MM761639
MM761639
MM761639
PA-28R-201
PA-28R-201T
Member
General Aviation
Manufacturers Association
1A2
PIPER CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
REVISION STATUS
Revisions to this Service Manual (P/N 761-639) originally published December 15, 1976 are as follows:
Consult the “Customer Service Information File" (available in the Avantext CD/DVD cited above) to verify
that you have the latest revision.
1A3
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
1A4
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
Aerofiche
Figure Grid No.
Revised: 2/13/89
1A6
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS (cont)
Aerofiche
Figure Grid No.
7-20. Installation of Anchor Bolt................................................................................................ 1K16
7-21. Brake System Installation.................................................................................................. 1K18
7-22. Brake Master Cylinder (Hand/Parking Brake).................................................................. 1K19
7-23. Toe Brake Installation........................................................................................................ 1K20
7-24. Brake Cylinder (1700) (Toe Brake)................................................................................... 1K21
7-25. Brake Cylinder (10-27) (Toe Brake) ................................................................................. 1K21
7-26. Bleeding Brakes................................................................................................................. 1L1
7-27. Nose Gear Service Tolerances........................................................................................... 1L9
7-28. Main Gear Service Tolerances........................................................................................... 1L12
8-1. Engine Cowling Installation.............................................................................................. 2A13
8-3. Propeller Installation ......................................................................................................... 2A14
8-4. Propeller Blade Minor Repair ........................................................................................... 2A16
8-5. Propeller Governor............................................................................................................ 2A17
8-6. Engine Installation............................................................................................................. 2A20
8-7. Schematic Diagram of Turbocharger System.................................................................... 2A23
8-8. Induction System Installation............................................................................................ 2B5
8-8a. Magneto Assembly............................................................................................................ 2B7
8-9. Contact Spring Inspection ................................................................................................. 2B8
8-10. Contact Points.................................................................................................................... 2B9
8-11. Impulse Coupling .............................................................................................................. 2B10
8-12. Flyweight Clearance of Impulse Coupling........................................................................ 2B10
8-13. Rotor Holding Tool Installed............................................................................................. 2B11
8-14. Timing Kit Installed........................................................................................................... 2B11
8-15. Cast-In Timing Marks........................................................................................................ 2B12
8-16. Fabricated Pointer.............................................................................................................. 2B12
8-17. Engine Timing Marks........................................................................................................ 2B13
8-18. Removing Spring From Lead Assembly........................................................................... 2B15
8-19. Assembly Tool................................................................................................................... 2B17
8-20. Assembly Tool Application............................................................................................... 2B17
8-21. Measuring Lead Assembly Length.................................................................................... 2B17
8-22. Ferrule Seating Tool .......................................................................................................... 2B19
8-23. Measuring Wire From Top of Ferrule ............................................................................... 2B19
8-24. Needle................................................................................................................................ 2B19
8-25. Installing Grommet Over Lead Assemblies...................................................................... 2B19
8-26. Lead Assembly Installed in Grommet............................................................................... 2B20
8-27. Wire Doubled Over For Installation of Eyelet .................................................................. 2B20
8-28. Ignition Schematic............................................................................................................. 2B21
8-29. Removing Frozen Spark Plug............................................................................................ 2B23
8-30. Lubrication System Maintenance Points........................................................................... 2B24
8-31. Schematic Diagram of Fuel Injection System................................................................... 2C2
8-32. Fuel Injection Nozzle Assembly ....................................................................................... 2C3
8-33. Engine Controls................................................................................................................. 2C4
8-34. Idle Speed and Mixture Adjustment Points....................................................................... 2C6
8-35. Sectional View of Altitude Compensating Fuel Pump Assembly..................................... 2C8
8-36. Exhaust Bypass Screw....................................................................................................... 2C10
8A-l. Propeller Installation (Hartzell)......................................................................................... 2C21
8A-2. Propeller Blade Minor Repair ........................................................................................... 2C22
8A-3. Propeller Governor............................................................................................................ 2C24
8A-3a. Engine Cowling Installation.............................................................................................. 2D2
8A-4. Engine Installation (PA-28R-201)..................................................................................... 2D4
8A-4a. Adjustment of Engine Controls......................................................................................... 2D7
8A-5. Fuel Injector....................................................................................................................... 2D8
8A-6. Schematic Diagram of RSA Injector System.................................................................... 2D9
NOTE: (Electrical Schematics Figures 11-46 thru 11-67, see Table XI-VIII.)
Revised: 2/13/89
1A9
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS (CONT)
Aerofiche
Flgure Grid No.
LIST OF TABLES
Aerofiche
Table Grid No.
Revised: 2/13/89
1A10
LIST OF TABLES
Aerofiche
Table Grid No.
LIST OF CHARTS
Aerofiche
Chart Grid No.
1A12
SECTION I
INTRODUCTION
Aerofiche
Paragraph Grid No.
Revised: 10/18/83
1A13
CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
SECTION I
INTRODUCTION
1-1. GENERAL. This manual contains service and maintenance procedures for the PA-28R-201T, 28R-201
Cherokee aircraft, designed and manufactured as a versatile airplane for use in the personal and business
aviation field, by the Piper Aircraft Corporation.
1-2. SCOPE OF MANUAL. Section II comprise the routine service part of this manual, Section III covers
inspections, and Sections IV through XIV comprise maintenance instructions. The routine service instructions
include ground handling and routine servicing. The inspection section includes 50, 100, 500, and 1000 hour
inspections which the manufacture requires for this airplane. The maintenance instruction for the various
systems of the airplane include system description, throubleshooting, removal and installation of components,
and corrective maintenance and testing as required. Each major system of the airplane is covered in a separate
section. Only qualified personnel should perform the operations described in this manual.
The description of the airplane included in this section is limited to general information. For more detailed
description of the various systems refer to the appropriate section of this manual. For detailed operating
instructions refer to the Pilot’s Information Manual for the airplane.
Section II of this manual also gives leading particulars and principal dimensions, along with lubrication
charts and other related routine service information.
1-4. WING. The laminar flow wing is of all-metal stressed-skin, full cantilever, tapered, low-wing design.
Each tapered wing panel is bolted to the spar box assembly in the fuselage. The wing tips are made of tough
resilient thermoplastic and are easily removed. The ailerons are statically balanced and cable and push rod
controlled. The trailing edge wing flaps are manually operated.
1-5. EMPENNAGE. The empennage consists of the fin, rudder, stabilator and stabilator trim tabs. The rudder
and stabilator are statically balanced.
1-6. FUSELAGE. The fuselage consists of three basic units: The engine section, the cabin section, and the tail
cone section.
1-7. LANDING GEAR. The tricycle landing gear is hydraulically operated, fully retractable unit consisting of
shock absorbing air-oil oleo struts.
1-8. HYDRAULIC SYSTEM. The hydraulic system incorporates an electrically driven pump which is
controlled by a selector lever on the instrument panel which in turn operates the retraction and extension of the
landing gear.
1-9. BRAKE SYSTEM. The brake system is operated hydraulically and controlled by a hand lever connected
to a single brake cylinder that operates both wheel brakes, plus individually operated toe brakes.
1-10. ENGINE Engine models, rated horsepower and other related information may be found in Table II-I of
Section II.
1-11.PROPELLER. A constant speed propeller is installed and controlled by an engine mounted governor
which is controlled by a lever on the power quadrant in the cockpit. Proeller specifications may be found in
Table II-I of Section II and Tble VIII-I or VIII A-I of Section VIII and VIIIA.
1-12.FUEL SYSTEM. The fuel system consists of an aluminum tank in the leading edge of the wings, a
stainer bowl with fuel screen, and electrical auxiliary fuel pump and an engine driven fuel pump.
1-13.FLIGHT CONTROLS. The flight controls are conventional equipment, consisting of a control wheel
which operates the ailerons and stabilator, and pedals which operate the rudder. Duplicate controls are
provided for the copilot.
1-14. CABIN HEATER, DEFROSTER, AND FRESH AIR SYSTEM. Heated air for the cabin and defroster is
obtained directly from the exhaust system muffler shroud. Fresh air is picked up from an inlet in the leading
edge of each wing and from an inlet in the upper leading edge of fin. The air is routed through the wings to
individually controlled outlets located just forward of each seat. The fresh air from the fin is routed to
overhead vents.
1-15.RADIO. Provisions are provided for the installations of various radio equipment along with microphone
and other radio navigation equipment.
1-16.INSTRUMENT AND AUTOPILOT SYSTEM. Provisions for instrument installation include panels for
engine instruments and advanced instruments, as well as for an Autopilot system.
Revised: 10/18/83
1A16
*
Aerofiche
Paragraph Grid No.
Revised: 5/1/80
1A17
*CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
SECTION II
2-2. DIMENSIONS. The principal airplane dimensions are shown in Figures 2-1 and 2-2 and are listed in
Table II-I.
2-3. STATION REFERENCE LINES. In order to facilitate the location of various components of the airplane
which require maintenance and servicing, a method utilizing fuselage station (Sta.) wing station or buttock line
(BL), and water line (WL) designations is frequently employed in this manual. (Refer to Figures 2-3 and 2-4.)
Fuselage stations, buttock and water lines are reference points measured by inches in the vertical or horizontal
direction from a given reference line which indicates station locations of structural members of the airplane.
Station O of the fuselage is 44.5 inches ahead of the lower edge of the firewall; station O (BL) of the wing and
stabilator is the centerline of the airplane; and station O (WL) of the fuselage vertical stabilizer and rudder is
20.5 inches below the cabin floor as measured at the rear wing spar with the airplane level.
2-4. WEIGHT AND BALANCE DATA. When figuring various weight and balance computations, the empty,
static and gross weight, and center of gravity of the airplane may be found in the Weight and Balance Form of
the Airplane Flight Manual.
2-5. SERIAL NUMBER PLATE. The serial number plate is located on the left side of the fuselage near the
landing edge of the stabilator. The serial number should always be used when referring to the airplane on
service or warranty matters.
2-6. ACCESS AND INSPECTION PROVISIONS. The access and inspection provisions for the airplane are
shown in Figure 2-5. The component to be serviced or inspected through each opening is identified in the
illustration. All access plates and panels are secured by eigher metal fasteners or screws. To enter the aft
section of the fuselage, open the baggage compartment door and remove the access panel.
CAUTION
Before entering the aft section of the fuselage, be sure the airplane is
supported at the tail skid.
2-7. TOOLS AND TEST EQUIPMENT. Because of the simplicity and easy accessibility of components, few
special tools outside normal shop tools will be required. Tools that are required may be fabricated from
dimensions given in the back of the section that pertains to a particular component or are listed in the back of
the PA-28R-201 and PA-28R-201T Parts Catalog.
ENGINE
ENGINE (cont.)
LANDING GEAR
FUEL SYSTEM
Fuel Tanks:
Capacity (each) 38.5 gal. 38.5 gal.
Unusable Fuel (each) 2.5 gal. 2.5 gal.
Total Capacity 77 gal. 77 gal.
Total Unusable Fuel (Refer to Owner’s
Handbook, Pilot’s Information
Manual or Flight Manual for
Particular Airplane) 5 gal. 5 gal.
OVERALL
GENERAL REQUIREMENTS:
1. Calibrate the torque wrench periodically to assure accuracy; recheck frequently.
2. Ascertain that the bolt and nut threads are clean and dry (unless otherwise specified by the
manufacturer). If the bolt or nut is specified to be lubricated prior to tightening, the torque range
should be reduced 50 percent.
3. Use a bolt length long enough to prevent bearing loads on the threads. The complete chamfer or end
radius of the bolt or screw must extend through the nut.
4. Unique torques specified in the text of this manual supersede the torques given in Charts A and B.
5. Refer to the latest revision of Lycoming SSP 1776 for torques on parts used on Lycoming engines.
6. A maximum of two AN960 washers may be added under the bolt heads or nuts to correct for
variations in material thickness within the tolerances permitted.
7. Limitations of the use of self-locking nuts, bolts and screws including fasteners with non-metallic
inserts are as follows:
A. Fasteners incorporating self-locking devices shall not be reused if they can be run up using only
fingers. They may be reused if hand tools are required to run them up, providing there is no
obvious damage to the self-locking device prior to installation.
B. Bolts 5/16 inch diameter and over with cotter pin holes may be used with self-locking nuts. Nuts
with non-metallic locking devices may be used in this application only if the bolts are free from
burrs around the cotter pin hole.
C. Do not use self-locking nuts at joints which subject either the nut or the bolt to rotation.
D. Never tap or rethread self-locking fasteners. Do not use nuts, bolts or screws with damaged threads
or rough ends.
NUTS
AN 310 AN 320
AN 315 AN 364
AN 363 NAS 1022
AN 365 MS 17826
NAS 1021 MS 20364
MS 17825
MS 21045
MS 20365
MS 20500
NAS 679
8-32 12 15 7 9
10-24 20 25 12 15
1/4-20 40 50 25 30
5/16-18 80 90 48 55
3/8-16 160 185 95 110
7/16-14 235 255 140 155
1/2-13 400 480 240 290
9/16-12 500 700 300 420
5/8-11 700 900 420 540
3/4-10 1,150 1,600 700 950
7/8-9 2,200 3,000 1,300 1,800
1-8 3,700 5,000 2,200 3,000
1-1/8-8 5,500 6,500 3,300 4,000
1-1/4-8 6,500 8,000 4,000 5,000
Nut-bolt Torque Limits Torque Limits Torque Limits Torque Limits Torque Limits Torque Limits
size in-lbs. in-lbs. in-lbs. in-lbs. in-lbs. in-lbs.
Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max.
8-36 12 15 7 9 5 10 3 6
10-32 20 25 12 15 25 30 15 20 10 15 5 10
1/4-28 50 70 30 40 80 100 50 60 30 45 15 30
5/16-24 100 140 60 85 120 145 70 90 40 65 25 40
3/8-24 160 190 95 110 200 250 120 150 75 110 45 70
7/16-20 450 500 270 300 520 630 300 400 180 280 110 170
1/2-20 480 690 290 410 770 950 450 550 280 410 160 260
9/16-18 800 1,000 480 600 1,100 1,300 650 800 380 580 230 360
5/8-18 1,100 1,300 660 780 1,250 1,550 750 950 550 670 270 420
3/4-16 2,300 2,500 1,300 1,500 2,650 3,200 1,600 1,900 950 1,250 560 880
7/8-14 2,500 3,000 1,500 1,800 3,550 4,350 2,100 2,690 1,250 1,900 750 1,200
1-14 3,700 4,500 2,200 3,300 4,500 5,500 2,700 3,300 1,600 2,400 950 1,500
1-1/8-12 5,000 7,000 3,000 4,200 6,000 7,300 3,600 4,400 2,100 3,200 1,250 2,000
1-1/4-12 9,000 11,000 5,400 6,600 11,000 13,400 6,600 8,000 3,900 5,600 2,300 3,650
2-8. TORQUE REQUIREMENTS. The torque valves given in Table II-II are derived from oil-free cadmium-
plated threads and are recommended for all airframe installations procedures where torquing is required, unless
otherwise noted in sections where other valves are stipulated. Engine torque valves for PA-28R-201 are found
in the latest revision of Avco-Lycoming Service Bulletin No. 268. Engine torque valves for PA-28R-201T are
found in the latest revision of Teledyne Continental Overhaul Manual. Propeller torque valves are found in
Section VII or VIIA of this manual.
a. Unless otherwise specified, torque all nuts to the applicable torque as given in Table II-II. If the nut (or
bolt) is listed but not its mating fastener, use the lower torque specified for the listed nut (or bolt).
NOTE
If normal operation requires movement between any of the components
being clamped together, tighten the nut (or bolt) without regard to the nut
torque chart to ensure intended operation of the assembly.
b. If the bolt and nut threads are to be lubricated an no torque has been specified, reduce the
recommended nut torque (plus friction drag torque) by 50%.
c. For thread sizes 10 through 7/16, add the friction drag torque for all self-locking fasteners as specified
in the friction drag torque table. For non self-locking fasteners, assume the friction drag torque to be
zero.
d. For bolt sizes other than those mentioned above, determine the friction drag torque by turning the nut
to near contact with the bearing surface. Attach a scale type torque wrench to the nut and determine
the torque required to turn the nut on the bolt before the nut contacts the bearing surface. Add the
friction drag torque to the recommended torque to get the final torque.
NOTE
If the bolt is stationary and the nut is torqued, use the lower side of the
torque range. If the nut is stationary and the bolt is torqued, use the higher
side of the torque range.
e. When torquing castellated nuts, begin with minimum torque plus friction drag torque. Do not exceed
maximum torque plus friction drag torque when trying to align slot on nut with hole in bolt shank. If
they do not align, change washers and try again. When using castellated nuts on movable joints, do not
torque as described above. Tighten nuts only to remove looseness in the joint and then install the cotter
pin.
f. After the final torque has been applied, the nut (or bolt or screw if no nut is used) should be
permanently marked red and should not be further tightened or disturbed.
2-9. WALKWAY, HANDHOLD AND STEP. The walkway is made of a non-skid compound applied to paper
and bonded to the wing surface. A fixed handhold is located on the right side of the fuselage near the rear
window. A step is available as optional equipment and is installed just aft of the trailing edge of the right flap.
2-11. INTRODUCTION TO GROUND HANDLING. Ground handling covers all essential information
governing the handling of the airplane while on the ground. This includes jacking, weighing, leveling mooring,
parking, towing and taxiing. When the airplane is handled in the manner described in the following
paragraphs, possible damage to the airplane and its equipment will be prevented.
CAUTION
When moving airplane forward by hand avoid pushing on the trailing edge
of the ailerons for this will result in an out of trim condition.
2-12. JACKING. Jacking the airplane is necessary to service the landing gear and to perform other service
operations. Proceed as follows:
a. Place jacks under jack pads on the front wing spar. (Refer to Figure 2-6.)
NOTE
A jacking point on the airplane is also provided on the underside of the
fuselage directly behind the nose gear actuating cylinder. This may be used
along with the wing jack points to raise the airplane, or alone it may be used
to raise the front end.
b. Attach the tail support to the tail skid. Place approximately 250 pounds of ballast on the base of the tail
support to hold down the tail.
CAUTION
Be sure to apply sufficient tail support ballast; otherwise the airplane will
tip forward.
c. Raise the jacks until all three wheels are clear of the surface.
2-13. WEIGHING. (Refer to Figure 2-7.) The airplane may be weighed by the following procedure:
a. Position a scale and ramp in front of each of the three wheels.
b. Secure the scales from rolling forward and tow the airplane up onto the scales. (Refer to Paragraph 2-
18.)
c. Remove the ramp so as not to interfere with the scales.
d. If the airplane is to be weighed for weight and balance computations, level the airplane per instructions
given in Paragraph 2-14.
2-14. LEVELING. The airplanes are provided with a means for longitudinal and lateral leveling. The airplanes
may be leveled while on jacks, during the weighing procedure while the wheels are on scales, or while the
wheels are on the ground. To level the airplane for purposes of weighing or rigging, the following procedures
may be used:
a. To longitudinally level the airplane, partially withdraw the two leveling screws located immediately
below the left front side window. (Refer to Figure 2-8.) Place a level on these screws heads and adjust
the jacks until the level is centered. Should the airplane be either on scales or on the floor, first block
the main gear oleos to full extension; then deflate the nose wheel until the proper position is reached.
b. To laterally level the airplane, place a level across the spar box assembly located under the rear seat.
(Refer to Figure 2-9.) Raise or lower one wing tip by deflating the appropriate tire on the high side of
the airplane or adjust either jack until the bubble of the level is centered.
2-15. MOORING. The airplane is moored to insure its immovability, protection and security under various
weather conditions. In order to properly moor the airplane use the following procedures:
a. Head the airplane into the wind, if possible.
b. Block the wheels.
c. Lock the aileron and stabilator controls using the front seat belt.
d. Secure tie-down ropes to the wing tie-down rings and the tail skid at approximately 45 degree angles
to the ground. When using rope constructed of non-synthetic material, leave sufficient slack to avoid
damage to the airplane when the ropes contract due to moisture.
CAUTION
Use square or bowline knots. Do not use slip knots.
NOTE
Additional preparations for high winds include using tie-down ropes from
the landing gear forks, and securing the rudder.
e. Install pitot tube cover, if available.
2-16. LOCKING AIRPLANE. The cabin and baggage compartment doors are provided with a key lock on the
outside. The ignition switch and cabin door require the same key while the baggage compartment door has a
separate key.
2-17. PARKING. When parking the airplane, insure that it is sufficiently protected against adverse weather
conditions and presents no danger to other aircraft. When parking the airplane for any length of time or
overnight, it is recommended that it be morred as in Paragraph 2-15.
a. To park the airplane, head it into the wind, if possible.
b. Set the parking brake by pulling back the brake lever and depressing the knob attached to the left side
of the handle, then release the handle. To release the parking brake, pull back on the brake lever to
disengage the catch mechanism, and allow the handle to swing forward.
NOTE
Care should be taken when setting brakes that are overheated or during
cold weather when accumulated moisture may freeze the brakes.
c. The aileron and stabilator may be locked by using the front seat belt.
2-18. TOWING. The airplane may be moved by using the nose wheel steering bar that is stowed in the
baggage area or power equipment that will not damage or cause excess strain to the nose gear steering
assembly. The stem on the bar is inserted in the hollow of the nose wheel axle at its right side.
CAUTION
When towing with power equipment, do not turn the nose gear in either
direction beyond its steering radius limits as this will result in damage to the
nose gear and steering mechanism.
In the event towing lines are necessary, lines (rope) should be attached to both main gear struts as high up
on the tubes as possible. Lines should be long enough to clear the nose and/or tail by not less than 15 feet, and
a qualified person to ride in the pilot’s seat to maintain control by use of the brakes.
2-19. TAXIING. Before attempting to taxi the airplane, ground personnel should be checked out by qualified
pilot or other responsible person. Engine starting and shut-down procedures should be covered as well. When
it is ascertained that the propeller back blast and taxi areas are clear, apply power to start the taxi roll and
perform the following checks:
a. Taxi forward a few feet and apply brakes to determine their effectiveness.
b. Taxi with propeller set in low pitch, high RPM setting.
c. While taxiing, make slight turns to ascertain the effectiveness of steering.
d. Observe wing clearances when taxiing near buildings or other stationary objects. If possible station a
guide outside the airplane to observe.
e. When taxiing on uneven ground, avoid holes and ruts.
f. Do not operate the engine at high RPM when running up or taxiing over ground containing loose
stones, gravel or any loose material that may cause damage to the propeller blades.
2-21. OPERATION OF EXTERNAL POWER RECEPTACLE. The external power receptacle is located on the
right side of the fuselage aft of the wing. When using external power for starting or operation of any of the
airplanes equipment the following procedure should be followed:
a. Turn aircraft MASTER SWITCH to OFF position.
b. Ensure that the RED lead of PEP (Piper External Power) kit jumper cable is connected to the
POSITIVE (+) terminal of the external 12-volt battery and that the BLACK lead is connected to the
NEGATIVE terminal.
c. Insert the plug of jumper cable into the socket located on the aircraft fuselage.
d. Turn the aircraft MASTER SWITCH ON and proceed with NORMAL engine starting technique
e. After the engine has been started, turn the MASTER SWITCH to the OFF position and remove the
jumper cable plug from the aircraft.
f. Turn the aircraft MASTER SWITCH to the ON position and check the alternator ammeter for an
indiction of output. (DO NOT ATTEMPT ANY FLIGHT IF THERE IS NO INDICATION OF
ALTERNATOR OUTPUT.)
NOTE
If aircraft battery is weak, charging current will be high. Do not take off
until charging current falls below 20 amps. Do not take off with a
completely discharged battery as three volts is needed to excite the
alternator.
2-22. CLEANING.
2-23. CLEANING ENGINE COMPARTMENT. Before cleaning the engine compartment, place a strip tape on
the magneto vents to prevent any solvent from entering these units.
a. Place a pan under the engine to catch waste.
b. With the engine cowling removed, spray or brush the engine with solvent or a mixture of solvent and
degreaser, as desired. It may be necessary to brush areas that were sprayed where heavy grease and dirt
deposits have collected in order to clean them.
CAUTION
Do not spray solvent into the alternator, starter, air intake, and alternate air
inlets.
c. Allow the solvent to remain on the engine from five to ten minutes, then rinse the engine clean with
additional solvent and allow to dry.
CAUTION
Do not operate engine until excess solvent has evaporated or otherwise been
removed.
d. Remove the protective covers from the magnetos.
e. Lubricate controls, bearing surfaces, etc. per Lubrication Chart.
2-24. CLEANING LANDING GEAR. Before cleaning the landing gear, place a plastic cover or similar
material over the wheel and brake assembly.
a. Place a pan under the gear to catch waste.
b. Spray or brush the gear area with solvent or a mixture of solvent and degreaser, as desired. It may be
necessary to brush areas that were sprayed where heavy grease and dirt deposits have collected in
order to clean them.
c. Allow the solvent to remain on the gear from five to ten minutes, then rinse the gear with additional
solvent and allow to dry.
d. Remove the cover from the wheel and remove the catch pan.
e. Lubricate the gear per Lubrication Chart.
2-25. CLEANING EXTERIOR SURFACES. The airplane should be washed with a mild soap and water.
Harsh abrasives or detergents used on painted or plastic surfaces could make scratches or cause corrosion of
metal surfaces. Cover areas where cleaning solution could cause damage. Cover the mast of the gear back-up
extender. To wash the airplane, the following procedure may be used:
a. Flush away loose dirt with water.
b. Apply cleaning solution with a rag, sponge or soft bristle brush.
c. To remove stubborn oil and grease, use a cloth dampened with naptha.
d. Where exhaust stains exist, allow solution to remain on the surface longer.
e. Any good automotive wax may be used to preserve the painted surfaces. Solt cleaning cloths or
chamois should be used to prevent scratches when cleaning or polishing. A heavier coating of wax on
the leading surfaces will reduce the abrasion problems in these areas.
NOTE
Do not use gasoline, alcohol, benzene, carbon tetrachloride, thinner,
acetone or window cleaning sprays.
d. After cleaning plastic surfaces, apply a thin coat of hard polishing wax. Rub lightly with a soft cloth.
Do not use a circular motion.
e. A servere scratch or mar in plastic can be removed by using jeweler’s rouge to rub out the scratch.
Smooth both sides and apply wax.
f. To improve visibility through windshield and windows during flight through rain, a rain repellent such
as REPCON should be applied to the windshield and windows. The surfaces of the windshield and
windows treated becomes so smooth that water beads up and readily flows off the surface. Apply this
product in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions. REPCON is manufactured by Unelko
Corp., 727 E. 110 Street, Chicago, Illinois 60628.
2-28. CLEANING CARPETS. Use a small whisk broom or vacuum to remove dirt. For soiled spots, use non-
inflammable dry-cleaning fluid.
2-29. SERVICING.
2-30. INTRODUCTION OF SERVICING. Servicing the airplane includes the replenishment of fuel, oil,
hydraulic fluid, tire pressures, lubrication requirements and other required items.
2-32. SERVICING HYDRAULIC SYSTEM. The general condition of the hydraulic pump and landing gear
actuating cylinders should be checked. Ensure that there are no leaks and that the line fittings are tight. The
cylinder rods are to be free of all dirt and grit. To clean the rods use an oil soaked rag and carefully wipe them.
All the hydraulic lines should also be checked for leaks, kinks, and corrosion. Check the tightness of the
attachment fittings.
The gear back up extender actuator assembly is located beneath the rear seat and should be checked
determine that it is operating properly. The diaphragm shaft may be operated by hand to make sure that is free
to fluctuate and that the actuating arm and its components are operating freely. Check the pressure housing
assembly for cracks, breaks, or fatique. Check to ensure that the hydraulic valve and fittings a free of leaks.
Repair and check procedures for the hydraulic pump, cylinders and various components may be found in
Section VI of this manual.
2-33. SERVICING HYDRAULIC PUMP/RESERVOIR. The fluid level of the reservoir of the combination
pump and reservoir should be checked every 50 hours by viewing the fluid through the filler plug hole in the
hydraulic pump. Access to the pump is through the panel at the right rear side of the baggage compartment.
To check fluid level, remove the filler plug located on the forward side of the pump and ascertain that fluid
is visible up to the bottom of the filler plug hole. Should fluid be below the hole, add fluid, MIL-H-5606A,
through the filler hole until full. Reinstall the filler plug and tighten.
NOTE
A small vent hole is located under the vent screw head. Retain 1/64 inch
clearance between the screw head and the small vent hole.
2-34. LANDING GEAR SYSTEM.
2-35. SERVICING LANDING GEAR. The landing gear consists of tires, brakes and oleo strut assemblies
These should be inspected for proper gear extension, scored piston tubes, possible hydraulic fluid leakage and
security and condition of all connection points. Check the brake linings for wear and frayed edges, and brake
discs for scoring. Replace if found necessary. Checked for proper adjustment of downlock hooks looseness of
drag links and side brace links. Minor servicing is described in the following paragraphs, and for detailed
service and overhaul instructions refer to Section VII.
2-37. SERVICING OLEO STRUTS. The air-oil type oleo strut should be maintained at proper strut tube
exposures for best oleo action. The nose gear strut must have approximately 2.75 inches of piston tube
exposed, while the main gear strut requires approximately 2.0 inches of tube exposure. These measurements
are taken with the airplane sitting on level surface under normal static load. (Empty weight of airplane plus full
fuel and oil.) If the strut has less tube exposure than prescribed, determine whether if needs air or oil by
rocking the airplane. If the oleo strut oscillated with short strokes (approximately one inch) and the airplane
settles to its normal position within one or two cycles after the rocking force is removed, the oleo strut requires
inflating. Check the valve core and filler plug for air leaks, correct if required, and add air as described in
Paragraph 2-39. If the oleo strut oscillates with long strokes (approximately three inches) and the airplane
continues to oscillate after the rocking force is removed, the oleo struts require fluid. Check the oleo for
indications of oil leaks, correct if required and add fluid as described in Paragraph 2-38. For repair procedures
of the landing gear and/or oleo struts, refer to Section VII.
WARNING
Do not release air by removing the strut valve core or filler plug. Depress
the valve core pin until strut chamber pressure has diminished.
CAUTION
Dirt and foreign particles form around the filler plugs of the landing gear
struts, therefore, before attempting to remove these plugs, the tops of the
struts should be cleaned with compressed air and/or with a dry solvent.
2-38. FILLING OLEO STRUTS. To fill the nose or main gear oleo strut with fluid (MIL-H-5606A), whether it
be the addition of a small or large amount, procede as follows:
a. Raise the airplane on jacks. (Refer to Paragraph 2-12.)
b. Place a pan under the gear to catch spillage.
c. At the filler plug, relieve air pressure from the strut housing chamber by removing the cap fron the air
valve and depressing the valve core.
d. There are two methods by which the strut chamber may be filled and these are as follows:
Method 1:
1. Remove the valve core from the filler plug at the top of the nose gear strut housing or at the top
inboard side of the main gear housing. Allow the filler plug to remain installed.
2. Attach one end of a clean plastic hose to the valve stem of the filler plug and submerge the other
end in a container of hydraulic fluid.
NOTE
An air-tight connection is necessary between the plastic tube and the valve
stem. Without such a connections, a small amount of air will be sucked into
the oleo strut during each sequence, resulting in an inordinate amount of
air bubbles and a prolonged filling operation.
3. Fully compress and extend the strut thus drawing fluid from the fluid container and expelling air
from the strut chamber. By watching the fluid pass through the plastic hose, it can be determined
when the strut is full and no air is present in the chamber.
4. When air bubbles cease to flow through the hose, compress the strut fully and remove the hose
from the valve stem.
5. With the strut compressed, remove the filler plug to determine that the fluid level is visible up to
the bottom of the filler plug hole.
6. Reinstall the core in the filler plug and apply thread lubricant (Parker No. 6PB) to the threads of
the filler plug and install the plug in the top of the strut housing. Torque the plug to 45 foot
pounds.
Method 2:
1. Remove the filler plug from the top of the nose gear strut housing or at the top inboard side of the
main gear housing.
2. Raise the strut piston tube until it is fully compressed.
3. Pour fluid from a clean container through the filler opening until it reaches the bottom of the filler
plug hole. (Air pressure type oil container may be helpful.)
4. Install the filler plug finger tight and extend and compress the strut two or three times to remove
air from the housing.
5. Remove the filler plug, raise the strut to full compression and fill with fluid if needed.
6. Apply thread lubricant (Parker No. 6PB) to the threads of the filler plug. Reinstall the filler plug
and torque to 45 foot pounds.
e. With the airplane raised, compress and extend the gear strut several times to ascertain that the strut
actuates freely. The weight of the gear fork and wheel should extend the strut.
f. Clean off overflow of fluid and inflate the strut as described in Paragraph 2-39.
g. Check that fluid is not leaking around the strut piston at the bottom of the housing.
2-39. INFLATING OLEO STRUTS. After making certain that an oleo strut has sufficient fluid, attach a strut
pump to the air valve and inflate the oleo strut. The strut should be inflated until the correct inches piston is
exposed with normal static load (empty weight of the airplane plus full fuel and oil) on the gears (Refer to
Paragraph 2-37.) Rock the airplane several times to ascertain that the gear settles back to the correct strut
position. (If a strut pump is not available, the airplane may be raised and line pressure from a high pressure air
system used. Lower the airplane and while rocking it, let air from the valve to bring the strut down to the
proper extension. (Before capping the valve, check for valve core leakage.)
2-41. SERVICING BRAKE SYSTEM. The brake system incorporates a hydraulic fluid reservoir through
which the brake system is periodically serviced. Fluid is drawn from the reservoir by the brake cylinders to
maintain the volume of fluid required for maximum braking efficiency. Spongy brake pedal action is often an
indication that the brake fluid reservoir is running low on fluid. Instructions for filling the reservoir a given in
Paragraph 2-42. When found necessary to accomplish repairs to any of the brake system components, or to
bleed the system, these instructions may be found in Section VII.
2-42. FILLING BRAKE CYLINDER RESERVOIR. The brake cylinder reservoir should be filled to the level
marked on reservoir, with the fluid specified in Table II-I. The reservoir, located on the left side of the firewall
in the engine compartment, should be checked at every 50-hour inspection and replenish
n e c e s s a r y. No adjustment of the brakes is necessary, though they should be checked periodically per
instructions given in Section VII.
2-43. DRAINING BRAKE SYSTEM. To drain the brake system, connect a hose to the bleeder fitting on the
bottom of the cylinder and place the other end of the line in a suitable container. Open the bleeder and slowly
pump the hand brake lever and the desired brake pedal until fluid ceases to flow. To clean the brake system,
flush with denatured alcohol.
2-44. TIRES.
2-45. SERVICING TIRES. The tires should be maintained at the pressure specified in Table II-I. When
checking tire pressure, examine the tires for wear, cuts, bruises and slippage on the wheel. The tire, tube and
wheel should be properly balanced when installed with the index mark on the tire aligned with the index mark
on the tube.
2-47. SERVICING POWER PLANT. Regularly check the engine compartment for oil and fuel leaks, chaffing
of lines, loose wires and tightness of all parts. For cleaning of the engine compartment, refer to Paragraph 2-
23. Maintenance instructions for the power plant may be found in Section VIII or VIIIA of this manual and in
the appropriate manufacturers manuals.
2-49. REMOVAL OF AIR FILTER. The location of the PA-28R-201 filter is on the left side and just in front of
the firewall. The PA-28R-201T filter is located just in front of the firewall above the turbocharger. Remove
filter by following procedure:
a. Remove upper engine cowl.
b. Loosen studs and carefully move the cover assembly aside.
c. The filter is now free for removal. Clean or replace the filter as given in Paragraph 2-50.
2-51. INSTALLATION OF AIR FILTER. After cleaning and inspection, install the filter element and cover in
reverse order of removal instructions.
2-52. PROPELLER.
2-53. SERVICING PROPELLER. The spinner, back plate and propeller surfaces should be cleaned and
inspected frequently for nicks, scratches, corrosion and cracks. Minor nicks and scratches may be removed as
found in Section VIII or VIIIA. The face of each blade should be painted when necessary with a flat paint to
retard glare. To prevent corrosion, wipe surfaces with a light oil or wax.
In addition, propellers should be inspected for grease or oil leakage and freedom of rotation on the hub
pilot tube. To check freedom of rotation, rock and blade back and forth through the slight freedom allowed by
the pitch change mechanism. Lubricate the propeller at 100-hour intervals in accordance with the Lubrication
Chart.
Additional service information for the propeller may be found in Section VIII or VIIIA.
2-55. SERVICING FUEL SYSTEM. At intervals of 50-hours or 90 days, whichever comes first, clean the fuel
strainer screen, located in the fuel bowl mounted on the lower left side of the firewall, and on PA-28R-201
only, clean the screen in the inlet side of the injector. Remove and clean the fuel strainer screen in accordance
with the instructions outlined in Section IX. Additional fuel system service information may also be found in
Section IX. Inspection intervals of the various fuel system components may be found in Section III.
2-56. FILLING FUEL TANKS. Observe all required precautions for handling gasoline. Fill the fuel tanks with
the fuel as specified on the placard adjacent to the filler neck or in Table II-I. Each wing tank has a capacity of
38 1/2 U.S. gallons, for a total capacity of 77 U.S. gallons. Five U.S. gallons are considered unusable fuel.
2-57. DRAINING MOSITURE FROM FUEL SYSTEM. The fuel tanks and fuel strainer should be drained
daily prior to first flight to avoid the accumulation of water or sediment. Each fuel tank is equipped with an
individual quick drain located at the lower inboard rear corner of the tank. The fuel strainer with a quick drain
valve (refer to Figure 2-12) is located on the lower left side of the firewall. Drain fuel tanks and strainer per the
following:
a. Drain each tank through its individual quick drain located at the lower inboard rear corner of the tank,
making sure that enough fuel has been drained to insure that all water and sediment is removed.
b. Place a container under the fuel strainer drain. Drain the fuel strainer by opening the quick drain on the
strainer.
c. Examine the contents of the container placed under the fuel strainer drain for water and sediment and
dispose of the contents.
CAUTION
When draining any amount of fuel, care should be taken to insure that no
fire hazard exists before starting engine.
2-58. DRAINING FUEL SYSTEM. Fuel may be drained from the system by opening the valve at the inboard
end of each fuel tank. The drain valve requires the drain cup pin to hold valve open. The remaining fuel in the
system may be drained through the filter bowl. Any individual tank may be drained by closing the selector
valve and then draining as desired.
2-58a FUEL ADDITIVES. Operating the aircraft with fuel anti-icing fuel additive, MIL-1-27686, is approved.
It must be uniformly blended with the fuel while refueling, must not exceed .15% by volume of the refueled
quantity and must be blended at not less than .10% volume 1 1/2 liquid oz.’s per 10 gallons of fuel would fall
within this range. Use a blender supplied by the additive manufacturer. Except for the information contained in
this section, the manufacturer’s mixing or blending instructions should be carefully followed.
—CAUTION—
Assure that the additive is directed into flowing fuel stream. The additive
flow should start after and stop before the fuel flow. Do not permit the
concentrated additive to come in contact with the aircraft painted surfaces
or the interior surfaces of the fuel tanks.
Some fuels have anti-icing additives preblended in the fuel at the refinery,
so no further blending should be performed.
Fuel additive cannot be used as a substitute for preflight draining of the
fuel system drains.
2-59. ELECTRICAL SYSTEM.
2-60. SERVICING ELECTRICAL SYSTEM. Servicing the electrical system involves adding distilled water to
the battery to maintain correct electrolyte level and checking cable connections and for any spilled electrolyte
that would lead to corrosion. The security of all electrical connections should be checked as well as the
operation of all lights, general condition of the alternator and starter. All electrical wires should be inspected
for chafing and bare wires. For detailed information on this system, refer to Section XI of this manual.
2-61. LUBRICATION.
2-63. SERVICING OIL SYSTEM. The engine oil level should be checked before each flight and changed after
each 100-hours of engine operation. During oil change the oil screen(s) should be removed and cleaned, and
the oil filter cartridge replaced. Replace oil filter at 50-hour intervals. Use a quality brand aviation grade oil of
the proper season viscosity. Refer to Tables II-III and II-VI for proper oil grade and specification. For
information on the use of detergent oil, on the PA-28R-201 airplanes refer to Paragraph 2-69 and/or Lycoming
Service Instruction Letter 1014. Detergent oil that meets Continental Motors Corporation Specification MHS-
24, is the only recommended lubricating oil for the PA-28R-201T airplanes.
CAUTION
Do not introduce any trade additive to the basic lubricant unless
recommended by the engine manufacturer.
2-64. FILLING OIL SUMP. The oil sump should normally be filled with oil to the mark on the engine
dipstick. The quantity of oil required for the engines may be found in Table II-I. The specified grade of oil may
be found in Table II-III, the Lubrication Chart, or on the access door. To service the engine with oil, open the
access door and remove the oil filler cap.
2-65. DRAINING OIL SUMP. To drain the oil sump, provide a suitable container with a minimum capacity of
that required to fill the sump. Remove the engine cowl and on PA-28R-201 airplanes open the oil drain valve
by pushing the center of the drain up and turning counterclockwise. This will hold the drain in the open
position. On PA-28R-201T airplanes remove the oil drain probe from the clip on the right rear engine baffle.
Install suitable hose on probe and insert in quick drain valve located on the underside of the engine. It is
recommended the engine be warmed to operating temperature to insure complete draining of the old oil.
—CAUTION—
When replacing the engine oil quick drain, refer to the Piper Parts Catalog
for the correct part number. Installation of an incorrect drain could damage
the sump or the drain itself. This could lead to loss of engine oil and a
possible engine seizure.
2-66. OIL FILTER (FULL FLOW).
a. The oil filter should be replaced after each 50 hours of engine operation; this is accomplished by
removing the lockwire from the bolthead at the end of the filter housing, loosening the cartridge, and
removing it from the adapter.
NOTE
Ascertain that oil filter complies with specifications of Continental Aircraft
Engine Service Bulletin M75-7. Warranty effectivity is dependent on the use
of Continental engine parts, per Continental Aircraft Engine Service
Bulletin M75-9.
b. Before discarding the throw away filter, remove the element for inspection by using a Champion cutter
tool, CT-470, available from Champion Spark Plug Co., Toledo, Ohio 43601. It will cut open any spin-
on type oil filter for inspection. Examine the material trapped in the filter for evidence of internal
engine damage, such as chips or particles from bearings. In new or newly overhauled engines, some
small particles of metallic shavings might be found; these are generally of no consequence and should
not be confused with particles produced by impacting, abrasion or pressure. Evidence of internal
engine damage found in the oil filter justifies further examination to determine the cause.
c. After the filter has been replaced, tighten the new cartridge with 18 to 20 foot-pounds of torque.
Lockwire the bolt head to the loops on the side of the housing, and on Lycoming engines also to the
drilled head of the thermostatic valve. Be sure the lockwire is replaced at both the attached bolthead
and the thermostatic oil cooler bypass. Use MS-20995-C41 safety wire.
2-67. RECOMMENDATIONS FOR CHANGING OIL. The engine manufacturer recommends that the oil
supply be drained and the entire sump filled with fresh oil after each 100 hours of engine operation. Always
start and warm the engine to operating temperature before performing an oil change. While draining the oil,
the screens should be removed from the crankcase cover and cleaned thoroughly. If sludge deposits are heavy,
subsequent oil changes should be made at shorter intervals.
a. Note the following for Continental engines:
1. Detergent oil that meets Continental Motors Corporation Specification MHS-24, is the only
recommended lubricating oil.
2. Use SAE-30 or 10W-30 below 40°F and SAE-50 above 40°F. When the average ambient air
temperature is approximately at the dividing line, use the lighter oil.
b. Note the following for Lycoming engine:
1. Non-detergent oil that meets MIL-L-6082 specification is recommended by Lycoming. (See
Lubrication Chart.)
2. For use of detergent oil note the following: Also refer to the latest revision of Lycoming Service
Information No. 1014.
(a) In engines that have been operating on straight mineral oil for several hundred hours, a change
to additive oil should be made with a degree of caution, since the cleaning action of some
additive oils will tend to loosen sludge deposits and cause plugged oil passages. When an
engine has been operating on straight mineral oil and is known to be in excessively dirty
condition, the switch to additive or compounded oil should be deferred until after the engine is
overhauled.
(b) When changing from straight oil to compound oil, the following precautionary steps should be
taken:
(1) Do not add additive oil to straight mineral oil. Drain the straight mineral oil from the
engine and fill with additive oil.
(2) Do not operate the engine longer than five hours before the first oil change.
(3) Check all oil screens for evidence of sludge or plugging and change oil every ten hours if
sludge conditions are evident. Resume normal oil drain periods after sludge conditions
improve.
2-68. LUBRICATION INSTRUCTIONS. Proper lubrication procedures are of immeasurable value both as a
means of prolonging the service life of the airplane and as a means of reducing the frequency of extensive and
expensive repairs. The periodic application of recommended lubricants to their relevant bearing surfaces, as
detailed in the following Paragraphs, together with the observance of cleanliness will insure the maximum
efficiency and utmost service of all moving parts. Lubrication instruction regarding the locations, time
intervals, and type of lubricants used may be found in the Lubrication Chart. To insure the best possible results
from the application of lubricants, the following precautions should be observed:
a. Use recommended lubricants. Where general purpose lubricating oil is specified, but unavailable,
clean engine oil may be used as a staisfactory substitute.
b. Check the components to be lubricated for evidence of excessive wear and replace them as necessary.
c. Remove all excess lubricants from components in order to prevent the collection of dirt and sand in
abrasive quantities capable of causing excessive wear or damage to bearing surfaces.
NOTE
If the airplane is inactive for long periods of time, it should be lubricated in
accordance with Lubrication Chart every 90 days.
2-69. APPLICATION OF OIL. Whenever specific instructions for lubrication of mechanisms requiring
lubrication are not available, observe the following precautions:
a. Apply oil sparingly, never more than enough to coat the bearing surfaces.
b. Since the control cables are sufficiently coated by the manufacturer, additional protection for the
prevention of corrosion is unnecessary.
c. Squeeze the magneto cam follower felt at regular inspection periods. If oil appears on fingers, do not
add oil. If the felt is dry, moisten with light oil.
CAUTION
Be careful not to add too much oil, because the excess will be thrown off
during operation and will cause pitting and burning of the magneto points.
2-70. APPLICATION GREASE. Care must be taken when lubricating bearings and bearing surfaces with a
grease gun, to insure that gun is filled with new, clean grease of the grade specified for the particular
application before applying lubricant to the grease fittings.
a. Where a reservoir is not provided around a bearing, apply the lubricant sparingly and wipe off any
excess.
b. Remove wheel bearings from the wheel hub and clean thoroughly with a suitable solvent. When
repacking with grease, be sure the lubricant enters the space between the rollers in the retainer ring. Do
not pack the grease into the wheel hub.
c. Use extra care when greasing the constant speed propeller hub to avoid blowing the clamp gaskets.
Remove one grease fitting and apply grease to the other fitting until fresh grease appears at the hole of
the removed fitting.
2-71. WINTERIZATION PLATE. (PA-28R-201 Only.) For winter operations there is a winterization plate kit
available. When the ambient temperature is 50° F or less the plate is installed on the inlet opening of the oil
cooler plenum chamber. When the plate is not being used it can be stowed on a bracket, provided for this
purpose, located on the oil cooler plenum chamber.
(PA-28R-201T Only.) The winterization plate is mounted on the firewall when not in use (temperature is
above 50°F). The plate is mounted to the oil cooler baffle when ambient temperature is 50°F or less.
2-72. LUBRICATION CHARTS. The lubrication charts consists of individual illustrations for the various
aircraft systems, and each component to be lubricated is indicated by a number, the type of lubricant and the
frequency of application. Special instructions are listed at the beginning of the lubrication charts and with the
applicable component illustration.
NOTE
When the average ambient air temperature is approximately at the dividing
line, use the lighter oil.
PA-28R-201
Average Average Ambient Oil Inlet Temperatures
Grade Oil Air Temperature Desired Maximum
PA-28R-201T
NOTE
When the average ambient air temperature is approximately at the dividing
line, use the lighter oil.
Brakes MIL-H-5606A
NOTE
Lubricate engine fittings only with the fluid contained in the particular
lines.
2. The English system is in use by England and the United States. All other countries use the metric system.
A. Read number in middle column, if in degrees Celsius (°C), read Fahrenheit equivalent in right-hand
column. If in degrees Fahrenheit (° F), read Celsius equivalent in left-hand column.
INCHES 0.0000 0.0001 0.0002 0.0003 0.0004 0.0005 0.0006 0.0007 0.0008 0.0009
MILLIMETER
0.000 0.0025 0.0050 0.0076 0.0101 0.0127 0.0152 0.0177 0.0203 0.0228
0.001 0.0254 0.0279 0.0304 0.0330 0.0355 0.0381 0.0406 0.0431 0.0457 0.0482
0.002 0.0508 0.0533 0.0558 0.0584 0.0609 0.0635 0.0660 0.0685 0.0711 0.0736
0.003 0.0762 0.0812 0.0838 0.0863 0.0889 0.0914 0.0939 0.0965 0.0965 0.0990
0.004 0.1016 0.1041 0.1066 0.1092 0.1117 0.1143 0.1168 0.1193 0.1219 0.1244
0.005 0.1270 0.1295 0.1320 0.1346 0.1371 0.1397 0.1422 0.1447 0.1447 0.1498
0.006 0.1524 0.1549 0.1574 0.1600 0.1625 0.1651 0.1676 0.1701 0.1727 0.1752
0.007 0.1778 0.1803 0.1828 0.1854 0.1879 0.1905 0.1930 0.1955 0.1981 0.2006
0.008 0.2032 0.2057 0.2082 0.2108 0.2133 0.2159 0.2184 0.2209 0.2235 0.2260
0.009 0.2286 0.2311 0.2336 0.2362 0.2387 0.2413 0.2438 0.2463 0.2489 0.2514
INCHES 0.000 0.001 0.002 0.003 0.004 0.005 0.006 0.007 0.008 0.009
MILLIMETER
0.00 0.025 0.050 0.076 0.101 0.127 0.152 0.177 0.203 0.228
0.01 0.254 0.279 0.304 0.330 0.355 0.381 0.406 0.431 0.457 0.482
0.02 0.508 0.533 0.558 0.584 0.609 0.635 0.660 0.685 0.711 0.736
0.03 0.762 0.787 0.812 0.838 0.863 0.889 0.914 0.939 0.965 0.990
0.04 1.016 1.041 1.066 1.092 1.117 1.143 1.168 1.193 1.219 1.244
0.05 1.270 1.295 1.320 1.346 1.371 1.397 1.422 1.447 1.473 1.498
0.06 1.524 1.549 1.574 1.600 1.625 1.651 1.676 1.701 1.727 1.752
0.07 1.778 1.803 1.828 1.854 1.879 1.905 1.930 1.955 1.981 2.006
0.08 2.032 2.057 2.082 2.108 2.133 2.159 2.184 2.209 2.235 2.260
0.09 2.286 2.311 2.336 2.362 2.387 2.413 2.438 2.463 2.489 2.514
INCHES 0.00 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04 0.05 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.09
MILLIMETER
0.0 0.254 0.508 0.762 0.016 1.270 1.524 1.778 2.032 2.286
0.1 2.540 2.794 3.048 3.302 3.556 3.810 4.064 4.318 4.572 4.826
0.2 5.080 5.334 5.558 5.842 6.096 6.350 6.604 6.858 7.112 7.366
0.3 7.620 7.874 8.128 8.382 8.636 8.890 9.144 9.398 9.652 9.906
0.4 10.160 10.414 10.668 10.922 11.176 11.430 11.684 11.938 12.192 12.446
0.5 12.700 12.954 13.208 13.462 13.716 13.970 14.224 14.478 14.732 14.986
0.6 15.240 15.494 15.748 16.002 16.256 16.510 16.764 17.018 17.272 17.526
0.7 17.780 18.034 18.288 18.542 18.796 19.050 19.304 19.558 19.812 20.066
0.8 20.320 20.574 20.828 21.082 21.336 21.590 21.844 22.098 22.352 22.606
0.9 22.860 23.114 23.368 23.622 23.876 24.130 24.384 24.638 24.892 25.146
INCHES TO MILLIMETER
INCHES 0.00 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9
MILLIMETER
0. 2.54 5.08 7.62 10.16 12.70 15.24 17.78 20.32 22.86
1. 25.40 27.94 30.48 33.02 35.56 38.10 40.64 43.18 45.72 48.26
2. 50.80 53.34 55.88 58.42 60.96 63.50 66.04 68.58 71.12 73.66
3. 76.20 78.74 81.28 83.82 86.36 88.90 91.44 93.98 96.52 99.06
4. 101.60 104.14 106.68 109.22 111.76 114.30 116.84 119.38 121.92 124.46
5. 127.00 129.54 132.08 134.62 137.16 139.70 142.24 144.78 147.32 149.86
6. 152.40 154.94 157.48 160.02 162.56 165.10 167.64 170.18 172.72 175.26
7. 177.80 180.34 182.88 185.42 187.96 190.50 193.04 195.58 198.12 200.66
8. 203.20 205.74 208.28 210.82 213.36 215.90 218.44 220.98 223.52 226.06
9. 228.60 231.14 233.68 236.22 238.76 241.30 243.84 246.38 248.92 251.46
°C °F - °C °F °C °F - °C °F
GAL., U.S. DRY 268.8 CU. IN. NAUTICAL MILE 1.151 STATUTE
0.1556 CU. FT. MILE
1.164 U.S. GAL., LIQ.
4.405 LITERS QUART .9463 LITER
Size Decimal Millimeter Size Decimal Millimeter Size Decimal Millimeter Size Decimal Millimeter
Equiv. Equiv. Equiv. Equiv. Equiv. Equiv. Equiv. Equiv.
1/2 0.500 12.7000 G 0.261 6.6294 5/32 0.1562 3.9687 51 0.067 1.7018
31/64 0.4843 12.3031 F 0.257 6.5278 23 0.154 3.9116 52 0.0635 1.6129
15/32 0.4687 11.9062 E-1/4 0.250 6.3500 24 0.152 3.8608 1/16 0.0625 1.5875
29/64 0.4531 11.5094 D 0.246 6.2484 25 0.1495 3.7973 53 0.0595 1.5113
7/16 0.4375 11.1125 C 0.242 6.1468 26 0.147 3.7338 54 0.055 1.397
25/64 0.3906 9.9212 7/32 0.2187 5.5562 1/8 0.125 3.1750 59 0.041 1.0414
W 0.386 9.8044 3 0.213 5.4102 31 0.120 3.048 60 0.040 1.016
V 0.377 9.5758 4 0.209 5.3086 32 0.116 2.9464 61 0.039 0.9906
3/8 0.375 9.5250 5 0.2055 5.2197 33 0.113 2.8702 62 0.038 0.9652
U 0.368 9.3472 6 0.204 5.1816 34 0.111 2.8194 63 0.037 0.9398
23/64 0.3593 9.1262 13/64 0.2031 5.1594 35 0.110 2.794 64 0.036 0.9144
T 0.358 9.1281 7 0.201 5.1054 7/64 0.1093 2.7781 65 0.035 0.899
S 0.346 8.7884 8 0.199 5.0546 36 0.1065 2.7051 66 0.033 0.8382
11/32 0.3437 8.7300 9 0.196 4.9784 37 0.104 2.6416 1/32 0.0312 0.7937
R 0.339 8.6106 10 0.1935 4.9149 38 0.1015 2.5781 67 0.032 0.8128
K 0.281 7.1374 19 0.166 4.2164 5/64 0.0781 1.9844 1/64 0.0156 0.3969
J 0.277 7.0358 20 0.161 4.0894 48 0.076 1.9304 78 0.016 0.4064
I 0.272 6.9088 21 0.159 4.0386 49 0.073 1.8542 79 0.0145 0.3683
H 0.266 6.7564 22 0.157 3.9878 50 0.070 1.778 80 0.0135 0.3429
17/64 0.2656 6.7462
PA-28R-201T (Continental) Teledyne Con- BP Aero Oil D65/80 BP (North America) Ltd.,
Lubricating oil, aircraft reciprocating tinental Mo- 620 Fifth Ave., New York,
engine (piston) grade as specified tors Speci- New York 10020
SAE 50 above 40°F ambient air (S.L.) fication
SAE 30 or 10-W-30 below 40°F MHS-24A
ambient air (S.L.)
Castrolaero AD Oil Castrol Oils, Inc., Castrol
Limited, 254-266 Doremus
Avenue, Newark, New
Jersey 07105
Mobil Aero White Band Mobil Oil Corp., 150 E. 42nd St.,
AVREX 101/1065 New York, New York 10017
Grease, Aircraft, General Purpose, MIL-G-81322 Mobilgrease 28 Mobil Oil Corp., Shoreham
Wide Temperature Range Building, Washington,
D.C. 20005
Grease, High Temperature Aircraft Marfak All Purpose Texaco Inc., 135 East 42nd St.,
Grease New York, New York 10017
Grease, High & Low Temperature, Aero Lubriplate Fiske Bros. Refining Company,
Waterproof Mag-1 129 Lochwood, Newark,
New Jersey 07105
Lubricating Oil, General Purpose, MIL-L-7870 Caltex Low Temp. Caltex Oil Products Company,
Low Temperature Oil New York, New York
Hydraulic Fluid (Brakes and Shock MIL-H-5606A 3126 Hydraulic Exxon Company, U.S.A. Box 2180,
Struts) Oil Houston, Texas 77001
Grease, Aircraft and Instrument, MIL-G-23827 Supermil Grease American Oil Company, 165 N. Canal,
Gear and Actuator Screw No. A72832 Chicago, lllinois 60606
NOTES
CAUTIONS
– CAUTION –
Do not lubricate control wheel shaft or bushing. Clean only using alcohol
or other uitable solvent.
COMPONENT LUBRICANT FREQUENCY
1. AILERON HINGE PINS MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
2. FLAP HINGE BEARINGS MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
3. STABILTOR HINGE PINS MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
4. RUDDER HINGE BEARINGS MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
5. CONTROL CABLE PULLEYS MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
6. TRIM CONTROL WHEEL MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
7. O-RING, CONTROL SHAFT BUSHING PARKER O-RING*
LUBRICANT AS REQUIRED
8. TEE BAR PIVOT POINT MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
9. CONTROL COLUMN CHAIN MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
10. CONTROL COLUMN FLEX JOINTS AND SPROCKET MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
11. STABILATOR CONTROL MIL-L-7870 100 HRS
Figure 2-19. Lubrication Chart (Cabin Door, Baggage Door and Seat)
Figure 2-20. Lubrication Chart (Lycoming Power Plant, Propeller and Control Pivot Points)
Revised 12/11/78 HANDLING AND SERVICING
1C21
*CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
Figure 2-21. Lubrication Chart (Continental Power Plant, Propeller and Control Pivot Points)
INSPECTION
Paragraph Aerofiche
Grid No.
Revised: 01/31/09
1D1
* CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
SECTION III
INSPECTION
3-1. INTRODUCTION. This section provides instructions for conducting inspections. These inspections are
described in Paragraphs 3-4 and 3-5. Repair or replacement instructions for those components found to be
unserviceable at inspection may be found in the section covering the applicable aircraft system.
CAUTION
When working on engines, ground the magneto primary circuit before
performing any operation.
3-2. RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS. Refer to Recommended Lubricants, Section II for Lubrication
Servicing Instructions.
3-4. INSPECTION REQUIREMENTS. Required inspection procedures are listed in Table III-I. The
inspection procedure is broken down into eight major groups which are Propeller, Engine. Cabin, Fuselage and
Empennage, Wing, Landing Gear, Operational Inspection and General. The first column in each group lists the
inspection or procedure to be performed. The second column is divided into four columns indicating the
required inspection intervals of 50 hours, 100 hours, 500 hours, and 1000 hours. Each inspection of operation
is required at each of the inspection intervals as indicated by a circle (O). If an item is not entirely accessible or
must be removed, refer to the applicable section of this manual for instructions on how to gain access to
remove the item. When performing inspections, use the annual inspection form furnished by the Piper Service
Department, available through Piper Dealers or Distributors.
3-5. PREFLIGHT INSPECTION. This inspection is for the pilot/or mechanic and should become part of the
airplane operational routine and/or preflight inspection before each flight.
a. The propeller blade is free of nicks and the spinner and hub free of cracks or damage.
b. The engine oil is at the proper level.
c. There are no obvious oil leaks.
d. The cowling is clean. There are no loose or missing fasteners and all inspection covers are secured.
e. There are no foreign objects in the engine compartment or obstructions in the air intakes, and cylinder
baffle seals on left and right side are properly positioned. Seals should be rolled up against inner
surface of upper cowl.
f. The tires are properly inflated and not excessively worn or cut.
g. The landing gear oleo struts have proper extension.
h. The brakes are working and there are no obvious leaks.
i. The fuel tanks are full or at a safe level of proper fuel.
j. There are no visible leaks in the fuel system.
k. The fuel tank caps are secure and the vents are open.
1. The fuel tanks and sediment bowls, strainers and lines are free of water and sediment by draining
sumps and strainers.
m. There is no external damage, cracks or operational interference to the control surfaces, wings or
fuselage.
n. The windshield and windows are free of defects and clean.
o. The baggage door latch, hinges, and cabin entrance door and window are free of damage and operate
properly.
p. The seats and seat belts are securely fastened.
q. The landing, navigation, and cabin instrument lights are all operating.
r. The fuel selector valve is operating properly.
s. The throttle, mixture and propeller controls are all operating properly.
t. All systems are operating properly.
3-6. OVERLIMIT INSPECTION. If the airplane has been operated so that any of its components have
exceeded their maximum operational limits, check with the appropriate manufacturer.
3-7. SPECIAL INSPECTIONS. The special inspections given in the following paragraphs, supplement the
scheduled inspections as outlined in the Inspection Report, Table III-I, to include inspection of items which are
required to be examined at intervals not compatible with airframe operating time or airframe inspection
intervals. Typical of this type are:
a. Inspection required because of special conditions or incidents that arise, and because of these
conditions or incidents, an immediate inspection would be required to ensure further safe flight.
b. Inspection of airframe or components on a calendar basis. This type of inspection could often be
accomplished during the nearest scheduled inspection.
c. Specific definitive inspection on engines based strictly upon engine operating time.
d. Those inspections not completely covered in other sections of this manual, but outlined in the
Inspection Report and must be explained in more detail to give a clearer and complete inspection.
—Note—
Perform all inspections or operations at each of the inspection intervals as
indicated by a circle (O). (See Notes at end of report)
29.Inspect condition and operation of fuel pumps (engine driven and electric) ........... O O O
30.Overhaul or replace engine-driven fuel pumps per manufacturer’s
recommendations (Read Note 5) ..............................................................................
31.Overhaul or replace electric fuel pump as required ................................................. O
32.Inspect hoses, wires, clamps, condition, and operation of vacuum pump(s)
(engine-driven and auxiliary electrically-driven) (Read Note 25) ........................... O O O
33.Replace engine or electrically driven vacuum pump(s) (Read Note(s) 5 and 25).... O
34.Inspect throttle, alternate air, mixture, and propeller controls for security, travel,
and operating condition ............................................................................................ O O O
35.Inspect exhaust stacks, connections, and gaskets (Replace gaskets as required) .... O O O O
36.Inspect breather tubes for obstructions and security................................................. O O O
37.Inspect crankcase for cracks, leaks, and security of seam bolts............................... O O O
38.Inspect engine mounts for cracks and loose ............................................................ O O O
39.Inspect rubber engine mount bushings for deterioration (replace as reqd.) or at
engine overhaul ........................................................................................................ O O O
40.Inspect all engine baffles and seals........................................................................... O O O
41.Inspect fire wall seals................................................................................................ O O O
42.Inspect condition of alternator and starter ................................................................ O O O
43.Inspect all lines, hoses, air ducts, electrical leads, and engine attachments for
security, proper routing, chafing, cracks, deterioration and correct installation
(Refer to latest Piper Service Bulletin 561).............................................................. O O O O
44.Check air conditioner compressor oil level (Read Note 13)..................................... O O O
45.Inspect condition and tension of compressor drive belt (Refer to Service
Manual, Section XIV) .............................................................................................. O O O
46.Inspect security of compressor mounting................................................................. O O O
47.Inspect compressor clutch security, wiring, and condition....................................... O O O
48.Check fluid in brake reservoir (Fill as required) ...................................................... O O O O
49.Overhaul or replace propeller governor per manufacturer’s recommendations.
(Refer to latest revision of Hartzell Letter 61)..........................................................
13.Inspect spark plug harness leads and ceramics for corrosion and deposits.............. O O O O
14.Check cylinder compression (Refer to latest revision of Lycoming
Service Instruction 1042).......................................................................................... O O O
15.Inspect cylinders for cracked or broken fins (Read Note 10)................................... O O O
16.Inspect rocker box covers for evidence of oil leaks. If found, replace
gasket(s); Torque cover screws 50 inch-pounds (Read Note 9) ............................... O O O O
NOTE
Lycoming requires a valve inspection after every 400
hours of engine operation. (Read Note 9 )
E. CABIN GROUP
WARNING
Read Note 28 before completing this inspection group.
1. Inspect cabin entrance door and windows for damage, operation, and security ...... O O O O
2. Inspect seats, seat belts, shoulder harness, security brackets and bolts (Read
Note 26) .................................................................................................................... O O O
3. Inspect trim operation............................................................................................... O O O
4. Inspect rudder pedals................................................................................................ O O O
5. Inspect parking brake and brake handle for operation and cylinder leaks................ O O O
6. Inspect control wheels, column, pulleys, chain, and cables (Read Note 23)............ O O O
7. Inspect flap control cable attachment bolt (See latest revision of Piper Service
Bulletin 965)............................................................................................................. O O O
8. Check landing, navigation, cabin, and instrument lights.......................................... O O O O
9. Inspect instruments, lines, and attachments ............................................................. O O O
10.Inspect gyro-operated instruments and electric turn and bank (Overhaul or
replace as required)................................................................................................... O O O
11.Replace instrument central air filter.......................................................................... O O O
12.Inspect or replace vacuum regulator filter................................................................ O O O
13.Check altimeter (Calibrate altimeter system in accordance with FAR 91.170,
if appropriate) (Read Note 11).................................................................................. O O O
G. WlNG GROUP
WARNING
Read Note 28 before completing this inspection group.
1. Inspect oleo struts for proper extension (Refer to Service Manual, Section VII)
(Check all fluid and air levels as required) ............................................................... O O O O
2. Inspect nose gear steering control and travel ........................................................... O O O
3. Inspect wheels for alignment .................................................................................... O O O
4. Lift aircraft on jacks (Refer to Service Manual, Section II) ..................................... O O O
5. Inspect tires for cuts, uneven or excessive wear, and slippage ................................. O O O
6. Remove wheels; clean, inspect, and repack bearings ............................................... O O O
7. Inspect wheels for cracks, corrosion, and broken bolts ............................................ O O O
8. Check tire pressure (Refer to Service Manual, Section II) ....................................... O O O O
9. Inspect brake linings and discs ................................................................................ O O O O
10. Inspect brake backing plates ..................................................................................... O O O
11. Inspect brake and hydraulic lines for leaks, loose fittings, or cracks ....................... O O O
12. Inspect shimmy dampner .......................................................................................... O O O
13. Inspect gear forks for damage .................................................................................. O O O
14. Inspect oleo struts for fluid leaks and scoring .......................................................... O O O
15. Inspect gear struts, attachments, torque links, retraction links, and bolts
for condition and security ........................................................................................ O O O
16. Inspect downlock for operation and adjustment. (Read Note 18) ............................ O O O O
17. Inspect torque link bolts and bushings (Rebush as require) ..................................... O O
18. Inspect drag and side brace link bolts (Replace as required).................................... O
19. Inspect gear doors and attachments ......................................................................... O O O
20. Check warning horn and light for operation ............................................................. O O O
I. OPERATIONAL INSPECTION
J. GENERAL.
NOTES:
1. Refer to last card of the Piper Price List - Aerofiche, for a checklist of current revision dates to Piper
Inspection Reports and Manuals.
2. Piper service bulletins are of special importance and Piper considers compliance mandatory. Piper
service letters are product improvements and service hints pertaining to servicing the airplane and should
be given careful attention.
3. Inspections given for the Lycoming powerplant are based on the engine manufacturer’s operator’s manual
(Lycoming Part No. 60297-12) for this airplane, dated August 1973. Any changes issued to the engine
manufacturer’s operator’s manual after this date shall supersede or supplement the inspection outlined in
this report.
4. Inspections given for the (Continental Part No. X-30512) for this airplane, dated June 1976. Any
changes issued to the engine manufacturer’s operator’s manual after this date shall supersede of
supplement the inspection outlined in this report.
5. Replace as required or at engine overhaul. (Refer to latest revision of Hartzell Service Letter 61.) For
engine overhaul, refer to latest revision of one of the following: Lycoming Service Instructions No. 1009,
for commended engine overhaul period, or Continental Service Bulletin M86-6 Rev. 1 , for
recommended engine overhaul period.
6. Replace flexible oil hoses at three calendar years or 1000 hours, whichever occurs first.
7. Check throttle body attaching screws for tightness; the correct torque for these screws is 40 to 50 inch
pounds
8. Rotate spark plugs form upper to lower positions and vice-versa to lengthen plug service life.
9. At every 400 hours of engine operation, remove the rocker box covers and check for freedom of valve
rockers when valves are closed. Look for evidence of abnormal wear or broken parts in the area of the
valve tips, valve keepers, springs and spring seals. If any indications are found, the cylinder and all of its
components must be removed (including the piston and connecting rod assembly) and inspected for
further damage. Replace any parts that do not conform with limits shown in the latest revision of
Lycoming’s Service Table of Limits No. SSP1776.
10. Check cylinders for evidence of excessive heat which is indicated by burned paint on the cylinders. This
condition is indicative of internal damage to cylinder(s) and, if found, its cause must be determined and
corrected before the aircraft is returned to service. Heavy discoloration and appearance of seepage at the
cylinder head barrel attachment area is usually due to emission of thread lubricant used during assembly
of the barrel at the factory, or by slight gas leakage which stops after the cylinder has been in service for
awhile. This condition is neither harmful nor detrimental to engine performance and operation. If it can
be proven that leakage exceeds these conditions, the cylinder must be replaced.
11. If the altimeter is damaged, defective or inaccurate, work must be done by an FAA approved instrument
repair facility only. A logbook entry must be made.
12. Refer to latest revision of Continental Motors Service Bulletin M84-17.
13. The compressor oil level should not be checked unless the system has been opened, or a Freon leak
occurred which requires an addition of Freon to the system.
14. Aircraft must be blown to check the landing gear system in accordance with instructions outlined in
Section VI, of the Service Manual. (Refer to latest revision of Piper Service Bulletin 810).
15. For operation above 12,000 feet, more frequent ignition system maintenance is required. (Refer to latest
revision of Continental Service Bulletin M78-8).
16. On Continental installations check torque of mounting bolts.
17. Maintain cable tensions specified in Section V of this Service Manual.
STRUCTURES
Paragraph Aerofiche
Grid No.
Revised: 2/13/89
1D17
CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
Aerofiche
Paragraph Grid No.
SECTION IV
STRUCTURES
4-l. INTRODUCTION. This section explains the removal and installation procedures for the structural
surfaces of the airplane. For the removal, installation, and rigging and adjustment procedures of the controlling
components of the various structural surfaces, refer to Section V.
NOTE
When torquing structural assemblies, standard torque values are to be used
as found in Section II or FAA Advisory Circular 43.13-1A, unless otherwise
stated in this section.
4-2. DESCRIPTION. The aircrafts are all metal semi-monocoque structure with overall lengths of 24 feet 8.16
inches for the PA-28R-201 and 25 feet for the PA-28R-201T. The fuselage is constructed of bulkheads, stringer
and stiffeners, to which all of the outer skin is riveted. Windows include a single pane windshield and six side
windows. A11 windows are single pane. A storm window is located in the forward lower section of the left
window and can be opened inward when the latch is released. The cabin entrance door is located on the right
side of the fuselage, above the wing, and is equipped with a safety latch on the top of the door, which can be
operated from the inside or outside. A door provided for entrance to the baggage compartment is located just
aft of the right wing with a key lock installed.
Each wing panel is an all metal, full cantilever semi-monocoque type construction with a removable wing
tip. Installed in each wing ahead of the main spar is a metal fuel tank with a capacity of 38.5 U.S. gallons each
or 77 U.S. gallons total. Attached to each wing is an aileron, flap and main landing gear. The wings are
attached to each side of the fuselage by inserting the butt ends of the main spars into a spar box carry-through.
The spar box is an integral part of the fuselage structure which provides, in effect, a continuous main spar with
splices at each side of the fuselage. There are also fore and aft attachments at the front and rear spars.
The all metal empennage group is a full cantilever design consisting of a vertical stabilizer (fin), rudder
and stabilator, all with removable tips. The stabilator has a trim tab attached that is controllable from the
cockpit. The stabilator also incorporates one channel main spar that runs the full length of the stabilator and
hinges to the aft bulkhead assembly of the fuselage. All exterior surfaces are coated with enamel or acrylic
lacquer. As an option the airplane may be completely primed with zinc chromate.
4-7. AILERON.
4-13. WING.
o. If the left wing is being removed, it will be necessary to disconnect pitot tube at the elbow located
within the cockpit at the wing butt line.
p. Arrange a suitable fuselage cradle and supports for both wings.
q. Remove the wing jacks.
r. Remove the front and rear spar nuts, washers and bolts.
s. Remove the eighteen main spar bolts.
t. Slowly remove the wing being certain that all electrical leads, cables and lines are disconnected.
q. Service and refill the brake system with hydraulic fluid in accordance with Servicing Brake System,
Section II. Bleed the system as given in Section VII and check for fluid leaks.
r. Check the fluid level of the landing gear hydraulic system and fill in accordance with Servicing
Hydraulic Pump/Reservoir, Section II. With the airplane setting on jacks, operate the gear through
several retraction and extension cycles to be certain that there are no hydraulic leaks. Bleed the
hydraulic system in accordance with Section VI.
s. Service and fill the fuel system in accordance with Servicing Fuel System, Section II. Open the fuel
valve and check for leaks and flow.
t. Check the operation of all electrical equipment and pitot systems.
u. Remove the airplane from jacks.
v. Install the cockpit trim panel assembly, spar box carpet, the front and back seats and wing root rubber.
w. Replace all the access plates and panels on the wing involved.
4-17. STABILATOR.
NOTE
Should it be necessary to move the rudder to its extreme left or right for
clearance, do so with the use of the rudder pedals or tow bar.
a. Remove the screws from around the upper and lower tail cone fairing assembly and remove the fairing
separately.
b. Block the trim cable at the barrel of the trim screw assembly to prevent the cable from unwrapping.
c. Remove the access panel to the aft section of the fuselage located at the back wall of the baggage
compartment.
d. Install cable blocks as illustrated in Figure 4-3 on the stabilator trim control cable at the first set of
pulleys forward of the cable turnbuckles to prevent the forward cable form unwrapping.
e. Disconnect the trim cables at the turnbuckles within the aft section of the fuselage.
f. Relieve tension from the stabilator control cables by loosening one of the cable turnbuckles in the aft
section of the fuselage.
g. Disconnect the stabilator control cables from the stabilator balance arm by removing cotter pins, nuts,
washers, bushings and clevis bolts.
h. Disconnect the trim assembly from the aft bulkhead of the fuselage by removing the attaching nuts,
washers and bolts of the horizontal and diagonal support brackets.
i. Move the trim assembly up through the tail cone fairing cutout in the stabilator and remove, with
cable, from the airplane.
j. Remove the stabilator by disconnecting the stabilator at its hinge points.
NOTE
A clearance of .25 +/- .06 of an inch between the stabilator and the side of
the fuselage and .18 of an inch minimum between all parts of the stabilator
and the tail cone assembly must be maintained throughout the stabilator
travel. Use a proper washer combination on the stabilator hinges to attain
the necessary tolerances.
a. Insert the stabilator in position and install attaching hinge bolts, washers and nuts.
b. Move the trim assembly through the cutout in the stabilator and attach the brackets of the assembly to
the aft bulkhead with bolts, washers and nuts. Insert the trim cable ends into the fuselage.
c. Attach the stabilator control cables to the stabilator balance arm with clevis bolts, bushings, washers,
nuts and cotter pins.
d. Connect the ends of the fore and aft trim cables at the turnbuckles within the aft section of the
fuselage.
e. Remove the cable block from the trim control cable within the fuselage.
f. Set the stabilator control cable tension and check rigging and adjustment according to Rigging and
Adjustment of Stabilator, Section V.
g. Remove the cable blocks from the trim cable at the barrel of the trim screw assembly.
h. Set stabilator trim control cable tension and check rigging and adjustment according to Rigging and
Adjustment of Stabilator Trim, Section V.
i. Remove the pad from the aft section of the fuselage and replace the access panel.
j. Install the tail cone fairing and remove tail stand.
4-23. RUDDER.
4-30. WINDSHIELD.
4-42. ADJUSTMENT OF DOOR LATCH MECHANISM. To adjust the door latch, loosen the screws on the
striker plate, make necessary adjustment, and retighten the screws.
4-48.BAGGAGE DOOR.
4-49. REMOVAL OF BAGGAGE DOOR. With the door open remove the hinge pin from the hinge and
remove the door.
4-50.INSTALLATION OF BAGGAGE DOOR. Place the door in position so that the hinge halves are properly
matched and install the hinge pin. It will not be necessary to replace the hinge pin with a new pin if it is free of
bends and wear.
4-51.REMOVAL OF BAGGAGE DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
a. With the door open remove the nut from the back of the lock assembly by use of a special made
wrench. (This tool may be fabricated from the dimensions given in Figure 4-8.)
b. Remove the lock assembly through the front of the door.
4-52. INSTALLATION OF BAGGAGE DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY.
a. Place the lock into position for installation.
b. Install the nut on the lock assembly and tighten with the use of a special wrench.
WARNING
The use of patch plates for repairs of all movable tail surfaces is prohibited.
The use of any filler material normally used for repair of minor dents
and/or materials used for filling the inside of surfaces is also prohibited on
all movable tail surfaces.
Revised: 10/18/83 STRUCTURES
1E14
CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
21.80”
FORWARD
14.99”
2.28” R
CL
TYP
2.00” R
TYP;M
0.120” HOLE THRU
N0.8 X 38 CRES TRUSS
RECESSED HEAD SHEET
METAL SCREWS (16 REQD.)
2.50”
COVER (2 REQD)
30° TYP PIPER P/N 62109-0
10.98”
8.48”
AFT
19.11”
4-56. FIBERGLASS REPAIRS. The repair procedure in this manual will describe the methods for repair of
fiberglass reinforced structures. Paragraph 4-57 describes Fiberglass Touch-Up and Surface Repairs such as
blisters, open seams, delamination, cavities, small holes and minor damages that have not harmed the
fiberglass cloth material. Paragraph 4-58 describes Fiberglass Fracture and Patch Repairs as puncture, breaks
and holes that have penetrated through the structure and damaged the fiberglass cloth. A repair kit, part
number 756 729 will furnish necessary material for such repairs, and is available through Piper Aircraft
Dealers.
NOTE
Very carefully follow resin and catalyst mixing instructions furnished with
repair kit.
4-57. FIBERGLASS TOUCH-UP AND SURFACE REPAIRS.
a. Remove wax, oil and dirt from around the damaged area with acetone, Methylethylketone or
equivalent and remove paint to gel coat.
b. The damaged area may be scraped with a fine blade knife or a power drill with a burr attachment to
roughen the bottom and sides of the damaged area. Feather the edge surrounding the scratch or cavity.
Do not undercut the edge. (If the scratch or cavity is shallow and penetrates only the surface coat,
continue to Step h.)
c. Pour a small amount of resin into a jar lid or on a piece of cardboard, just enough to fill the area being
worked on. Mix an equal amount of milled fiberglass with the resin, using a putty knife or stick. Add
catalyst, according to kit instruction, to the resin and mix thoroughly. A hypodermic needle may be
used to inject gel into small cavities not requiring fiberglass millings mixed with the gel.
d. Work the mixture of resin, fibers and catalyst into the damaged area, using the sharp point of a putty
knife or stick to press it into the bottom of the hole and to puncture any air bubbles which may be
present. Fill the scratch or hole above the surrounding undamaged area about 1/ 16 inch.
e. Lay a piece of cellophane or waxed paper over the repair to cut off air and start the cure of gel mixture.
f. Allow the gel to cure 10 to 15 minutes until it feels rubbery to the touch . Remove the cellophane and
trim flush with the surface, using a sharp razor blade or knife. Replace the cellophane and allow to
cure completely for 30 minutes to an hour. The patch will shrink slightly below the structure surface as
it cures. (If wax paper is used, ascertain wax is removed from surface.)
g. Rough up the bottom and edges of the hole with the electric burr attachment or rough sand paper.
Feather hole into surrounding gel coat, do not undercut.
h. Pour out a small amount of resin, add catalyst and mix thoroughly, using a cutting motion rather than
stirring. Use no fibers.
i. Using the tip of a putty knife or finger tips, fill the hole at about 1/16 inch above the surrounding
surface with the gel coat mixture.
j. Lay a piece of cellophane over the patch to start the curing process. Repeat Step f, trimming patch
when partially cured.
k. After trimming the patch, immediately place another small amount of gel coat on one edge of the patch
and cover with cellophane. Then, using a squeegee or the back of a razor blade, squeegee level with
area surrounding the patch, leave the cellophane on patch for one or two hours or overnight, for
complete cure.
1. After repair has cured for 24 hours, sand patched the area using a sanding block with fine wet
sandpaper. Finish by priming, again sanding and applying color coat.
4-59.THERMOPLASTIC REPAIRS. Refer to Borg-Warner manual part number PB-160A for repairs to
thermoplastic.
Borg-Warner Chemicals
Washington, West Virginia 26181
4-61.SURFACE PREPARATION.
a. Clean all surfaces with a suitable cleaning solvent to remove dirt, grease and oils. Solvents may be
applied by dipping, spraying or mapping.
b. Insure that no moisture remains on the surface by wiping with a clean dry cloth.
c. Outline the area to which the liquid safety walk compound is to be applied, and mask adjacent
surfaces.
NOTE
Newly painted surfaces, shall be allowed to dry for 2.5 hours minimum prior
to the application of the safety walk.
4-62.PRODUCT LISTING FOR LIQUID SAFETY WALK COMPOUND.
a. Suggested Solvents:
Safety Solvent per MIL-S-18718
Sherwin Williams Lacquer Thinner R7KC120
Glidden Thinner No. 207
b. Safety Walk Material:
Walkway Compound and Matting, Nonslip (included in Piper Part No. 179 872)
4-63. APPLICATION OF LIQUID SAFETY WALK COMPOUND. Liquid safety walk compound shall be
applied in an area free of moisture for a period of 24 hours minimum after application. Do not apply when
surface to be coated is below 50°F. Apply liquid safety walk compound as follows:
a. Mix and thin the liquid safety walk compound in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions on
the container.
b. Coat the specified surfaces with a smooth, unbroken film of the liquid safety walk compound. A nap
type roller or a stiff bristle brush is recommended, using fore and aft strokes.
c. Allow the coating to dry for 15 minutes to one hour before recoating or touch-up; if required after
application of the initial coating.
d. After recoating or touch-up; if done, allow the coating to dry for 15 minutes to one hour before
removing masking.
NOTE
The coated surface shall not be walked on for six hours minimum after
application of final coating.
4-65. CHECKING CONTROL SURFACE BALANCE. The movable control surfaces have been statically
balanced at the time of installation at the factory and normally should not require rebalancing. Where possible
the control surfaces where set with the balance weight on the heavy side of the limits, to permit limited repair
or paint touch-up without adjusting the balance weight. It should be noted however, that spar control surfaces
are delivered unpainted and the static balance will not necessarily fall within the limits provided, this is more
pronounced on the stabilators and rudders. The completed control surface, including paint, should be within
the limits given in Table IV-I. If the surface is not to be painted, the balance weight will probably require
adjustment. All replacement control surfaces, or surfaces that have been repainted or repaired, should be
rebalanced according to the procedures given in Paragraphs 4-65 thru 4-70. The static balance of the surfaces
must be as specified in Table IV-I.
Before balancing any control surface, it must be complete including tip, trim/servo tabs and tab actuating
arms or push rods with bearings as applicable, and all optional equipment which is mounted on or in the
control surface when it is flown, including paint, position lights and wiring, static wicks, scuff boots, etc.
If optional equipment is added or removed after balancing, the control surface must be rebalanced. During
balancing, trim/servo tabs must be maintained in their neutral positions.
4-66. CHECKING CONTROL SURFACES FREE PLAY. The following checks are recommended before
balancing to ascertain the amount of “free play” in the stabilator, stabilator trim tab and aileron:
a. Stabilator: Check the stabilator for any “free play” at its attachment points by grasping each half near
the tip and gently trying to move it up and down, fore and aft, and in and out. No play is allowed.
b. Stabilator Trim Tab: Set the stabilator trim tab in neutral position. This neutral position is determined
with the airplane properly rigged per instructions given in Section V of this Service Manual and the
trim indicator at its neutral position. Obtain a straightedge long enough to extend from the ground up
to a few inches above the trim tab trailing edge. Place the straightedge next to the trim tab inboard
(center) trailing edge, secure the stabilator in neutral and grasping the tab, gently move it up and down,
mark the limit of tab free play on the straightedge. The overall travel (free play) must not exceed 0.15
of an inch. The use of a dial indicator and fixed stand in recommended.
c. Aileron: Set the aileron in its neutral position and secure. Obtain a straightedge long enough to extend
from the ground up to a few inches above the ai1eron trailing edge. Place the straightedge next to the
aileron trailing edge and gently move the aileron up and down, mark the limit of travel (free play) on
the straightedge. The overall travel (free play) must not exceed 0.24 of an inch. Should free play
exceed the limit stated make necessary repairs as required to eliminate excessive free play.
4-67. BALANCING EQUIPMENT. (Refer to Figure 4-9.) The balancing must be done using a suitable tool
capable of measuring unbalance in inch-pounds from the centerline of the control surface hinge pin. A
suggested tool configuration is shown in Figure 4-9. Other tool configurations may be used, provided accuracy
is maintained and recalibration capability is provided. The tool shown in Figure 4-9 may be calibrated by
placing it on the control surface to be balanced with the balance points over the control surface hinge
centerline and the balance bar parallel to the cord line. Position the trailing edge support to align the tool with
the control surface cord line and secure in this position. Remove the tool without disturbing the trailing edge
support and balance the tool by adding weight to the light end as required. (The movable weight must be at the
centerline.) Place the tool on the control surface perpendicular to the hinge centerline as shown in Figures 4-
10, 4-11 and 4-13. Read the scale when the bubble level has been centered by adjustment of the movable
weight.
4-68. BALANCING AILERONS. (Refer to Figure 4-10.) Position the aileron on the balancing fixture in a
draft free area and in a manner which allows unrestricted movement of the aileron on the hinges. Place the tool
on the aileron, avoid rivets and keep the beam perpendicular to the hinge centerline. Calibrate the tool as
described in Paragraph 4-67. Read the scale when the bubble level has been centered by adjustment of the
movable weight and determine the static balance. If the static balance is not within the limits specified in Table
IV-I, proceed as follows:
a. Leading Edge Heavy: This condition is highly improbable; recheck measurements and calculations.
b. Trailing Edge Heavy: There are no provisions for adding weight to balance weight to counteract a
trailing edge heavy condition; therefore, it will be necessary to determine the exact cause of the
unbalance. If the aileron is too heavy because of painting over old paint, it will be necessary to strip all
paint from the aileron and repaint. If the aileron is too heavy resulting from repair to the skin or ribs, it
will be necessary to replace all damaged parts and recheck the balance.
4-69. BALANCING RUDDER. (Refer to Figure 4-11.) To balance the rudder, the assembly must be complete
including the tip assembly and all attaching screws, the position light and wiring must be included. Place the
complete assembly horizontally on knife edge supports in a draft free area in a manner that allows unrestricted
movement. Place the tool on the rudder with the beam perpendicular to the hinge centerline. Calibrate the tool
as described in Paragraph 4-67. Read the scale when the bubble level has been centered by adjustment of the
movable weight and determine the static balance limit. If the static balance is not within the limits given in
Table IV-I, proceed as follows:
a. Nose Heavy: This condition is highly improbable; recheck calculations and measurements.
b. Nose Light: In this case, the mass balance weight is too light or the rudder is too heavy because of
painting; it will be necessary to strip the paint and repaint. If the rudder is too heavy as a result of
repairs, the repair must be removed and the damaged parts replaced.
4-70. BALANCING STABILATOR. (Refer to Figure 4-13.) To balance the stabilator, the assembly must be
complete including the trim tab, the tab push rod and end bearing, stabilator tips and all attaching screws.
Before balancing, tape the trim tab in neutral position with a small piece of tape. Place the complete assembly
on the knife edge supports in a draft free beam perpendicular to the hinge centerline. Do not place the tool on
the trim tab. Calibrate the tool as described in Paragraph 4-67. Read the scale when the bubble level has been
centered by adjustment of the movable weight and determine the static balance limit. If the static balance is not
within the limits given in Table IV-I, proceed as follows:
a. If the stabilator is out of limits on the leading edge heavy side, remove balance plates from the mass
balance weight until the static balance is within limits.
b. If the stabilator is out of limits on the trailing edge heavy side, add balance plates to the mass balance
weight until the static balance is within limits.
TABLE IV-II
Types of clamps
Types of hose
Worm screw type All other types
Self sealing Finger-tight-plus Finger-tight-plus
2 complete turns 2 1/2 complete turns
All other hose Finger-tight-plus Finger-tight-plus
1 1/4 complete turns 2 complete turns
lf clamps do not seal at specified tightening, examine hose connection and replace parts as necessary.
4-72.STANDARDS.
4-73 TORQUE WRENCHES Torque wrenches should be checked daily and calibrated by means of weights
and a measured lever arm to make sure that inaccuracies are not present. Checking one torque wrench against
another is not sufficient and is not recommended. Some wrenches are quite sensitive as to the way they are
supported during a tightening operation. Any instructions furnished by the manufacturer must be followed
explicitly
When it is necessary to use a special extension or adapter wrench with a torque wrench, a simple
mathematical equation must be worked out to arrive at the correct torque reading. Following is the formula to
be used: (Refer to Figure 4-16.)
T = Torque desired at the part
A = Basic lever length from center of wrench shank to center of handle or stamped on wrench or listed for
that model wrench.
B = Length of adapter extension center of bolt to center of shank.
C = Scale reading needed to obtain desired torque (T).
A+T
The formula C =
A+B
EXAMPLE
A bolt requires 30 foot-pounds and a 3 inch adapter(one-quarter of
a foot or .25’) is needed to get at it. You want to know what scale
reading it will take on a one-foot lever arm wrench to obtain the 30
foot-pounds at the bolt.
1 x 30 30
C= or C = = 24 ft.-lbs.
1+.25 1.25
Remember the 3 inch adapter must be projecting 3 inches straight
along the wrench axis. In general, avoid all complex assemblages
or adapters and extensions of flex joints.
SURFACE CONTROLS
Paragraph Aerofiche
Grid No.
Revised: 2/13/89
1F6
* CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
SECTION V
SURFACE CONTROLS
5-1. INTRODUCTION. This section contains the explanation for the removal, installation, rigging and
adjustment procedures for the control assemblies of the various structural surfaces. For the removal and
installation of the structural surfaces of the airplane, refer to Section IV. The assemblies need not be removed
in order of paragraphs since each paragraph describes the individual removal and installation of the
component.
5-2. DESCRIPTION. The airplane is controlled in flight by the use of three standard primary control surfaces,
consisting of the ailerons, stabilator and rudder. Operation of these controls is through the movement of the
dual control columns and dual rudder pedals. The individual surfaces are connected to their control
components through the use of cables and push-pull tubes. Provision for directional and longitudinal trim
control is provided by an adjustable trim mechanism for the rudder and stabilator. The flaps are mechanically
operated and can be positioned in four locations of 0, 10, 25 and 40 degrees.
The aileron controls consist of two-control wheels connected by torque tubes to sprockets on each end of
the horizontal control column. A chain is wrapped around the sprockets and around a double sprocket on the
vertical post of the control column. The chain is connected to the primary aileron control cable which is routed
through the center of the fuselage to the main spar and out through the wings to a bellcrank in each wing. A
balance cable is also connected to the bellcrank. As the control wheels are moved, the control cables move the
bellcranks and actuate push-pull rods to move the ailerons.
The stabilator controls are also connected to the control column. From the connecting point, cables are
routed around a series of pulleys down under the floor and aft to the tail section of the airplane. The aft end of
the cables connect to the stabilator balance arm which in turn is connected to the stabilator. When the control
wheels are moved forward or aft, the cables move the balance arm up and down rotating the stabilator on its
hinge points.
The rudder is controlled by the pilot’s and co-pilot’s rudder pedals. Cables are connected to both sides of
the rudder pedal assembly and are routed aft through the bottom of the fuselage to the rudder horn. When one
rudder pedal is pushed, the cables move in opposite directions turning the rudder horn and rudder. The wing
flap system is operated by a lever located between the front seats.
For a visual description of the various control systems, refer to the illustrated figures throughout this
section.
5-3. STANDARD PROCEDURES. The following tips may be helpful in the removal, installation and rigging
of the various assemblies:
a. It is recommended, though not always necessary to level and place the airplane on jacks during rigging
and adjustment.
b. Remove turnbuckle barrels from cable ends before withdrawing the cables through the structures.
c. Tie a cord to the cable end before withdrawing the cable through the structures to facilitate
reinstallation of cable.
d. Turnbuckle stations are given at their neutral positions.
e. When referring to marking cable end, etc., before disconnecting a felt marking pen may be used.
f. Assemble and adjust the turnbuckles so that each terminal is screwed an approximately equal distance
into the barrel. Do not turn the terminals in such a manner that will put a permanent “twist” into the
cables.
g. Cable tensions should be taken with the appropriate control surface in its neutral position.
h. After completion of each adjustment, check the turnbuckles to be sure not more than three terminal
threads are visible outside the barrel. Install the locking clips, and check for proper installation by
turning to remove the clips using fingers only. Both locking clips may be installed in opposite holes.
Locking clips which have been installed and removed must be scrapped and not reused.
i. When push rods or rod ends are provided with an inspection hole, the screw must be screwed in far
enough to pass the inspection hole. This can be determined visually or by feel inserting a piece of wire
into the inspection hole. If no hole is provided, there must be a minimum of .375 of an inch thread
engagement.
j. After completion of adjustments, each jam nut must be tightened securely. (Refer to Figure 5-la for
proper installation method).
k. Torque all nuts in the flight control surface rigging system (including nose wheel steering) in
accordance with Table II-II, Recommended Nut Torques.
NOTE
Cable rigging tensions specified must be corrected to ambient temperature
in the area where the tension is being checked, using Table V-II.
5-4. CONTROL COLUMN ASSEMBLY.
NOTE
Examine cables for broken strands by wiping the cable along its length.
Visually check for damage. Replace all damaged cables.
5-9. INSTALLATION OF AILERON CONTROL CABLES. (Refer to Figure 5-2.)
a. The installation of either the right or left primary control cable (14 or 15) that is located in the fuselage
may be accomplished as follows:
1. Draw the cable through the fuselage floor tunnel.
2. Connect the cable to the end of the control chain (4) and secure using bushings, bolt, nut and cotter
pin (23).
3. Place the cable around the pulley (9) that is located in the tunnel aft of the tee bar.
4. Position cables and install the cable pulleys (8) that attach to the lower section of the tee bar
assembly. Secure with bolt, washer and nut (21).
5. Place the cable around the pulley (10) that is located within access opening just aft of the main spar.
6. If the primary control cable in the wing is installed, connect the control cable ends at the turnbuckle
(12 or 16) located within access opening just aft of the main spar. Apply partial tension to cable to
keep it positioned on pulleys.
7. Install cable guard (20) on pulley (9) and secure with a cotter pin.
8. Install cotter pin cable guard on pulley (10).
9. Check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-12.
10. Install the floor tunnel plate trim covers by placing the tunnel plate into position for installation and
secure with attachment screws. Roll the carpet into place and install the rudder trim cover and knob.
b. The primary control cable (13 or 17) in either wing may be installed by the following procedure:
1. Draw the control cable into the wing.
2. Connect the cable to the forward end of the aileron bellcrank (6) using a bolt, washer, nut and cotter
pin. Allow the cable end to rotate freely on the bellcrank.
3. If the primary control cable in the fuselage is installed, connect the ends at the turnbuckle (12 or 16)
located under the rear seat aft of the main spar. Apply partial tension to cable to keep it from
slipping off of pulleys (28 and 29).
4. Install cable guard (31) on pulley (28).
5. Check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-12.
6. Install the access plate on the underside of the wing.
c. Either balance cable (18 or 19) may be installed by the following procedure:
1. Draw the cable into the wing.
2. Connect the cable to the aft end of the aileron bellcrank (6) using a bolt, washer, nut and cotter pin.
Allow the cable end to rotate freely on the bellcrank.
3. Connect the balance cable ends at the turnbuckle (24) that is located under the rear seat aft of the
main spar. Apply partial tension to cable to keep it positioned on pulley (11).
4. If the left cable was removed, install the cotter pin cable guard (32) at the pulley (11) located within
the fuselage, aft of the main spar.
5. Check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-12.
6. Install the access plate on the underside of the wing.
d. Replace the rear seat floor panel and seats.
f. Remove the nut, pivot bolt (25) and washers that secure the bellcrank. The nut is visible from the
underside of the wing.
g. Remove the bellcrank from within the wing.
5-12. RIGGING AND ADJUSTMENT OF AILERON CONTROLS. (Refer to Figures 5-3 thru 5-4.)
NOTE
Flap adjustment must be complete before starting aileron adjustment.
a. To check and adjust the rigging of the aileron controls, first set the right and left aileron bellcranks at
neutral position. (Ascertain that the control chains have been rigged per Paragraph 5-6.) This may be
accomplished by the following procedure:
l. Place tee bar in full forward position, and maintain it in this position by use of a suitable tool or
by placing weights on the aft side of the stabilator if the stabilator cables have been previously
tensioned.
2. Remove the access plate to each aileron bellcrank located on the underside of the wing, forward of
the inboard end of the aileron by removing the plate attaching screws.
3. Affix a bellcrank rigging tool, as shown in Figure 5-3, between the forward arm of each bellcrank
and the adjacent outboard rib. (This tool may be fabricated from dimensions given in Figure 5-18.)
The slotted end of the tool fits on the arm forward of and adjacent to the primary control cable
end. The other end of the tool is positioned so that the side of the tool contacts the aft side of the
bellcrank stop. The bellcrank must be moved to allow a snug fit of the tool between the bellcrank
arm and rib. To do so, it may be necessary to loosen a primary control cable or the balance cable.
Neutral position of the bellcranks may also be found by locating the position at which the forward
and aft cable connection holes are an equal distance from the adjacent outboard wing rib.
b. With each bellcrank set at neutral, the ailerons may be checked and adjusted for neutral as follows:
1. Ascertain that the bellcrank rigging tool fits snug between the bellcrank and the rib.
2. Place an aileron rigging tool as shown in Figure 5-4 against the underside of the wing and aileron
as close as possible to the inboard end of the aileron without contacting any rivets. The tool must
be positioned parallel with the wing ribs, with the aft end of the tool even with the trailing edge of
the aileron. (This tool may be fabricated from dimensions given in Figure 5-19.)
3. With the aileron control rod connected between the bellcrank and aileron, check that the surface of
the wing contacts the tool at its forward surface and at the spacer, and the trailing edge of the flap
contacts the aft end of the tool. The aileron is neutral at this position.
4. Should the three points not contact; loosen the jam nut at the aft end of the control rod and rotate
the rod until the three points contact. Apply a slight up pressure against the trailing edge of the
aileron while making this adjustment. The aileron may be allowed to “droop” by approximately
1/8’’ of an inch at the inboard trailing edge. After adjustment, retighten the jam nut.
c. Adjust primary and balance cable tension as given in Table V-l by the following procedure:
1. Remove the two front seats, if desired, and the rear seat floor panel to facilitate in the necessary
operation.
2. Loosen the connecting bolts of the idler cross-over sprockets at the control tee bar to allow the
chain to fit snug around the control wheel sprockets and over the idler sprockets.
3. Ascertain that both bellcranks are at neutral position.
4. Adjust the turnbuckles, located in the access opening just aft of the main spar, of the primary and
balance cables to their proper cable tension and maintain neutral-center position of the control
wheels. Primary cable tension will be slightly less than balance cable tension, but still should be
within the tension specified. Adjust the cables so that the inboard end of the ailerons visually lines
up with the outboard end of the flap when a slight up pressure is applied to the middle of the
aileron to take the slack out of the hinge and linkage. To obtain neutral position of both control
wheels, it may also be necessary to adjust the roller chain turnbuckle located between the control
wheel sprockets. During adjustment, obtain a little more tension oh the primary control cables to
hold the bellcranks in neutral against the rigging tools, finishing with even tension on all cables.
Figure 5-4. Aileron Rigging Tool Figure 5-5. Stabilator Rigging Tool
g. Check complete system for safety of turnbuckle, bolts, and smooth operation without binding or chafing.
h. Install access plates and panels.
9. Install the floor tunnel plate and trim covers by placing the tunnel plate into position for
installation and secure with the attaching screws. Roll the carpet into place and install the rudder
trim cover and knob.
10. Install the front seats and rear seat floor panel.
b. Either aft stabilator control cable (4 or 5) may be installed by the following procedure:
1. Route the cable (4 or 5) around its pulley (7) located either over or under the balance arm (18) of
the stabilator.
2. Connect the cable to the stabilator balance arm and secure with bolt, washer, nut and cotter pin (8).
(Insure bushing is installed with bolt.)
3. Connect the cable to the forward cable at the turnbuckle (16) in the aft section of the fuselage. The
upper aft cable (5) connect to the right forward cable (2) and the lower cable (4) to the left cable
(3).
4. Install the cotter pin cable guard at the pulley (7), where required.
5. Set cable tension and check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-17.
6. Install the seats and access panels.
7. With the tension of the upper cable correct and the control wheel still forward, adjust the
turnbuckle of the lower cable to obtain correct tension.
8. Check the full travel of the control wheel with relation to the full travel of the stabilator to
determine that the stabilator contacts its stops before the control wheel contacts its stops. With the
control wheel in the fore and aft positions, the travel distance from the point where the stabilator
contacts its stops and the control wheel contacts its stops should be approximately equal. Readjust
turnbuckles if incorrect.
9. Reinstall access panels.
d. Remove the airplane from jacks.
4. The wheel and drum are joined by a push fit, separate these two items with their center bushing and
unwrap the right cable (8).
5. Tie the cables forward to prevent them from slipping back into the floor tunnel.
e. The trim control cables (8 and 9) may be removed by the following procedure:
1. Remove the rear seat and the front seats, if desired.
2. Unfasten the carpet from the aft portion of the floor tunnel and lay it forward.
3. Remove the tunnel cover located between the trim control wheel and the spar cover by removing
attaching screws.
4. Remove the cable pulleys (6) located in the tunnel by removing the cotter pin, washer and clevis pin
(5).
5. Remove the cable rub blocks (37) located on the aft side of the main spar by removing the block
attaching screws.
6. Remove the cable guard pin (36) at the pulley cluster (34) located just aft of the wing flap torque
tube at station 127.25.
7. If installed, remove the cable pulleys (33) within the aft section of the fuselage at station 156.5 by
removing nut, washer, bushing and bolt.
8. With the cables disconnected from the trim control wheel, draw the cable(s) through the floor tunnel.
NOTE
Examine cables for broken strands by wiping the cable along its length.
Visually check for damage. Replace all damaged cables.
5-19. INSTALLATION OF STABILATOR TRIM ASSEMBLY. (FORWARD) (Refer to Figure 5-8.)
a. The trim control wheel with drum may be installed by the following procedure:
1. Wrap the right trim cable on the trim drum by inserting the swaged ball of the cable in the slot
provided in the side (right side) of the drum that mates with the control wheel, and looking at this
side, wrap the drum with three wraps of the cable in a clockwise direction.
2. Attach the control wheel to the cable drum by aligning the long lug of the drum with the long slot of
the wheel and pushing the two pieces together.
3. Wrap the left trim cable on the drum by inserting the swaged ball of the cable in the slot provided in
the flanged side (left side) of the drum and looking at this side, wrap the drum with three wraps of
the cable in a clockwise direction.
4. Lubricate and install the bushing in the control wheel and drum.
5. Align the control cables and position the control wheel assembly between its mounting brackets.
Ascertain that the end of the trim indicator wire is positioned in the spiraled slot of the drum with no
bind on the end. Install the retainer bolt from the left side and install washer and nut.
6. Install the cover over the control wheel and secure with screws, unless the control cables have yet to
be installed.
b. The trim control cables may be installed by the following procedure:
1. Draw the cable(s) through the floor tunnel.
2. Wrap the cable drum and install the trim control wheel as given in Step a.
3. Position the cable pulleys on their mounting bracket within the floor tunnel and install the clevis pin,
washer and cotter pin.
4. Connect the cable to the aft cable at the turnbuckle in the aft section of the fuselage. Install aft cable
if not installed.
5. If previously installed, install the pulleys in the aft lower section of the fuselage at station 156.5
forward of the cable turnbuckles. Apply partial tension to cable to keep it positioned on pulleys.
6. Install the cable guard at the underside of the pulleys located just aft of the flap torque tube at station
127.25 and secure.
7. Install the cable rub blocks located on the aft side of the main spar housing and secure with screws.
8. Remove the blocks that secure the aft trim cable and check that the cables are seated on their pulleys.
c. Set cable tension and check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-22. Check safety of all turnbuckles.
d. Install the tunnel cover on the tunnel and secure with screws.
e. Install the carpet over the floor tunnel.
f. Install the cover over the trim control wheel and secure with screws and special washers.
g. Install the floor panel and seat belt attachments aft of the main spar and secure panel with screws.
h. Install the panel to the aft section of the airplane and the seats.
5-24. REMOVAL OF RUDDER AND STEERING PEDAL ASSEMBLY. (Refer to Figure 5-9.)
a. Remove the access panel to the aft section of the fuselage.
b. Relieve rudder and stabilator cable tension by loosening one of the rudder and stabilator cable turnbuckles
in the aft section of the fuselage.
c. Remove the tunnel plate located just aft of the tee bar assembly by removing the rudder trim control knob,
trim cover attaching screws and trim cover. Roll back the carpet from the tunnel and remove the tunnel
plate that is located just aft of the tee bar assembly by removing the plate attaching screws.
d. Disconnect the stabilator control cable from the lower end of the tee bar assembly.
e. Remove the tee bar attaching bolts with their washers and nuts which are through each side of the floor
tunnel. Pull the lower end of the tee bar aft.
f. Disconnect the control cable (19) ends from the arms on the torque tube (3) by removing the cotter pins,
washers, nuts and bolts (20).
g. Disconnect the rudder trim from the torque tube assembly by removing the cotter pin, washers and bolt
that connects the arm to the trim. Remove the cotter pin and clevis pin from the rudder trim mechanism
and remove the mechanism from the mounting channel. Remove the screw from the engine control
bracket assembly and swing it out of the way. Disconnect the alternate air cable and move aside.
h. Disconnect the steering rods (21) at the rudder (32 and 33) by removing nuts and bolts (24).
i. Disconnect the brake cylinders (12) at the lower end of each cylinder rod (11) by removing the cotter pins,
washers, nut and bolts (20).
j. Disconnect the vee brace(s) (29) (two braces are used with right hand brakes) from the torque tube by
removing nuts, washers and bolts (27) that secure the strap bracket (28) to the vee brace.
k. Disconnect the torque tube support bracket (35) where it attaches by removing the two bolts attached
to the box located beneath, and the four bolts attached to the forward bulkhead.
1. Remove the two bolts (25 and 26) that extend through the torque tube and are located at the center of
the tube assembly over the floor tunnel. Compress the tubes. Remove the left and right toe brake pedal
assembly.
m. Disconnect the torque tube support blocks (7 and 8) from their support brackets on each side of the
fuselage by removing the attaching nuts, washers and bolts (6).
n. Remove the trim side panels, if desired.
o. Rotate the rudder pedal bar assembly toward the cabin door far enough to pull the right pedal bar out.
Rotate the remaining assembly to the left and remove the assembly from the aircraft. Note the spacers
and washers (9) on each end and between the support blocks.
5-25. INSTALLATION OF RUDDER AND STEERING PEDAL ASSEMBLY. (Refer to Figure 5-9.)
a. Assemble the torque tube assembly (1, 2, 3 and 4) as shown in Figure 5-9. Do not at this time install
the two bolts (25 and 26) through the center of the tube assembly.
b. Place the upper support blocks (7) on the ends of the torque tube assembly. Note that a washer (9) is
required on each end of the tube.
c. Position the support blocks (7 and 8) on their mounting brackets at each side of the fuselage and secure
with bolts, washers and nuts. Note that a bushing is required in the bolt holes of the upper support
block, a plate on top of the upper block, between the upper and lower blocks and under the block
mounting bracket.
d. Align the bolt holes in the center area of the torque tube assembly, install bolts, washers and nuts (25
and 26) and tighten.
e. Position the torque tube support bracket (35) on the floor tunnel and secure with bolts.
f. Position the vee brace(s) (29) on the torque tube, install the strap bracket (28) around the torque tube
and brace and secure with bolts, washers and nuts (27).
g. Check that the rod end (17) on the clevis rod (15) is adjusted to give a dimension of 7.94 inches
between hole centers.
h. Connect the ends of the brake cylinder rods (11) and clevis rods (15) to the idler arms (10) and secure
with clevis and cotter pins (13).
i. Connect the steering rods (21) to the rudder pedals (32 and 33) and secure with bolts and nuts (24).
Check steering rod adjustment per Alignment of Nose Gear, Section VII.
j. Connect the rudder trim to the arm of the torque tube and secure with bolt, washer, nut and cotter pin.
A thin washer is installed under the nut which is tightened only finger tight.
k. Connect the ends of the rudder control cables (19) to the arms provided on the torque tube and secure
with bolts, washers, nuts and cotter pins (20). Allow the ends free to rotate.
1. Swing the tee bar into place and secure with attachment bolts, washers and nuts (15). Insert bolts
through each side of the floor tunnel. (See Figure 5-1).
m. Connect the stabilator control cables (11) to the lower end of the tee bar with bolt, washer and nut (16),
and secure with cotter pin. (See Figure 5-1). Allow the cable ends to rotate freely.
n. Set rudder cable tension and check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-33.
o. Set stabilator cable tension and check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-16.
p. Check aileron cable tension.
q. Check safety of bolt and turnbuckles.
r. Install the floor tunnel plate and secure with screws. Fasten the tunnel carpet in place.
s. Install the rudder trim cover and control knob.
t. Install the access to the aft section of the fuselage.
Figure 5-11. Rudder Rigging Tool Figure 5-12. Clamping Rudder Pedals
NOTE
Examine cables for broken strands by wiping the cable along its length.
Visually check for damage. Replace all damaged cables.
5-28. INSTALLATION OF RUDDER CONTROL CABLES. (Refer to Figure 5-10.)
a. The forward rudder control cables may be installed by the following procedure:
1. Draw the control cable through the floor tunnel.
2. Connect the end of the cable to the arm on the rudder pedal torque tube by installing bolt, washer, nut
and cotter pin (2). Allow the cable end free to rotate on the arm.
3. Connect the cable to the aft control cable at the turnbuckle (12 or 13) in the aft section of the
fuselage. If the aft control cables are not installed, install at this time per Step b. Apply partial tension
to cable to keep it positioned on the pulleys. Ascertain that each cable is in the groove of its pulley.
4. Move the cable guard (4) into position under the pulley cluster (5) that is located in the forward area
of the tunnel and secure the guard with cotter pin.
5. Within the area aft of the main spar, install the cable guard blocks (6) onto the spar housing and
secure with screws.
6. Install the cable guard (7) under the pulley cluster (9) located just aft of the flap torque tube.
7. Set cable tension and check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-29.
8. Install the forward tunnel plate aft of the tee bar and secure with screws.
9. Put the floor carpet in place and secure.
10. Install the lower and upper selector covers and secure with screws.
11. Install the rear seat floor panel and install front seats.
b. The aft rudder control cables may be installed by the following procedure:
1. Position the control cable in the fuselage.
2. Connect the end of the cable (14 or 15) to the rudder horn (17) with bolt, washer, nut and cotter pin
(16). Allow the cable end free to rotate.
3. Connect the other cable end to forward control cable (10 or 11) at the turnbuckle (12 or 13) in the aft
section of the fuselage.
4. Set cable tension and check rigging and adjustment per Paragraph 5-29.
5. Install tail cone fairing and secure with screws.
c. Install the access panel to the aft section of the fuselage.
b. Before attaching the assembly to the mounting channel, ascertain that the clips (11) are installed so the
safety wire (12) will be on top. Also, that the threaded bushing (43 is installed on the assembly shaft
(15) with the welded attachment bushing forward or toward the housing.
c. Attach the housing lug to the arm provided on the rudder pedal torque tube and secure with bolt,
washer and nut (7). Tighten the nut only finger tight and safety with cotter pin.
d. Clamp the rudder pedals in neutral and position the threaded bushing in the mounting channel (8).
Turn the control shaft until the holes in the bushing and channel align and then install the clevis pin
and cotter pin (5). Should two thru holes be located in the aft end of the mounting channel, the pin
must be installed through the hole that will give equal travel and hit rudder stops before bottoming out
of the trim assembly.
e. With the rudder pedals neutral and no pressure fore or aft on the clevis pin, install the assembly cover
(1) so that the indicator washer (13) and the neutral mark on the cover align.
f. Install the trim cover, secure with screws, and install the trim control knob.
5-33. RIGGING AND ADJUSTMENT OF RUDDER TRIM CONTROLS. Perform these procedures only
after all other rudder and nose wheel rigging is complete. No adjustments are necessary other than those
required during installation of the assembly in the airplane as given in Paragraph 5-32.
3. Disconnect the left and right flap control tubes (rods) (4) at the flaps by removing the nuts, washers
and bolts (2) or at the torque tube cranks (arms) (11) by removing the bolts (12) and washers from
the inner side of each crank. It will be necessary to remove bolt through a hole in the side skin of
the fuselage located over the torque tube with the flap handle moved to its 40 degree position.
4. With the flap handle (29), fully extend the flaps and disconnect the flap tension spring (22) at the
spar or the aft end of the control cable (23), as desired.
5. Grasp the flap handle, release the plunger (33) and allow the flap to return to the retracted position.
Use caution as forward pressure will be on the handle with the tension spring disconnected.
6. Disconnect the flap return spring (32) at the spar or return chain (30), as desired.
7. Disconnect the control cable from the chain (20) by removing cotter pin, nut and clevis bolt (21).
8. Remove the tube support blocks (16 and 31) by removing the block attaching bolts (15).
9. Remove the nuts, washers and bolts (10) securing the right and left cranks (11) and stop fittings
(13) on the torque tube.
10. From between each wing and the fuselage, remove the cranks from the torque tube.
11. Disconnect one bearing block (7) from its mounting brackets (6) by removing nuts, washers and
bolts (5).
12. Slide the tube from the bearing block still attached to its brackets; raise the end and lift it from the
floor opening.
b. The flap control cable (23) may be removed by the following procedure:
1. If the front seats and rear seat floor panel have not been removed, remove the seats and floor
panel.
2. Disconnect the flap tension spring (22) from the cable, if not previously disconnected, by
extending the flaps to relieve spring tension.
3. Retract the flap. Use caution as forward pressure will be on the handle with the spring
disconnected.
4. Disconnect the cable from the chain (20) by removing cotter pin, nut, clevis pin and bushing (21).
5. Remove the flap handle bracket and cover.
6. Lift the aft section of the tunnel carpet far enough to remove the screws securing the tunnel cover
that is between the flap handle and the spar cover. Remove the cover.
7. Remove the cotter pin cable guard from the flap cable pulley (24) located inside the floor tunnel
just ahead of the spar housing.
8. Remove the cable rub blocks located in the floor opening on the aft side of the spar housing by
removing the attaching screws.
9. Disconnect the cable turnbuckle (25) at the flap handle by removing cotter pin, nut, washer,
bushing* and bolt (26). Check clevis bolt (26) for wear. Replace bolt if any wear is evident.
*(See latest revision of Piper Service Bulletin 965.)
c. Remove the flap handle (29) and bracket (28) by disconnecting the cable turnbuckle from the handle
and removing the bolts securing the bracket to the floor tunnel.
Figure 5-16. Flap Step Adjustment Figure 5-17. Flap Rigging Tool
7. Push the torque tube cranks (arms) (11) on each end of the torque tube and slide the stop fitting
(13) in place. Align the bolt hole of the crank and stop fitting with the holes in the torque tube and
install bolts. The holes in the stop fitting are longated to allow the stop fitting to be pushed against
the bearing blocks (7) thus allowing no side play of the assembly. Tighten the bolt assemblies (10)
on the stop fittings.
8. Install the tube support blocks (16 and 31) on their support brackets (19) and secure with bolts
(15).
9. Connect the flap return spring (32) to the return chain (30) and/or at the spar housing.
10. Connect the control cable end to the tension chain (20) and secure with bushing, clevis bolt, nut
and cotter pin.
11. Pull the flap handle full back and connect the tension spring (22). Release the flap handle to the
forward position.
12. Connect the flap control tube (4) to the flap and/or torque tube crank (11) and secure. The bolt (12)
and bushing that connects the control tube to the crank is installed through a hole in the side of the
fuselage located over the torque tube.
b. To install the flap handle (29) with bracket (28), place the assembly on the floor tunnel and secure with
bolts.
c. The flap control cable (23) may be installed by the following procedure:
1. Attach the cable and turnbuckle (25) to the flap handle arm and secure with clevis bolt, bushing*,
washer, nut and cotter pin (26). Ascertain that the turnbuckle end is free to rotate on the arm.
*(See latest revision of Piper Service Bulletin 965.)
2. Route the cable through the tunnel and spar housing.
3. Install the cable rub blocks on the aft side of the spar housing and secure with screws.
4. Install cotter pin cable guard over pulley (24) located just ahead of the spar housing in the floor
tunnel.
5. Attach the cable end to the tension chain (20) and secure with bushings, clevis bolt, nut and cotter pin.
If the chain is not installed because of the torque tube assembly is removed, install the assembly as
per Step c instruction. Apply partial tension to cable to keep it positioned on pulley.
6. Install cotter pin cable guard over the pulley (24) which is just ahead of the spar housing in the floor
tunnel.
7. Pull the flap handle (29) full back and connect the tension spring (22) to the cable end.
d. Install the tunnel cover and secure with screws. Also, install the tunnel carpet and bracket cover.
e. Install and secure the seats.
NOTE
In the event of wing heaviness during flight, the flap on the side of the
heavy wing can be adjusted down from neutral to remedy this condition by
lengthening the control rod. Check the inspection hole in each rod end to
ascertain that there are sufficient threads remaining and a wire cannot be
inserted through these holes. Rod ends without check holes, maintain a
minimum of .375 of an inch thread engagement. Do not raise the flap of the
other wing above neutral.
Lost motion between con- Cable Tension too low. Adjust cable tension.
trol wheel and aileron. (Refer to Paragraph
5-12.)
Lost motion between Cable tension too low. Adjust cable tension
control wheel and stabi- per Paragraph 5-16.
lator.
Lost motion between Cable tension too low. Adjust cable tension
rudder pedals and per Paragraph 5-29.
rudder.
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
Paragraph Aerofiche
Grid No.
Revised: 8/31/77
1H5
* CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
SECTION VI
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
6-1. INTRODUCTION. The hydraulic system components covered in this section consist of the combination
hydraulic pump and reservoir (both Prestolite and Oildyne), gear back-up extender actuator assembly (if
operational), actuating cylinders and hydraulic lines. The brake system, although hydraulically operated, is not
included in this section because it incorporates its own hydraulic system which is independent of the gear
retraction system. The brake system along with the landing gear and components are covered in Section VII.
This section provides instructions for remedying problems which may arise in the operation of the
hydraulic system. The instructions are organized so that the mechanic can refer to: Description of the System,
for a basic understanding of the system; Troubleshooting, for a methodical approach in locating problems;
Corrective Maintenance, for the removal, repair and installation of components; Adjustments and Checks, for
the operation of the repaired system.
CAUTION
Prior to any investigation of the hydraulic system, properly place the
airplane on jacks. (Refer to Jacking, Section II.)
6-2. DESCRIPTION. Hydraulic fluid is supplied to the landing gear actuating cylinders by an electrically
powered reversible pump located aft of the baggage compartment at right side station 156.00. There are two
vendors that supply pumps that are incorporated in the PA-28R-201/201T airplane. One pump, which has been
installed in Piper airplanes for years is the Prestolite. The latest that has been installed, is the Oildyne. Both are
interchangeable, and are similar in that they both have reservoirs that are an integral part of the pump. Both
pumps are controlled by a selector handle located on the instrument panel to the left of the control quadrant. As
the handle is selected to either the up or down position, the pump directs fluid through a single line to a
manifold and from that manifold to each individual actuating cylinder. As fluid pressure increases at one side
of a cylinder piston, fluid at the opposite side is directed back through another manifold to the pump reservoir.
The two manifolds and their connecting lines serve either as pressure or return passages depending on the
rotation of the pump to retract or extend the gear.
On the manifold through which pressured fluid passes during gear retraction, there is located a pressure
switch which opens the electrical circuit to the pump solenoid when the gear fully retracts and pressure in the
system increases to 1800 plus or minus 100 psi. The switch will continue to hold the circuit open until pressure
in the system drops to 1500 plus or minus 100 psi, which at this point the pump will again operate to build up
the pressure as long as the gear selector handle is in the up position. The down position of the gear handle has
no effect on the pressure switch
The hydraulic pump is a gear type unit driven by a 14 volt reversible motor. To prevent excessive pressure
on the hydraulic system due to fluid expansion, there is a thermal relief valve incorporated in the Prestolite
pump that will open at 2250 plus or minus 250 psi, and the Oildyne pump at 3000 plus 300 or minus 200 psi,
thus allowing fluid to flow to the pump reservoir. Other valves in the pump system channel fluid to the proper
outlets during gear retraction or extension. In the base of the pump is a shuttle valve that allows fluid displaced
by the cylinder piston rods to return to the reservoir without back pressure. This shuttle valve has a delivery
pressure of 400 to 800 psi during the extension cycle.
Also in the system is a bypass or free-fall valve that allows the gear to drop should a malfunction in the
pump circuit occur. To prevent the gear from extending too fast, there is a special restrictor fitting on the side
of the valve. If your particular hydraulic system has the gear back-up extension device operation (refer to Piper
Service Bulletin 886A), this valve will operate one of two ways. First, manually by pushing the emergency
gear lever located on the forward center floor console between the front seats to the left of the flap handle, to
“Emergency Down” position. This method is the only way that the gear can be extended in an emergency if
you have complied with Piper Service Bulletin 886A. The second way of operating the free-fall valve is that if
you have not complied with Piper Service Bulletin 886A and opted to keep your gear back-up extension
system operational, the first method will apply, along with the operation of a pressure sensing device
incorporated in the back-up extension system. This pressure sensing device incorporated in the gear back-up
extension system which lowers the gear regardless of gear selector handle position, depends upon airspeed and
engine power (propeller slipstream). Gear extension occurs even if the selector is in the up position, at airspeed
below approximately 103 KIAS for the PA-28R-201T or 95 EUAS for PA-28R-201 with engine idled or in
power off. The device also prevents the gear from retracting at airspeed below approximately 78 KIAS for PA-
28R-201T or 75 KIAS for PA-28R-201 with full power, though the selector switch may be in the up position.
This speed increases with reduced power and/or increases altitude. The sensing device operation is controlled
by a differential air pressure across a flexible diaphragm which is mechanically linked to the hydraulic valve
and an electrical switch which actuates the pump motor. A high pressure and static air source for actuating the
diaphragm is provided in a mast mounted on the left side of the fuselage above the wing.
The emergency gear lever, used for emergency extension of the gear, manually releases hydraulic pressure
to permit the gear to “free-fall” with spring assistance on the nose gear. The lever must be held in the
downward position for emergency extension. This same level when held in the up position, can be used to
override the system, and gear position is controlled by the gear selector switch regardless of airspeed power
combinations. The lever must also be held in the raised position when hydraulic system operational checks are
being conducted. An override lock allows the emergency extension lever to be locked in the up override
position. A warning light is mounted below the gear selector lever and flashes to indicate whenever the lock is
in use. The lock is disengaged by pulling up on the extension lever.
For a description of the landing gear and electrical switches, refer to Section VII, Landing Gear and Brake
System.
6-3. TROUBLESHOOTING. Malfunctions of the hydraulic system obviously will result in failure of the
landing gear to operate properly. When problems occur, jack the airplane up (refer to Jacking, Section II) and
then proceed to determine the extent of the problem. Generally, hydraulic system problems fall into two types;
problems involving the hydraulic supplying system and problems in the landing gear hydraulic system. Table
VI-III at the back of this section, lists the problems which may be encountered and their probable cause and
suggestions to remedy the problem involved. A hydraulic system operational check may be conducted using
Figure 6-1 or 6-2. When the problem has been recognized, the first step in troubleshooting is to isolate the
cause. Hydraulic system problems are not always traceable to one cause. It is possible that a malfunction may
result of more than one difficulty within the system. Starting first with the obvious and most probable reasons
for the problem, check each possibly in turn and by process of elimination, isolate the problems.
Pressure Switch
Open (OFF) Pressure 1800 +/-100 psi
Close (ON) Pressure 300 +/-psi below opening pressure
6-5. REMOVAL OF HYDRAULIC PUMP. The hydraulic pump with reservoir incorporated is located in the
aft section of the fuselage. Access to the pump is through the access panel in the aft wall of the baggage
compartment.
a. Disconnect the pump electrical leads from the pump solenoid relays and the ground wire from the
battery shelf.
b. Disconnect the hydraulic lines from the pump. Cap the line ends to prevent contamination.
c. Remove the pump by removing the pump attaching bolts.
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper aircraft, it
is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
6-6. DISASSEMBLY OF HYDRAULIC PUMP. (PRESTOLITE) (Refer to Figure 6-3.) After the hydraulic
pump has been removed from the airplane, cap or plug all ports and clean the exterior of the pump with a dry
type solvent to remove accumulated dust or dirt. To disassemble any one of the three main components of the
pump, proceed as follows:
a. The base (16) of the pump may be removed from the case (15) as follows:
1. Cut the safety wire and remove the bolts (17) with washers that secure the base to the pump case.
2. The shuttle valve within the base should be removed for cleaning purposes only. To remove the
valve, cut safety wire. Remove plug with spring and valve.
NOTE
The shuttle valve and pump base are matched, lapped parts. Should it be
necessary to replace, replace as an assembly only.
b. Pump Motor: The pump motor may be removed from the pump and disassembled as follows:
1. Remove thru bolts (4) from head (1) of motor. Using a knife, cut the seal coating between the
motor head and case.
2. Lift the head up from the case approximately .50 of an inch, this will allow inspection of brushes
(3) without the brushes unseating from the commutator. (Refer to Paragraph 6-7, b for brush
inspection.) The brush heads are secured to the head assembly.
3. Raise the head assembly (1) off the armature (8) and note the small thrust ball (7) located between
the end of the armature (8) and motor head. Do not misplace this bearing.
4. Draw the armature from the motor frame (9). Note the number of thrust washers (11) mounted on
the drive end of the armature shaft.
5. Remove the motor frame from the pump reservoir (13).
c. The valve body and gear case assembly (15) may be separated from the reservoir (13) as follows:
1. Remove the screws from the flange of the body and separate the two assemblies.
2. The pump gears and valves should be removed for cleaning purposes only. To remove cap securing
gears, remove cap attaching bolts. There are two valve springs that should be positively identified
with their valve cavities. Otherwise, it will be necessary to readjust each valve for proper operating
pressure.
NOTE
The Oildyne hydraulic pump is a sealed unit and inspection and repair
instructions are available from the vendor (manufacturer) only at this time.
6-7. CLEANING, INSPECTION AND REPAIRS OF HYDRAULIC PUMP. (PRESTOLITE)
a. Discard all old O-rings.
b. Remove cap or plugs and clean all parts with a dry type cleaning solvent and dry thoroughly.
NOTE
The conditions at repair require cleanliness, carefulness and proper
handling of parts. Ensure the foreign materials are prevented from entering
the system and that no parts are damaged.
c. Inspect pump components for scratches, scores, chips, cracks and wear.
d. Inspect motor for worn brushes (minimum of .218 of an inch brush remains between the braided wire
and commutator end), excess commutator wear and excess bearing wear.
e. Repairs are limited to O-ring and brush replacement as follows:
1. One brush holder has the winding wire attached. Locate this wire and remove by using a soldering
gun.
2. The head assembly can now be removed and worked on for ease of brush replacement if required.
3. Remove brush wire and brush from bimetal heat protector.
4. Solder new brush wires to head assembly and bimetal heat protector and wire from winding to one
brush holder.
5. Install brush springs and brushes into brush holders and secure in place (temporary) with a piece of
string looped around the brush and holder and tied in a knot.
NOTE
Ensure that the braided wire is in the holder slot for proper brush movement.
6. Install the head assembly with new brushes to the frame and commutator in accordance with
instructions given in Paragraph 6-8, Step a.
5. Insert the thrust ball (7) in the bearing of the head assembly (1). To hold the ball in position, place a
small amount of light grease inside the bearing.
6. Place head assembly on frame and allow brushes to extend over commutator. Remove the string
securing the brushes in the holders. Push head assembly on frame and ensure proper indexing of
head and frame assemblies. Secure in place with thru bolts (4).
7. Check freedom of rotation and end play (thrust) of the armature within the assembly. A minimum of
.005 of an inch end play is allowable. Should this be incorrect, adjust by adding or removing thrust
washers (11) on drive end of armature shaft, as required.
b. The valve body and gear case assembly (15) may be assembled to the reservoir (13) as follows:
1. If removed, place the pump gears in the gear case and install cover. Install cover attaching bolts and
secure.
2. Lubricate the reservoir seal ring (14) with hydraulic fluid (MIL-H-5606A) and place it in the recess
provided in the case (15).
3. Position the valve body and gear case assembly (15) with the reservoir (13). Care should be taken
when lining up the armature drive with the pump gear. Do not run the motor to do this.
4. Ascertain that the seal ring is properly positioned and install attaching screws. Tighten the screws so
that with the motor connected to a 14-volt source and with an ammeter in the circuit, the current
drawn does not exceed 12-amperes.
c. The base of the pump may be attached to the pump as follows:
1. With the pump in the up-side down position, lubricate O-ring seals, and install in the recesses
provided in the valve body and gear case assembly (15).
2. Install attaching bolts with washers and torque to 70 inch pounds.
3. Safety attaching bolts with MS20995-C32 wire.
d. Conduct motor operational check not to exceed 10 seconds running time.
6-9. TEST AND ADJUSTMENT OF HYDRAULIC PUMP. (PRESTOLITE) (Refer to Figure 6-4.)
a. Test Equipment:
1. Hydraulic pump and mounting base.
2. Pressure gauge (0 to 1000 psi).
3. Pressure gauge (0 to 3000 psi).
4. Hoses with fittings to connect between base and gauges.
5. Power supply (14 Vdc).
6. Ammeter (0 to 100 amps).
7. Fuse or circuit protector (100 amp).
b. Test and Adjustment:
1. Connect a 0 to 1000 psi gauge to the low pressure port (port No. 3) of the pump base. (The low
pressure port, No. 3, is located nearest to the pipe plug installed in the base.)
2. Connect a 0 to 3000 psi gauge to the high pressure port (port No. 1) of the pump base. (The high
pressure port, No. 1, is located farthest from the pipe plug installed in the base.)
3. Connect the black lead of the pump motor to the negative terminal of the DC power supply.
4. Fill the pump reservoir and bleed all air from the attached lines. (Lines may be bled by alternately
connecting the blue electrical lead and green lead to the positive terminal of the power supply until
all air is exhausted.)
5. Connect the blue lead to the positive terminal of the power supply. Pump should operate and the high
pressure gauge should indicate 2250 +/-250 psi. (Should the pressure be incorrect, adjust valve “A”,
Figure 6-3, in pump reservoir.)
6. Disconnect the blue lead and the high pressure reading should not drop more than 300 psi in five
minutes. High pressure may not be selected until after five minutes.
7. Connect the green lead to the positive terminal of the power supply. Pump should operate in reverse,
dropping the high pressure gauge to zero and the low pressure gauge should indicate between 500 to
800 psi. When the green lead is disconnected, both pressure gauges should indicate zero psi. (Should
the pressure of 500 to 800 psi be incorrect, adjust valve “B”, Figure 6-3, in pump reservoir.)
Voltage 14 DC
Rotation Reversible
Polarity Negative ground
Operating Current 18 amps, max. at 14-volts (both rotations)
Operating Time 5 to 10 seconds with a current load of
100 amps at 77°F.
Overload Protection Thermal circuit breaker
Automatic Reset Time 12 seconds, max.
Location, Automatic Reset Commutator end head of motor
NOTE
No mechanical characteristics for Oildyne is
available at this time.
NOTE
During test Steps 5 thru 7, there should not be any external leakage.
8. Should it be necessary to check the pump motor, first connect the ammeter in the electrical circuit with
the positive terminal of the meter to the black lead and the negative terminal of the meter to negative
terminal of the DC power supply.
9. Connect the blue lead to the positive terminal of the power supply. With the high pressure indication
within the 2250 +/-250 psi range on the pressure gauge, the ammeter should read between 35 to 60
amperes. Disconnect the electrical lead.
10. Connect the green lead to the positive terminal of the power supply. With the high pressure indication
within the 500 to 800 psi range, the ammeter should read between 15 to 35 amperes.
NOTE
In the event that any of the various tests do not perform satisfactorily, the
pump assembly should be overhauled or replaced.
11. Connect the green lead to the power supply to drop pressures before disconnecting the hydraulic lines.
NOTE
The following paragraphs, 6-11 through 6-14a, on grid pages 1H16 through
1H21, are instructions directed towards owners who have opted to comply with
Piper Service Bulletin 866A Part II, and keep the back-up gear extender
system operational.
6-12. REMOVAL OF GEAR BACK-UP EXTENDER ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY. (Refer to Figure 6-6.) The
back-up extender actuator is located under the rear seat. To reach the actuator, remove the rear seats.
a. Disconnect the actuator electrical leads at the quick disconnect terminals.
b. Disconnect the pressure (13) and static (11) hoses from the elbows (12) of the diaphragm housing (10) by
releasing clamps and sliding the hoses from their elbows. The hoses should be tagged for ease of
reassembly.
c. Place a shop cloth under the actuator hydraulic valve (25) to absorb fluid and then disconnect the hydraulic
lines (5) and (26) from the elbows (4) and (27) of the hydraulic valve (25). Cover the lines to prevent
contamination.
d. Remove the machine screws that secure the actuator base to the mounting brackets. There are two
mounting screws at the inboard side of the base and one at the outboard side of the diaphragm housing.
Remove the actuator from the mounting brackets.
6-13. INSTALLATION OF GEAR BACK-UP EXPENDER ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY. (Refer to Figure 6-6.)
a. Position the gear back-up extender actuator against its mounting brackets and install attaching machine
screws. Do not tighten screws.
NOTE
With the base attached and before installing the attaching screw through
the ring of the diaphragm housing, ensure that the attaching holes in the
housing and mounting bracket align without using force. Should they
misalign, it may be necessary to reform the main fuselage mounting
bracket.
To reform the main fuselage mounting bracket, an Aligning Tool may be
used. (Refer to Figure 6-5.) This tool may be fabricated from dimensions
given in Figure 6-10. When proper alignment has been accomplished,
tighten the machine screws.
b. Move the actuator on its mounting brackets to allow the manual control push rod to have maximum
clearance from the left stabilator cable and center in the fairlead on the aft face of the main spar box.
Check system for sufficient travel and freedom of movement of controls. Tighten actuator attaching
screws.
NOTE
Care should be used when attaching the forward hose (13) to the diaphragm
assembly (10) so that no strain is placed on the teflon bushing (15) and
diaphragm shaft (16), thus causing friction in movement.
c. Connect the hydraulic lines (5) and (26) to the elbows (4) and (27) of the actuator hydraulic valve (25).
NOTE
A special fitting (27) with a restriction orifice of .063 of an inch is installed
in the side of the hydraulic valve (25). Do not mistake this for a standard
AN fitting.
d. Connect the pressure (13) and static (11) hoses to the elbows (12) of the diaphragm housing (10).
Secure hoses with clamps.
e. Connect the actuator electrical leads terminal to their mating terminals and insulate. Refer to the
electrical schematic for hookup.
f. Check the actuator adjustments as given in Paragraph 6-14.
g. Install the rear seat.
6-14. CHECK FOR ADJUSTMENT OF GEAR BACK-UP EXTENDER ACTUATOR. (Refer to Figure 6-6.)
a. If diaphragm failure is suspected, note the following:
1. If the landing gear retracts or extends at too high an airspeed or will not retract at all unless the
back-up extender is placed in the override position, then the diaphragm is possible defective.
2. If it is determined that the diaphragm is defective, then remove the Back-Up Extender per
instructions given in paragraph 6-12 and install Piper Kit No. 761 138V, Back-Up Gear Extender
Diaphragm Replacement. Instructions for installing the diaphragm are included in the kit.
3. Following completion of Replacement Kit, reinstall the extender unit in the aircraft and
functionally test and adjust as outlined below and in paragraph 6-14a.
b. Adjustment of the gear back-up extender actuator is preset to allow the hydraulic valve (25) of the
actuator to open when the airspeed is reduced below 103 KIAS for PA-28R-201T or 95 KIAS for PA-
28R-201 with the engine power OFF. This adjustment is accomplished by setting the tension of spring
(24) on the actuator with adjustment screw (2) as follows:
NOTE
The airspeed at which the hydraulic valve of the actuator opens was preset
at the factory under ideal conditions. There should be some variations at
different altitudes and atmosphere conditions.
CAUTION
The micro switch (21) and eccentric bolt (35) must not be adjusted. These
components are set at the factory under specific conditions, with the use of
special set-up equipment.
NOTE
This adjustment will require two persons, a qualified pilot and a mechanic
to set the actuator adjustment screw (2).
1. Remove the bottom of the rear seat.
2. The pivot screw (20) should be torqued 8 to 10 inch-pounds.
3. Loosen the jam nut (28) of the adjustment screw (2).
4. Ascertain that the electrical switch (21) will actuate with the use of the emergency gear extension
lever.
5. Fly the airplane (refer to Owner’s Handbook). Should the spring tension be out of adjustment very
much, it may be necessary to assist gear retraction with the use of the emergency gear extension
lever moved to the up override position.
6. Loosen the adjustment screw (2) by turning counterclockwise until spring (24) tension is free.
WARNING
While making adjustments, do not lay tools in area exposed by the removal
of floorboard. This may interfere with airplane controls.
7. With the airplane at a safe altitude, slow the airplane to a glide of 120 KIAS for PA-28R-201T or
110 KIAS for PA-28R-201 with the gear selector handle up and the throttle reduced to power OFF.
(Gear unsafe light and horn will indicate when power is reduced.) At 120 KIAS for 28R-201T or
110 KIAS for 28R-201, slow the airplane at a rate of one (1) knot per second until 103 KIAS for
PA-28R-201T or 95 KIAS for PA28R-201 is obtained, hold the airplane at this speed.
NOTE
Adjustment of the nut (32) may be necessary to increase or decrease the
spread between the gear up and gear down actuation speeds. To expand the
spread between these speeds, loosen the nut. Tighten the nut to bring the
airspeeds closer together. Whenever the nut is adjusted, it may be necessary
to readjust the tension on the springs (24) and to repeat the nut adjustment
procedure. If the eccentric bolt (35) is installed on the unit being adjusted,
CAUTION should be observed so as not to disturb its position in relation to
the rest of the unit.
8. With the glide established, turn the adjustment screw (2) clockwise until the gear drops. (First
indication of gear dropping will be that the gear unsafe light comes ON.)
9. Climb again to a safe altitude and check that the gear drops at the correct airspeed.
10. Land the airplane and tighten the adjustment screw jam nut (28).
3. Manual Override Up Latch: With the gear up, the aircraft in normal flight configuration, select up
on the gear override lever. Engage the up latch. The amber up latch warning light, below the gear
selector switch, should be flashing. Gradually slow the aircraft below the auto gear extend speed
and observe that the gear stays fully retracted. Disengage the up latch. The flashing amber warning
light should go out.
e. Gear Indicator Lights:
1. The green lights indicate when the corresponding gear is in the down and locked position. Turn
landing light switch on and off- observe ammeter for indication.
2. The red gear warning light will indicate an unsafe condition. It will indicate when the gear is in an
intermediate position neither fully up nor down. In conjunction with the gear warning horn, it will
indicate when the throttle setting is less than 14 +/- 2 inches of manifold pressure or when flaps
are set beyond 10° for aircraft that complied with Piper Service Bulletin 866A Part I, and have the
back-up extender disabled, or s/n 2837001 and s/n 2803001 and up while the gear is not down and
locked. It will also indicate when the gear is down and locked while the selector switch is in the
UP position.
f. The Gear Warning Horn: The gear warning horn will sound whenever the red gear warning light is on
and the throttle is closed or below 14 +/- 2 in. Hg of manifold pressure.
g. Micro Switch Check:
1. The aft throttle micro switch setting is checked as follows: with the gear up, reduce the throttle at a
normal rate. The gear warning horn and the red light should come on at 14 inches of manifold
pressure +/2.
NOTE
PA-28R-201 s/n’s 2837001 and up, and PA-28R-201T s/n’s 2803001 and up
do not have landing gear back-up extender systems installed.
6-28. REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF HYDRAULIC LINES. Remove a damaged hydraulic line by
disconnecting the fitting at each end and by disconnecting where secured by brackets. Refer to Figure 6-2 as an
aid in the location of attaching brackets and bends in the lines. Provide a small container for draining the line.
Install a new or repaired line in reverse. Operate the pump to purge the system of air and check fluid level in
reservoir.
6-29. TESTING HYDRAULIC SYSTEM. The hydraulic system should be tested to determine that it functions
properly when suspicion of a problem exists, or after performing any service or repairs, it is suggested that the
airplane be connected to an outside source of power in order to conserve the battery. (Refer to External Power
Receptacle, Section II.)
CAUTION
Turn the master switch OFF before inserting or removing external power
supply plug.
NOTE
The following instructions will be directed towards testing that involves
systems incorporating the Prestolite and Oildyne hydraulic pumps. During
all tests, add hydraulic fluid MIL-H-5606 to reservoir as necessary to keep
fluid level visible to a level 1/2 inch below top of the filler hole on the
Prestolite pump, and to the FULL indication on the dipstick, with the
dipstick turned all the way in.
CAUTION
After filling the Oildyne reservoir, tighten dipstick, then back off 1 1/2 turns.
This is essential to allow the reservoir to be vented.
a. Place airplane on jacks. (Refer to Jacking, Section II.)
b. With gear down, master switch ON, and circuit breaker IN, or closed, check to see that there are three
green lights, the red warning light is OFF and that the gear warning horn is not sounding.
c. Now place the landing gear in the UP position. Note that the pump operates immediately and the red
gear unsafe light illuminates on the instrument panel until the gear is fully retracted. The hydraulic
pump should stop operating after full gear retraction.
d. Place the gear in the DOWN position. The gear should extend and lock in position and the three green
gear position lights will illuminate when all three gears are locked in the down position.
e. For airplanes that have complied with Piper Service Bulletin 866A, Part II and have the gear back-up
extender system operational, refer to Paragraph 6-14 for Check and Adjustment Procedures.
f. Airplanes with the electric flap system incorporated, ensure that the flaps are rigged properly.
g. Put the gear selector in the up position. Check again that the gear retracts normally, that the pump
stops, and the red warning light goes out.
h. Put the flap selector in the first down (10 degree) position, and ensure that the flaps operate normally
to first position, and that the horn does not sound.
i. Put the flap selector in the second down (25 degree) position, and ensure that the flaps operate
normally to second position, and that the horn does not sound.
j. Put the flap selector in the fill down position, and observe that the flaps operate normally to the fill
down position, and that the horn continues to sound.
k. Return the flap selector to the first down (10 degree) position and check that they operate to first
position and that the warning horn stops sounding.
1. Now return the flaps to the full up (0 degree) position and check that the flaps have fully retracted and
the warning horn does not sound.
m. Put the gear selector switch in the down position, and ensure that the gear has extended, the pump has
stopped running, and the three green safe lights are illuminated.
n. Return the flap selector to the fill down position, and note that the flaps operate to the full down
position, and the warning horn does not sound.
o. Now return the flap selector to the full up position, and observe that the flaps operate to the full up
position, and the warning horn does not sound.
p. Turn the Master Switch OFF.
CAUTION
Prior to removing the airplane from jacks, turn the master switch on and
determine that ALL THREE green lights are illuminated. This will ensure
that the landing gear is down and locked.
6-30. SERVICING HYDRAULIC PUMP/RESERVOIR. The fluid level of the reservoir of the combination
pump and reservoir should be checked every 50 hours by viewing the fluid through the filler plug hole in the
Prestolite and by checking the dipstick indication on the Oildyne. Access to the pump is through the access
panel in the aft wall of the baggage compartment.
Should the fluid level be low, add fluid, MIL-H-5605A, and return the filler plug on the Prestolite pump
and dipstick on the Oildyne. After tightening the dipstick on the Oildyne, loosen it 1 In turns to allow the
reservoir to vent.
CAUTION
The Prestolite pump has a small hole located under the vent screw head.
Retain 1/64 inch clearance between the screw head and the small vent hole.
The Oildyne pump must have the dipstick loosened 1 1/2 turns to properly
vent it.
Can be checked by
using override.
NOTE
If the extension solenoid of the pump can be heard to actuate when
operating the gear selector switch, it may be assumed that the gear control
circuit is operating properly and the actuator circuit should be further
checked.
§ Gear selector switch § Check ground.
ground incomplete.
Pump fails to shut off § Nose gear down limit § Adjust switch actuator
though the gear has switch actuator out (Refer to Adjustment
fully extended. (cont) of adjustment. of Nose Gear Down
Limit Switch, Section
VII.)
NOTE
The out of adjustment or failed switch may be determined by noting which
down light is not lit.
Pump running § Leakage of high § Remove pump and
intermittently pressure check valve. replace check valve.
after gear has
retracted.
* Landing gear fails to * Manual control rod * Form the rod to allow
operate at required between override clearance through fill
speeds. (Gear up at lever (manual ex- fore and aft travel.
103 KIAS for PA-28R- truder) and rear
201T or 95 KIAS for seat rubbing or
PA-28R-201, gear chafing on spar web
down at 78 KIAS for where rod passes
PA-28R-201T or 75 beneath the spar.
KIAS forPA-28R-201.
* With override lever up, * Auto extension off * Adjust switch Refer
auto extension off light switch actuator out to Paragraph 6-2 for
fails to operate. of adjustment. switch location by
moving mounting
bracket at attachment
slot. Adjust switch
until actuator is closed
when emergency gear
handle is in override
position and open when
handle is in neutral.
Revised: 2/13/89
1I22
Aerofiche
Paragraph Grid No.
Revised: 2/13/89
1I23
* CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
SECTION VII
7-1. INTRODUCTION. In this section are instructions for the overhaul, inspection and adjustment of the
various components of the landing gear and brake system. Also included are adjustments for the electrical
limit, safety and warning switches. This section though does not cover the hydraulic function of the landing
gear, except brakes, and this information may be found in the hydraulic section listed as Section VI.
7-2. DESCRIPTION. The airplanes are equipped with retractable tricycle air-oil strut type landing gear which
are hydraulically operated by an electrically powered reversible pump. A selector handle on the instrument
panel to the left of the control quadrant is used to select gear UP or DOWN positions.
Gear positions are indicated by three green lights located below the selector lever for gear down and
locked, and a red light located at the top of the instrument panel for gear unsafe position. There is no light to
indicate the gear has fully retracted other than all lights are out. As the landing gear swings to the down
position and each downlock hook moves into its locked position, a switch at each hook actuates to the switch
normally closed (NC) circuit to indicate by a green light that the individual gear is safely down and locked.
The activation of all three downlock switches will also shut the hydraulic pump off. As the instrument lights
are turned on, the green lights will dim. When the gear begins to retract and the downlock hook disengages, the
down limit switch actuates to the NC circuit and in series with the NC circuit of the up limit switch allows the
gear unsafe light to come on. The gear unsafe light will remain on until the gear is up and all up limit switches
are actuated to their normally open (NO) circuit.
The red gear unsafe light also operates simultaneously with the warning horn, and in conjunction their
purpose is to give warning when power is reduced below approximately 14 inches of manifold pressure and
the landing gear has not reached the down and locked position. This circuit is controlled by the three
paralleling down limit switches connected in series with a throttle switch (see Figure 7-15) located in the
control quadrant. When the airplane is setting on the ground, the warning circuit is controlled through the NO
side of the safety switch (squat switch) located on the left gear and the up position of the selector lever. Should
the airplane be raised from the ground, such as in flight, far enough to move the safety switch to its NC
position, then current is directed in series through the hydraulic pressure switch, the pump switch (providing
airspeed has actuated the switch to its NO position). The up limit, safety, throttle, pressure and selector switch,
and pump solenoids are all protected by the landing gear control and warning circuit protector. (Refer to
Section XI for electrical schematic.)
Each landing gear is retracted and extended by a single hydraulic cylinder attached to the drag link
assembly of the nose gear and the side brace link assembly of the main gears. As the gears retract, doors
partially enclose each gear through mechanical linkage. The gears are held in their up position by hydraulic
pressure along on the cylinder. There are no uplocks and loss of hydraulic pressure will allow the gears to drop.
It is preferred that the gears be extended and retracted with the use of the gear selector handle; however in the
event of hydraulic loss or electrical failure, they can be lowered by pushing down on the emergency extension
lever between the pilot seats with or without the back-up gear extender system installed or disabled per
compliance instructions of Piper Service Bulletin 866A, or they will drop themselves should airspeed drop
below approximately 103 KIAS, engine power off for the PA-28R-201T and 95 KIAS, engine power off for the
PA-28R-201 if the back-up gear extender system is operational per compliance instructions Part II of Service
Bulletin 866A. In either instant the hydraulic valve of the back-up extender unit opens to allow hydraulic
pressure to neutralize between each side of the cylinder pistons. The emergency extension lever can also be used
to manually overcome system malfunctions or to meet special pilot needs such as a deliberate wheels up landing
needed for emergency landings on water, or during various flight maneuvers where airspeed and power settings
would normally allow the gear to extend. It also permits gear retraction after takeoff at speeds lower than those
normally permitted by the automatic system. When using the manual extension lever, the gear position is
controlled by the selector switch, regardless of airspeed/power combinations. An override latch mechanism is
installed which allows the pilot to latch the extension lever in the up override position, thus bypassing the
automatic portion of the system on airplanes that have operational back-up gear extender systems. A flashing
warning light is mounted below the gear selector lever to indicate whenever the latch is in use. The latch is
disengaged by pulling up on the extension lever. To assist the nose gear to extend under these conditions are two
springs, one inside the other, mounted on arms above the gear links. The main gears require no assist springs.
Once the gears are down and the downlock hooks engage, a spring maintains each hook in the locked position
until hydraulic pressure again releases it. A further description of the hydraulic system and the gear back-up
extender unit may be found in Section VI, Hydraulic System.
The nose gear is steerable through a 60 degree arc by the use of the rudder pedals. As the gear retracts,
however, the steering linkage becomes separated from the gear so that rudder pedal action with the gear retracted
is not impeded by the nose gear operation. A shimmy dampener is also incorporated in the nose wheel steering
mechanism. Bungee springs are also incorporated on the push rods. These springs make lighter and smoother
ground steering possible.
The two main wheels are equipped with self-adjusting single disc hydraulic brake assemblies. Toe brakes are
standard on both the pilot’s and copilot’s rudder pedals. A parking brake is incorporated with the handle, and may
be used by pulling back on the handle and pushing forward on the button to the left of the handle. To release the
hand brake, pull aft on the handle and allow it to swing forward. Hydraulic fluid for the cylinders is supplied by a
reservoir installed on the left forward side of the firewall.
WARNING
Place airplane on jacks prior to troubleshooting landing gear system.
7-3. TROUBLESHOOTING. Mechanical and electrical switch troubles peculiar to the landing gear system are
listed in Table VII-II at the back of this section. When troubleshooting, first eliminate hydraulic malfunctions as
listed in Section VI. Then proceed to switch malfunctions and last to the mechanical operation of the gear itself,
both of which are listed in this section. Always place the airplane on jacks before attempting any troubleshooting
of the gear. To operate the gear, the emergency gear lever must be maintained in the up override position.
7-4. LANDING GEAR SYSTEM.
7-5. NOSE LANDING GEAR.
7-6. DISASSEMBLY OF NOSE GEAR OLEO. (Refer to Figure 7-1.) The nose gear oleo assembly may be
removed and disassembled from the gear oleo housing with the gear removed from or installed on the airplane.
a. Place the airplane on jacks. (Refer to Jacking, Section II.)
b. Place a drip pan under the nose gear to catch spillage.
c. Remove air and fluid from the oleo strut. Depress the air valve core pin until strut chamber pressure has
diminished, remove the filler plug and with a small hose siphon as much hydraulic fluid from the strut as
possible.
d. To remove the complete cylinder and fork assembly from the oleo housing (21), cut safety wire (2) at the
top of the unit and remove cap bolts (1) that attach steering arm (11) and aligner guide bracket (12) to the
top of the oleo cylinder (23).
e. Disconnect the shimmy dampener by removing each cotter pin, nut, washer and bolt that connects the
dampener to the oleo cylinder (23) and housing.
f. Release and remove the snap ring (17) and washer(s) (43), if installed, at the top of the housing (21), and
pull the complete cylinder and fork assembly from the bottom of the housing. The upper and lower
housing bushings (20 and 22) should remain pressed in the housing.
g. To remove the piston tube (39) and fork (42) from the cylinder (23), first separate the upper and lower
torque links (24 and 26) by removing the link connecting bolt assembly (25) and then separate the two
links. Note spacer washer between the two links.
h. Compress the piston tube (39), reach up along the tube and release the snap ring (38) from the annular
slot at the bottom of the oleo housing.
i. Pull the piston tube (39) with components parts from the cylinder.
j. The piston tube components may be removed by reaching in the tube and pushing out the upper
bearing retainer pins (27). Slide from the tube, the upper bearing (29), lower bearing (34) with outer
and inner O-rings (33 and 35), wiper strip (36), washer (37) and snap ring (38).
k. To remove the orifice tube (30, remove the large lock nut (16) and lock washer (19) from the top of the
cylinder. Pull the tube from the cylinder.
l. The orifice plate (31) is removed from the bottom of the orifice tube be releasing the snap ring (32)
that holds the plate in position.
m. To remove the piston tube plug (40) with O-ring (41) located in the lower end of the tube, remove the
bolt assembly and insert a rod up through the hole in the body of the fork (42). Push the plug out
through the top of the tube.
g. Lubricate the inner wall of the cylinder (23) with hydraulic fluid. Carefully insert the piston tube
assembly into the bottom of the cylinder, allowing the orifice tube to guide itself into the fork tube,
until the snap ring (38) can be installed in the annular slot at the bottom of the cylinder. Install wiper
strip (36), slide washer (37) into position and secure assembly with snap ring (38).
h. At the top of the cylinder (23), tighten (torque) the orifice tube lock nut (16) to 500 (min.) 600 (max.)
inch pounds.
i. Ascertain that bushings are installed in the upper and lower torque links (24 and 26) and then install
both links. The torque link bolt assemblies should be lubricated and installed with the flat of the bolt
head hex adjacent to the milled stop on the wide end of the link. Tighten the bolts only tight enough to
allow no side play in the link, yet be free enough to rotate.
j. Ascertain that the upper and lower oleo housing bushings (20 and 22) are installed. Install the cylinder
into the oleo housing, position spacer washer(s) (43) over the top of the cylinder and secure with snap
ring (17). Install spacer washers as required to obtain .0 to .015 of an inch trust of the cylinder within
the housing.
k. At the top of the oleo housing, install on the cylinder the aligner guide bracket (12) and steering arm
(11). Install cap bolts (1), tighten 20 to 25 inch pounds torque and safety with MS20995C40 wire (2).
l. Install the shimmy dampener and safety.
m. Lubricate the gear assembly. (Refer to Lubrication Chart, Section II.)
n. Compress and extend the strut several times to ascertain that the strut will operate freely. Weight of the
gear wheel and fork should allow the strut to extend.
o. Service the oleo strut with fluid and air. (Refer to Oleo Struts, Section II.)
p. (Check nose gear for alignment (refer to paragraph 7-13) and gear operation.
c. The drag links (32 and 35) and gear tension spring arm (40) may be installed by the following
procedure:
1. Ascertain that the upper and lower links (32 and 35) are assembled with the downlock hook
attached and the through travel of the links checked according to Paragraph 7-10.
2. Position the link assembly to allow the bolt holes in the links to align with the bolt holes in the
gear housing and the engine mount. Install the link attachment bolts.
3. Install nuts and washers on the upper link (35) attachment bolts. Tighten the nuts to allow the links
to rotate freely and safety.
4. Check alignment of the downlock hook to determine if it grips the roller bearing so as not to
contact the bolt head, the bearing attachment block or washer. If the downlock hook is inboard, or
it contacts the bolt head, shim between the bearing and the bearing attachment block with washer
AN960-10L, not to exceed three. The bearing must be free to rotate.
5. Install the gear tension spring arm (40) on the drag link bolt (29) on the right side of the gear oleo
housing (39), secure and safety. A washer is installed on the bolt between the lower drag link and
the arm.
NOTE: During extension and retraction of the nose landing gear check the routing and security of the
mixture cable to prevent interference between the cable and the nose gear linkage.
d. Retract and extend the landing gear several times to ascertain smoothness of operation. Also check that
the drag link assembly falls into the through center-locked position.
e. Retract the gear and connect the gear downlock spring (42) between the downlock hook (43) and the
upper drag link (35).
f. Extend the gear and connect the two gear tension springs (15 and 17) between the attachment point on
the oleo housing (39) and the spring arm (40).
g. Ascertain that the landing gear is lubricated per Lubrication Chart, Section II.
h. Check adjustment of the gear per Paragraph 7-12 or 7-13.
i. Install engine cowling. (The cowl support jacks located at each forward side of the nose gear door
hinges are adjusted down to contact the cowl surface after attaching screws are secure.)
j. Retract landing gear and check door operation as per Paragraph 7-18.
k. Check the alignment of the nose gear per Paragraph 7-14.
l. Ascertain that the landing gear is down and locked, then remove the airplane from jacks.
7-12. ADJUSTMENT OF NOSE LANDING GEAR (PA-28R-201). (Refer to Figure 7-3.) The gear up stop
(4) is located just above the gear door retraction roller near the lower aft end of the engine.
a. Remove the engine cowl. For removal instructions, refer to Paragraph 8A-14.
b. Place the airplane on jacks. (Refer to Jacking, Section II.)
NOTE: Inspect the nose landing gear link and brace assembly, the aft attachment end of the nose actuator
and the right front hat section fairing for cracks and loose rivets. Dye penetrant may be required.
If any of these parts are cracked, remove and replace in accordance with the latest revision of
Piper Service Bulletin 724.
c. Retract the landing gear by turning the master switch on, raising the emergency gear extension lever
and moving the gear selector handle to the UP position. Retain the emergency extension lever in the
UP override position.
d. Check the adjustment of the gear up stop by placing a carpenters square with the longest end along the
bottom of the fuselage and the shortest end running up through the centerline of the wheel axle.
Measure up along the square from the bottom of the fuselage 5.80 +/- .12 inches to determine if the
center of the wheel axle meets this measurement. If this measurement is incorrect, extend the gear,
loosen the jam nut (5) on the gear up stop, and make the required adjustment by turning the stop.
e. Check the adjustment of the hydraulic actuator rod by extending the gear and removing the nut and
bolt (19) from the rod end bearing (8). Extend the actuator rod (6) to maximum then retract actuator
rod (6) a minimum of .10 inch from the maximum extension. Try hooking rod end bearing with
downlock hook (10), if connect can not be made, loosen the jam nut that secures the rod end bearing
and turn rod end bearing until hook-up can be accomplished. Tighten jam nut and check that threads
cover safety hole in actuator rod (6). Recheck .10 inch minimum rod travel remains to fill extension.
f. Hook-up cylinder rod end bearing and retract gear. Recheck all adjustments and retighten the jam nut
on the gear up stop. When the gear is fully retracted, the upper drag link (3) should be firmly against
the gear up stop. Extend the gear.
g. Adjust shimmy dampener by turning nose wheel against stops and adjusting the rod end of the
dampener for adequate travel to both extremes.
h. Install engine cowling, retract landing gear and check door per Paragraph 7-18.
i. Ascertain that the landing gear is down and locked, then remove the airplane from jacks.
7-13. ADJUSTMENT OF NOSE LANDING GEAR (PA-28R-201T. (Refer to Figure 7-4.) The gear up stop
(4) is located on the gear mount approximately 6 inches above the aft attachment point of the upper drag link
(3).
a. Remove the engine cowl. For removal instructions, refer to Paragraph 8-5.
b. Place the airplane on jacks. (Refer to Jacking, Section II.)
NOTE
Inspect the nose landing gear link and brace assembly, the aft attachment
end of the nose actuator and the right front hat section fairing for cracks
and loose rivets. Dye penetrant may be required. If any of these parts are
cracked, remove and replace in accordance with the latest revision of Piper
Service Bulletin 724.
c. Retract the landing gear by turning the master switch on, raising the emergency gear extension lever
and moving the gear selector handle to the UP position. Retain the emergency extension lever in the
UP override position.
d. Check the adjustment of the gear up stop by placing a carpenters square with the longest end along the
bottom of the fuselage and the shortest end running up through the center line of the wheel axle.
Measure up along the square from the bottom of the fuselage 5.00 +/- .12 inches to determine if the
center of the wheel axle meets this measurement. If this measurement is incorrect, extend the gear,
loosen the jam nut (5) on the gear up stop, and make the required adjustment by turning the stop.
e. Check the adjustment of the hydraulic actuator rod by extending the gear and removing the nut and
bolt (9) from the rod end bearing (8). Extend the actuator rod (10) to maximum then retract actuator
rod (10) from .33 to .53 inch from the maximum extension. Try hooking rod end bearing with
downlock hook (12), if connection can not be made, loosen the jam nut that secures the rod end
bearing and turn rod end bearing until hook-up can be accomplished. Tighten jam nut and check that
threads cover safety hole in actuator rod (6). Recheck .33 to. 35 inch rod travel remains to full
extension.
f. Hook-up cylinder rod end bearing and retract gear. Recheck all adjustments and retighten the jam nut
on the gear up stop. When the gear is fully retracted, the strut tube (11) should be firmly against the
gear up stop. Extend the gear.
g. Adjust shimmy dampener by turning nose wheel against stops and adjusting the rod end of the
dampener for adequate travel to both extremes.
h. Install engine cowling, retract landing gear and check door per Paragraph 7-18.
i. Ascertain that the landing gear is down and locked, then remove the airplane from jacks.
Figure 7-5. Clamping Rudder Pedals in Figure 7-6. Rudder Pedals at Neutral
Neutral Position Angle
g. Extend a chalk line from the mark on the floor below the tail skid to a point approximately three feet
forward of the nose wheel. Allow the line to pass under the wheel at the center line of the tire. Snap
the chalk line.
h. Clamp the rudder pedals to align them in a lateral position. Ascertain that the rudder pedals are in their
neutral position. (Refer to Figure 7-6.)
i. Adjust the rod end bearings of each steering control rod to align the nose wheel with the chalk line and
to bring the rudder pedals into neutral angle fore and aft.
j. Install the steering push rods on the pilot’s rudder pedals. Adjust the rods so the lengths are both the
same and the rudder pedals are at their neutral position.
k. To align the nose wheel straight forward, stand in front of the nose gear and align the center rib of the
tire with the chalk line, or lay a straight edge along the side of the tire and parallel the straight edge
with the chalk line.
l. Install the nose wheel bungees in their neutral position (no load on the bungee springs). Adjust bungee
rod ends as necessary.
m. Place a bubble protractor against a rudder pedal steering tube to check the neutral angle as shown in
Figure 7-6.
n. One end of each rod must be disconnected and the jam nuts loosened to make any adjustments. Do not
attempt to make the adjustment by means of one rod end bearing, but divide the adjustment between
the bearings at each end of each rod. Check that the rod ends have sufficient thread engagement by
ascertaining that a wire will not go through the check hole in the rod. Reinstall the rods and tighten the
jam nuts.
o. To check the nose gear steering for its 30° +/- 2° maximum right and left travel, mark on each side of
the nose wheel an angle line from the centerline and wheel pivot point. Turn the wheel to its maximum
-travel in both directions to check for allowable travel. Should travel be exceeded in one direction and
not enough in the other direction, check for possible damage to the gear fork or torque links.
NOTES
1. IT MAY HAVE BEEN NECESSARY TO USE SPECIAL LANDING GEAR ATTACHMENT
HARDWARE DURING ASSEMBLY OF THE AIRCRAFT DUE TO MANUFACTURING
TOLERANCES. THEREFORE, SPECIAL ATTENTION SHOULD BE GIVEN WHEN
REMOVING HARDWARE TO INSPECT AND ENSURE THE SAME DIAMETER
HARDWARE IS USED UPON REASSEMBLY. STANDARD AN4 OR AN5 BOLTS ARE
REPLACED BY ALTERNATE OVERSIZED BOLTS NAS3004 OR NAS3005
RESPECTIVELY, WHEN OVERSIZED HARDWARE IS REQUIRED.
2. WHEN NEW BUSHINGS, P/N 14843-16, ARE INSTALLED, LINE BEAM l.D. TO .376/.375.
BUSHINGS TO BE PRESS FIT AND IF LOOSE ON INSTALLATION, INSTALL WITH
LOCTITE 601.
7-15. REMOVAL OF NOSE GEAR DOOR ASSEMBLY. (Refer to Figure 7-7 or 7-8.)
a. The nose gear assembly on the PA-28R-201 may be removed as follows:
1. With nose gear extended, disconnect the door retraction rods (1) from the doors (2) by removing
nut, bolt and washers.
2. To remove the door(s) from the cowl, bend one end of the hinge pin straight and from the other
end pull out the pin. The bottom cowl may be removed to facilitate easier removal.
3. Remove the bellcrank assembly (4) of the door retraction mechanism by removing the attached
hardware, disconnecting the door down tension spring (3) and removing the cotter pins (8) at each
end of the pivot tube. Slide the insulating sleeve and bushing tube from the bellcrank.
4. Remove the roller assembly of the mechanism by removing the attached hardware and pivot bolt
with insulator.
b. The nose gear assembly on the PA-28R-201T may be removed as follows:
1. With nose gear extended, disconnect the door retraction rods (1) from the doors (2) by removing
nut, bolt and washers.
2. To remove the door(s) from the cowl, bend one end of the hinge pin straight and from the other
end pull out the pin.
3. Remove the arm assembly by removing the upper arm assembly nut and bolt (5), carefully
disconnecting the door down tension springs (3) and removing the cotter pin, nut, bolt, washer and
bushings (6).
4. Remove the roller (7) by removing the attached hardware and pivot bolt.
2. The arm assembly may be installed by placing the arms on either side of the bracket (8) and
securing with bolt, bushings, nut, washer and cotter pin (6).
3. Install the gear door(s) by positioning the hinge halves of the door and cowl and inserting the
hinge pin. It is recommended a new pin be used. Bend the end of the pin to secure in place.
4. Install the cowl and adjust doors as given in Paragraph 7-18.
7-20. DISASSEMBLY OF MAIN GEAR OLEO. (Refer to Figure 7-9.) The main gear oleo assembly may be
removed and disassembled from the gear oleo housing with the gear removed from or installed on the airplane.
a. Place the airplane on jacks. (Refer to Jacking, Section II.)
b. Place a drip pan under the main gear to catch spillage.
c. Remove the air and fluid from the oleo. To do this, depress the air valve core pin until strut pressure
has diminished, remove the filler plug and with a small hose, siphon as much hydraulic fluid from the
strut as possible.
d. Disconnect the brake line at the joint located in the wheel well.
e. To remove piston tube (25) assembly from oleo housing (11), remove the upper and lower torque link
connecting bolt assembly (3) and separate the links. Note number and thickness of spacer washer(s)
between the two links (15 and 16).
f. Compress the piston tube (25), reach up along the tube and release the snap ring (24) from the annular
slot at the bottom of the oleo housing.
g. Pull the piston tube (25) with component parts from the cylinder housing.
h. The piston tube (25) components may be removed by reaching in the tube and pushing out the upper
bearing (18) retainer pins (17). Slide off the upper bearing (18), lower bearing (20) with O-rings (19
and 21), wiper (22), washer (23) and snap ring (24).
i. To remove the orifice tube (12) from the oleo housing, remove the lock nut (6) and washer (7) from
the top of the housing. Draw the tube with O-ring (9) and retainer (8) from the housing.
j. The orifice plate (13) is removed from the bottom of the orifice tube (12) by releasing the snap ring
(14) that holds the plate in position.
k. To remove the piston tube plug (26) with O-ring (27) located in the lower end of the tube, remove the
bolt assembly and insert a rod up through the hole in the body of the fork (28), pushing the plug out
through the top of the tube.
d. Check the general condition of each limit switch and its actuator, and wiring for fraying, poor
connections or conditions that may lead to failures.
e. Check the side brace link through center travel by attaching the upper and lower links, setting them on
a surface table and ascertaining that when the stop surfaces of the two links touch, linkage is not less
than .062 nor more than .125 of an inch through center. Should the distance exceed the required
through center travel and bolt and bushings are tight, replace one or both links.
f. With the side brace links assembled and checked, ascertain that when the stop surfaces of the two links
contact, the clearance between each downlock hook and the flat of the downlock pin is not less than
0.010 of an inch. Should clearance be less than that required, the hook only may be filed not to exceed
a gap of more than 0.02S of an inch. The maximum allowable clearance between each hook and the
downlock pin that are service worn is 0.055 of an inch. Should clearance be more than 0.055 of an
inch, replace the pin, check clearance and then if still beyond tolerance, replace hooks. The gap
between each hook should be equal.
g. Repair of the landing gear is limited to reconditioning of parts such as replacing components, bearings
and bushings, smoothing out minor nicks and scratches and repainting areas where paint has chipped
or peeled.
NOTE
When installing a new wing, it will be necessary to back drill two (2) holes
0.250 inch and countersink 100° x .499 through the spar cap. (Screw head
should be flush with spar.) Use hole in the support bracket has a guide in
the drilling.
2. Ascertain that the upper and lower links (28 and 33) are assembled with downlock hook (30),
retraction fitting (21), etc. attached, and the through travel of the links and downlock hook
clearance checked according to Paragraph 7-24.
3. Attach the upper link to the swivel stud of the support fitting and secure with bolt, bushing,
washer, nut and cotter pin.
4. The actuating cylinder rod end bearing (46) and lower side brace link (33) may be attached
respectively to the retraction fitting (21) and gear housing during the adjustment of the landing
gear.
d. Ascertain that the landing gear is lubricated per Lubrication Chart.
e. Check adjustment of the landing gear per Paragraph 7-26.
f. Check alignment of the wheel per Paragraph 7-27.
g. Install the access plate on the underside of the wing and remove the airplane from jacks.
f. Adjust the turnbuckle of the downlock mechanism by first ascertaining that the gear is down and
locked and then move the retraction fitting outboard until it contact the stop slot of the side brace link.
Hold the fitting in this position and turn the turnbuckle barrel until the downlock hooks make contact
with the lock pin. Safety the turnbuckle.
g. For easier adjustment of the downlock limit switch, it may be set at this time as given in Paragraph 7-
36.
h. Retract and extend the gear manually several times to ascertain that the side brace link falls through
center, the downlock hook falls into position and there is no binding of the gear assembly.
i. The gear should be adjusted in the up position to allow the gear fork to press lightly into the rubber
bumper pad on the wing. The adjustment may be accomplished as follows:
NOTE
If it requires less than .025 of an inch to move the gear into the correct
adjustment, steps 2 and 6 thru 8 need only be followed.
1. Ascertain that the rod end bearing of the actuating cylinder is disconnected from the retraction
fitting.
2. Actuate the hydraulic system to bring the hydraulic cylinder to the up position by turning the
master switch on, raising the emergency gear extension lever and moving the gear selector handle
to the up position. Retain the emergency extension lever in the up override position. The piston of
the cylinder should be bottomed. The retracted length of the cylinder is 10.92 inches.
3. Raise the gear by pushing up on the retraction fitting, thus disengaging the hooks, and pushing up
on the pivot point at the bottom of the side brace links to bring the links out of the locked position.
Raise the gear until the fork presses lightly into the rubber pad. Retain the gear in this position.
4. Loosen the jam nut on the piston rod of the actuating cylinder and turn the rod end bearing in or
out to allow a slip fit of the attachment bolt.
5. Install with the attachment bolt, bushing, spring swivel and secure with washer and nut. Install the
gear downlock spring.
6. When the gear is to within .125 of an inch of correct adjustment, the rod end need not be
disconnected and therefore all that will be required is to loosen the jam nut, place a wrench on the
flat at the end of the piston rod and turn to obtain correct adjustment.
7. Check the rod end bearing for adequate thread engagement and tighten jam nut.
8. If the downlock limit switch is properly adjusted, retract and extend the gear hydro-electrically to
ascertain that the gear operates properly.
TOE-IN
TOE-OUT SHIM WASHERS WASHERS AN 174
ANGLE WASHERS UNDER HEAD UNDER NUT BOLT
NOTE
Do not bend the actuator springs mounted on the limit switches.
7-33. ADJUSTMENT OF NOSE GEAR UP LIMIT SWITCH. The gear up limit switch is mounted on a
bracket on the engine mount above the point where the right side of the upper drag link attaches to the engine
mount.
a. To facilitate adjustment of the limit switch, disconnect the gear doors or remove the bottom cowl, as
desired.
b. Retract the landing gear by turning the master switch on, raising the emergency gear extension lever
and moving the gear selector handle to the up position. Retain the emergency extension lever in the up
position and turn the master switch off.
c. Block the nose gear in the up position and then slowly release the emergency extension lever. This will
relieve hydraulic pressure and the main gears will drop.
d. Place a .027 of an inch spacer on the oleo strut housing between the housing and the crossover tube
where the steering arm attaches. Push the gear up tight and block.
e. Loosen the attachment screws of the switch and rotate the switch toward the actuator tang until it is
heard to actuate. Retighten the attachment screws of the switch.
f. Manually move the gear up and down only as far as necessary to ascertain that the switch actuates at
the correct position. Remove the block from under the gear and allow it to slowly extend.
g. Retract the gear electrically and ascertain that the red gear unsafe light will go out when the gear has
retracted and the pump has shut off.
7-34. ADJUSTMENT OF NOSE GEAR DOWN LIMIT SWITCH. The gear down limit switch is mounted on
the horizontal support tube of the engine mount that runs between the tight attachment points of the gear
housing and upper drag link.
a. Ascertain that the gear is down and locked.
b. The down limit switch should actuate only after the leading edge of the downlock hook, when moving
to the locked position, has passed the downlock roller by .06 of an inch. (Refer to Figure 7-12.)
Position the hook at this location in relation to the roller by moving the actuator piston manually
toward the up position. The downlock spring may be disconnected, if desired.
c. Loosen the attachment screws of the actuator located on the downlock hook and move it toward the
switch until it is heard to actuate. Retighten the actuator screws.
d. Manually move the hook from the locked to the unlocked position and ascertain that the switch
actuates at the correct location of the hook.
e. Retract and extend the gear electrically by turning the master switch on, raising the emergency gear
extension lever and moving the gear selector handle to the up position. As the gear begins to retract,
the green light below the selector should go out and the red gear unsafe light at the top of the
instrument panel should come on.
7-35. ADJUSTMENT OF MAIN GEAR UP LIMIT SWITCH. A gear up limit switch is located in each wheel
well above the door hinge. There is no adjustment of these switches other than check that the gear, when
retracting, will actuate the switch within .88 of an inch of full up. Switch operation turns the red gear unsafe
light out.
7-36. ADJUSTMENT OF MAIN GEAR DOWN LIMIT SWITCH. A gear down limit switch is mounted on a
bracket which is attached to the lower drag link of each main gear. The switch should be adjusted to allow it to
actuate thus turning on the green indicator light within the cockpit when the downlock hook has entered the
locked position and is within .025 to .035 of an inch of contacting the downlock pin. (Refer to Figure 7-13.)
Adjustment of the switch may be as follows:
a. Ascertain that the main gear downlock is properly adjusted as described in Paragraph 7-26.
b. Raise the airplane on jacks. (Refer to Jacking, Section II.)
c. Ascertain that the landing gear is down and pressure is relieved from the hydraulic system. To relieve
pressure, hold down the emergency extender lever.
d. Raise the downlock hook assembly and place a .030 of an inch feeler gauge between the horizontal
surface of the hook that is next to the switch. (the surface that contacts the downlock pin) and the
rounded surface of the pin. Lower the hook and allow it to rest on the feeler gauge.
e. Loosen the attaching screws of the switch and, while pushing up on the center of the link assembly, rotate
the switch toward the hook until it is head to actuate. Retighten the attaching screws of the switch.
f. Manually move the hook assembly up from the pin until the hook nearly disengages from the pin. Then,
with pressure against the bottom of the link assembly, move back to ascertain that the switch actuates
within .025 to .035 of an inch of full lock.
g. Retract and extend the gear by turning the master switch on, raising the emergency gear extension lever
and moving the gear selector handle to the up position. As the gear begins to retract, the green light
below the selector should go out and the red gear unsafe light at the top of the instrument panel should
come on.
7-37. ADJUSTMENT OF LANDING GEAR SAFETY SWITCH (SQUAT SWITCH). The landing gear safety
switch, located on the left main gear housing is adjusted so that the switch is actuated within the last quarter of an
inch of gear extension.
a. Compress the strut until 7.875 inches is obtained between the top of the gear fork and the bottom of the
gear housing. Hold the gear at this measurement.
b. Adjust the switch down until it actuates at this point. Secure the switch.
c. Extend and then compress the strut to ascertain that the switch will actuate within the last quarter of an
inch of oleo extension.
WARNING
Applicable to airplanes that are in compliance with Piper Service Bulletin
886A, Part II.
7-38. ADJUSTMENT OF GEAR BACK-UP EXTENDER ACTUATOR SWITCH. The back-up gear extender
actuator switch is mounted on the extender unit located under the bottom section of the rear seat. Inasmuch as the
switch is a component of the back-up extender, instructions for the adjustment of the switch will be found with
the adjustment instructions for the extender as found in Section VI.
7-39. LANDING GEAR WARNING SWITCHES (THROTTLE SWITCHES).
7-40. LANDING GEAR UP/POWER REDUCED WARNING SWITCH. The gear up/power reduced warning
switch is within the control quadrant below the throttle control lever. (Refer to Figure 7-15.) This switch will
actuate the warning horn and red light simultaneously when the landing gear is not down and locked and the
throttle is reduced to the below 14 inches of manifold pressure.
7-40a. LANDING GEAR UP/FLAP TORQUE TUBE CAM WARNING SWITCH. (All aircraft with back-up
gear extender disabled, or PA-28R-201/20lT, S/N’s 2837001 & 2803001 and up.) Any flap selection in excess of
10 degrees, or beyond the first notch, will activate the warning horn and red light simultaneously. Adjust the
switch assembly so the roller remains within the cam slot and the switch remains open and when in excess of 10
degrees, the roller exits the slow and allows the switch to close giving the landing gear up warning indication
(Refer to Figure 7- 14.)
Figure 7-14. Flap Torque Tube Cam Gear Warning Switch Installation
f. Advance and retard the throttle to ascertain that the switch actuates at the desired throttle lever setting.
The airplane may also be down to ascertain that the horn and light will actuate when the throttle is
reduced below approximately 14 inches of manifold pressure with gear up.
g. Reinstall the quadrant cover as given in Paragraph 7-42.
7-44. WHEELS.
NOTE
On McCauley nose wheel assemblies only, bushing (19) is required to
prevent tube movement.
b. Position the tire and tube so the index mark on the tire is aligned with the index mark on the tube. This
will maintain proper balance of the wheel. Inflate the tire to the specified pressure as given in Table II-
I of Section II.
c. Lubricate the bearing cones (6 and 12) and install the cones, grease seals (4 or 13), felt rings (3 or 14)
and seal retainer rings (2 or 15). Secure with snap rings (1 or 16).
d. Slide the wheel on the axle and secure with retainer nut. righten nut to allow no side play, yet allow the
wheel to rotate freely. Safety the nut with clevis pin and secure pin with washer and cotter pin.
7-49. INSPECTION OF MAIN WHEEL ASSEMBLY. The inspection of the main wheel is the same as that
given for the nose wheel, Paragraph 7-46.
7-53. BRAKE ADJUSTMENT AND LINING TOLERANCE. No adjustment of the brake lining clearance is
necessary as they are self adjusting. Inspection of the lining is necessary and it may be inspected visually while
installed on the airplane. The linings are of the riveted type and should be replaced if the thickness of any one
segment becomes worn below .100 of an inch or unevenly worn.
7-54. REMOVAL AND DISASSEMBLY OF WHEEL BRAKE ASSEMBLY. (Refer to Figure 7-18.)
a. To remove the brake assembly, first disconnect the brake line from the brake cylinder at the tube
fitting.
b. Remove the cap bolts that join the brake cylinder housing and the lining back plate assembly. Remove
the back plate from between the brake disc and wheel.
c. Slide the brake cylinder housing from the torque plate.
d. Remove the pressure plate by sliding it off the anchor bolts of the housing.
e. The piston(s) may be removed by injecting low air pressure in the cylinder fluid inlet and forcing the
piston from the housing.
f. Check anchor bolt for wear.
g. Remove anchor bolt by the following procedure:
1. Position cylinder assembly on a holding fixture. (Refer to Figure 7-19.)
2. Use a suitable arbor press to remove the anchor bolt from the cylinder head.
7-56. ASSEMBLY AND INSTALLATION OF WHEEL BRAKE ASSEMBLY. (Refer to Figure 7- 18.)
a. Lubricate the piston O-ring(s) with fluid MIL-H-5606 and install on piston(s). Slide the piston in
cylinder housing until flush with surface of housing.
b. Slide the lining pressure plate onto the anchor bolts of the housing.
c. Slide the cylinder housing assembly on the torque plate of the gear.
d. Position the lining back plate between the wheel and brake disc. Install the bolts and torque to 40 inch
pounds to secure the assembly.
e. Connect the brake line to the brake cylinder housing.
f. Bleed the brake system as described in paragraph 7-69.
NOTE
In order to obtain optimum service life from newly installed brake linings,
they must be properly conditioned. To condition the brake linings, perform a
minimum of six light pedal effort braking applications from 25 to 40 mph.
Allow the brake discs to partially cool between stops.
NOTE
Fluid level in the reservoir must be maintained to prevent air from entering
in the line.
g. Tighten both wheel bleeders.
h. Pull hand brake until a firm handle is maintained.
Red gear unsafe light out Indicator lamp burned Replace lamp.
while gear is in transit. out.
NOTE
The out of adjustment or failed switch may be determined by noting which
down light is not lit.
Red gear unsafe light and Micro switch at throttle Adjust micro switch.
horn fail to operate when out of adjustment.
throttle is near closed
and landing gear is re- Micro switch at throttle Replace switch.
tracted (cont). failed.
Green gear down lights Micro switch out of Adjust micro switch.
blink momentarily before adjustment.
the down lock is engaged
on roller.
Nose landing gear Internal wear in shimmy Replace shimmy
shimmies during fast dampener dampener.
taxi, takeoff, or
landing. Shimmy dampener or Replace necessary
bracket loose at parts and bolts.
mounting.
Red gear unsafe light and Warning light and horn Check wiring.
horn fail to operate when circuit wire broken.
selector is moved to up
position with gear extended
and throttle retarded.
Above condition on Defective safety (squat) Replace switch.
ground. switch.
Above condition in Pressure switch open. Replace switch.
the air.
Hydraulic pump shuts Gear not fully Determine cause and
off, but red gear unsafe retracted. remedy.
light remains on.
3 65003-45* Bushing ID ID
21 452 366 Bearing, torque link * * ID .2495 ID .2495 002 Coat bearing
(#F-310-5) .2505 .2515 with zinc
chromate and
install while still
wet Press fit
9 14843-16 (2) Bushing, side brace * * ID .376 ID .374 Press Fit. Install
link .375 using Loctite
601.
14 65003-44 (2) Bushing, lowerside brace * * ID .373 ID .372 .004 Press Fit
link .375 3.76
26 31796-00 (2) Bushing, Torque link * * ID .252 ID .253 002 Press Fit
.251 .251
SERVICE MANUAL
CARD 2 OF 3
PA-28R-201/201T
Service manual information incorporated in this set of Aerofiche cards is arranged in accordance with the
general specifications of Aerofiche adopted by the General Aviation Manufacturer’s Association. Information
compiled in this Aerofiche service manual is kept current by revisions distributed periodically. These revisions
supersede all previous revisions, are complete Aerofiche card replacements, and supersede Aerofiche cards of
the same number in the set.
Revisions to Service Manual 761 639 issued December 15, 1976 are as follows:
Section VII in Card 1 and Sections VIII and VIIIA in Card 2 have been
revised. There are no other changes included in this interim change
revision. Please discard your current cards 1 and 2, and replace them with
the revised ones. DO NOT DISCARD CARD 3.
Consult the latest Customer Services Information Aerofiche for current revision dates for this manual.
2A2
TABLE OF CONTENTS
NO. AEROFICHE CARD NO. 1 GRID NO
I INTRODUCTION 1A13
IV STRUCTURES 1D17
X INSTRUMENTS 2F5
2A3
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS (cont)
Aerofiche
Figure Grid No.
Revised: 2/13/89
2A5
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS (cont)
Aerofiche
Figure Grid No.
NOTE: (Electrical Schematics Figures 11-46 thru 11-67, see Table XI-VIII.)
Revised: 2/13/89
2A6
LIST OF TABLES
Aerofiche
Table Grid No.
LIST OF CHARTS
Chart Grid No.
Revised: 2/13/89
2A8
SECTION VIII
POWER PLANT [CONTINENTAL]
Aerofiche
Paragraph Grid No.
SECTION VIII
POWER PLANT
TURBOCHARGED
CONTINENTAL
(PA-28R-201T)
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper Aircraft,
it is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
8-1. INTRODUCTION. The purpose of this section is to provide instructions for the removal, minor repair,
service and installation of the engine and components. For instructions on major repairs and overhauls, consult
the appropriate publication of the component manufacturer.
8-la. STANDARD PRACTICES - ENGINE. The following suggestions should be applied wherever they are
needed when working on the power plant.
1. To ensure proper reinstallation and/or assembly, tag and mark all parts, clips, and brackets as to their
location prior to their removal and/or disassembly.
2. During removal of various tubes or engine parts, inspect them for indications of scoring, burning or
other undesirable conditions. To facilitate reinstallation, observe the location of each part during
removal. Tag any unserviceable part and/or units for investigation and possible repair.
3. Extreme care must be taken to prevent foreign mater from entering the engine, such as lockwire,
washers, nuts, dirt, dust, etc. This precaution applies whenever work is done on the engine, either on or
off the aircraft. Suitable protective caps, plugs, and covers must be used to protect all openings as they
are exposed.
NOTE
Dust caps used to protect open lines must always be installed OVER the tube
ends and NOT IN the tube ends. Flow through the lines may be blocked off if
lines are inadvertently installed with dust caps in the tube ends.
4. Should any items be dropped into the engine, the assembly process must stop and the item removed,
even though this may require considerable time and labor. Ensure that all parts are thoroughly clean
before assembling.
5. Never reuse any lockwire, lockwashers, tablocks, tabwashers or cotter pins. All lockwire and cotter
pins must fit snugly in holes drilled in studs and bolts for locking purposes. Cotter pins should be
installed so the head fits into the castellation of the nut, and unless otherwise specified, bend one end
of the pin back over the stud or bolt and the other end down flat against the nut. Use only corrosion
resistant steel lockwire and/or cotter pins. Bushing plugs shall be lockwired to the assembly base or
case. Do not lockwire the plug to the bushings.
6. All gaskets, packings and rubber parts must be replaced with new items of the same type at
reassembly. Ensure the new nonmetallic parts being installed show no sign of having deteriorated in
storage.
7. When installing engine parts which require the use of a hammer to facilitate assembly or installation,
use only a plastic or rawhide hammer.
8. Anti-seize lubrication should be applied to all loose-fit spline drives which are external to the engine
and have no other means of lubrication. For certain assembly procedures, molybdenum disulfide in
either paste or powdered form mixed with engine oil or grease may be used.
CAUTION
Ensure that anti-seize compounds are applied in thin even coats and that excess
compound is completely removed to avoid contamination of adjacent parts.
WARNING
Before performing any work on the propeller, be sure the magneto and
master switch is OFF and the mixture control is in the IDLE CUT-OFF
position.
a. Remove the hardware that attaches the nose cowl and remove the cowl. The top and side panels may
be removed for greater accessibility.
b. Remove the safety wire from the propeller mounting nuts and remove the nuts.
c. Place a drip pan under the propeller to catch oil spillage and pull the propeller from the engine shaft.
d. If the spinner and spinner bulkhead are to be removed, remove the spinner nose cap attaching screws
and cap. Remove the spinner by removing the safety wire and check nut from the propeller at the
forward end of the forward spinner bulkhead and the screws that secure the spinner to the aft bulkhead.
The aft spinner bulkhead may be removed from the hub by removing the locknuts.
NOTE
Do not attempt to disassemble the propeller any further than stated in this
manual. For internal repairs and replacement of parts, the propeller should
be referred to the Hartzell Factory or Certified Repair Station.
a. Check for oil and grease leaks.
b. Clean the spinner, propeller hub, and blades with a non-corrosive solvent.
c. Inspect the hub parts for cracks.
d. Steel hub parts should not be permitted to rust. Use aluminum paint to touch up, if necessary, or
replate them during overhaul.
e. Check all visible parts for wear and safety.
f. Check blades to determine whether they turn freely on the hub pilot tube. This can be done by rocking
the blades back and forth through the slight freedom allowed by the pitch change mechanism. If they
appear tight and are properly lubricated, the propeller should be disassembled by an authorized Service
Center.
g. Inspect the blades for damage or cracks. Nicks in the leading edges of blades should be filed out and
all edges rounded, as cracks sometimes start from such places. Use fine emery cloth for finishing.
(Refer to Figure 8-4 for propeller blade care.)
h. Check the condition of the propeller mounting nuts and studs.
i. Each blade face should be sanded lightly with fine sandpaper and painted, when necessary, with a flat
black paint to retard glare. A light application of oil or wax may be applied to the surfaces to prevent
corrosion.
j. Grease the blade hub through the zerk fittings. Remove one of the two fittings for each propeller blade;
alternate the next time. Apply grease through the zerk fitting until fresh grease appears at the fitting
hole of the removed fitting. Care should be taken to avoid blowing out the hub gaskets.
8-11. INSTALLATION OF PROPELLER. (Refer to Figure 8-3.)
WARNING
Before performing any work around the propeller be sure the magneto and
master switch is OFF, and the mixture control is in the IDLE CUT-OFF
position.
a. Clean the propeller and engine flanges.
b. Lubricate and install the O-ring in the propeller hub.
c. Align the propeller with the dowel pins on the prop flange and slide it over the pins.
d. Tighten the mounting nuts a few threads at a time until all are tight. Stager torque the nuts 60 to 70
foot-pounds.
e. Safety the propeller mounting nuts.
f. Install spinner if removed and torque screws 35 to 40 inch-pounds.
Propeller RPM Setting Engine Static High RPM 2575 RPM max.
8-12. CHECKING PROPELLER BLADE TRACK. Blade track is the ability of one blade tip to follow the
other, while rotating, in almost the same plane. Excessive difference in blade track - more than .0625 inch may
be an indication of bent blades or improper propeller installation. Check blade track as follows:
a. With the engine shut down and blades vertical, secure to the aircraft a smooth board just under the tip
of the lower blade. Move the tip fore and aft through its full “blade-shake” travel, making small marks
with a pencil at each position. Then center the tip between these marks and scribe a line on the board
for the full width of the tip.
b. Carefully rotate propeller by hand to bring the opposite blade down. Center the tip and scribe a pencil
line as before and check that lines are not separated more than .0625 inch.
c. Propellers having excess blade track should be removed and inspected for bent blades, or for parts of
sheared O-ring, or foreign particles, which have lodged between hub and crankshaft mounting faces.
Bent blades will require repair and overhaul of assembly.
8-13. PROPELLER GOVERNOR.
8-14. REMOVAL OF PROPELLER GOVERNOR. The propeller governor is mounted on the lower left
forward portion of the engine crankcase. Remove the governor as follows:
a. Remove the lower cowl to gain access to the governor.
b. Disconnect the governor control cable end from the governor control arm.
c. Remove the governor mounting nuts and withdraw the governor from the mounting pad. Cover the
mounting pad to prevent foreign material from entering the engine.
8-17. ENGINE.
*WARNING - OPERATION OF ENGINE AT TOO HIGH AN RPM BEFORE REACHING OIL TEMPERATURE MAY CAUSE LOSS
OF OIL PRESSURE.
8-19. INSTALLATION OF ENGINE. (Refer to Figure 8-6.) Prior to installing the engine, be sure to install all
items that were removed after the engine was removed from the aircraft
WARNING
Prior to installation of the engine, ensure that Teledyne Continental Service
Bulletin M86-11 is complied with.
NOTE
Removal all protective caps and identification tags as each item is installed.
NOTE
If engine is equipped with a freon compressor, the compressor support
brackets must be properly aligned. Refer to the latest revision of Teledyne
Continental Motors Service Bulletin No. M79-15.
a. Install the shock mount in the engine mount and hoist the engine into position on the mount.
b. Install the lower shock mount assemblies and mounting bolts. Torque the bolts 450 to 500 inch
pounds.
c. Route and connect the throttle and mixture control cables and adjust.
d. Route and connect the propeller governor control cable and adjust.
e. Connect the alternate air cable and adjust.
f. Reconnect all lines and hoses previously disconnected from the engine.
NOTE
Apply Lubon No. 404 to all male fuel system fittings. Do not allow to enter
system.
g. Route and connect the electrical leads to the appropriate connections on the engine.
h. Connect the tachometer drive cable.
i. Connect exhaust manifold at the turbocharger turbine inlet (“Y” connection) and at each exhaust
manifold slip joint adjacent to No. 1 and 2 cylinders.
NOTE
Secure all cables, hoses and wires with clamps and Ty-strap in the same
location as before removal. Make sure then clamping cables to ensure
wiring clears all metal plates and free from forced chaffing against any
sharp metal edges, see Figure 8-6.
j. Install the propeller and spinner per paragraph 8-11.
k. Service the engine with the proper grade and quantity of oil; refer to Section II.
l. Be certain all switches are in the OFF position and connect the battery cables.
m. Install the engine cowling per paragraph 8-7.
n. Make a final check of the security, location and installation of all lines, wires and cables.
o. Perform an operational check of the engine; inspect for leaks and make final adjustments to engine
controls as required.
NOTE
Check exhaust pipe clearance. Minimum clearance to structure opening
should be 0.50 of an inch.
8-22a. TURBOCHARGER NOMENCLATURE. Many unfamiliar terms may appear on the following pages of
this manual. An understanding of these will be helpful, if not necessary, in performing maintenance and
troubleshooting. The following is a list of commonly used terms and names as applied to turbocharging and a
brief description.
TERM MEANING
Supercharge To increase the air pressure (density) above or higher than ambient
conditions.
Wastegate and Actuator The wastegate is a butterfly type valve in the exhaust by-pass which,
(Exhaust By-Pass) throughout its travel from open to closed, allows varied amounts of
exhaust gas to by-pass the turbine, controlling its speed, hence the
output of the compressor. The actuator is operated by a hydraulic
piston operated by engine oil and cylinder with the piston linked to an
arm on the butterfly valve shaft.
Density Controller The density controller is designed to allow the engine to develop full
rated power no matter what ambient temperature and pressure
conditions are. This controller regulates wastegate bleed oil only at
full throttle position to maintain a constant air density at the injector
inlet. The pressure and temperature sensing bellows of the con troller
react to pressure and temperature changes between the fuel injector
inlet and the turbocharger compressor. The bellows, filled with dry
nitrogen gas, maintains a constant density by allowing the pressure to
increase as temperature increases. Movement of the bellows re-
positions the bleed valve, causing a change in quantity of bleed oil,
which changes oil pressure to the wastegate piston.
NOTE
The density controller is designed to keep the air density constant at the
injector entrance. As ambient air temperature increases or density decreases
due to change in altitude a higher manifold pressure is required to maintain
a constant density, also resulting in a higher injector inlet temperature. This
is why wide open throttle manifold pressure increases with either altitude or
outside air temperature. In a full throttle climb, a gain of 3 to 4 inches of
manifold pressure between sea level and critical altitude will be seen.
Differential Pressure This controller uses a diaphragm rather than a bellows as is found in
Controller the density controller. It is used in conjunction with the density
controller. Its function is to override the density controller so that the
compressor discharge pressure is not held at an unnecessarily high
level when lower manifold pressure is being used. The differential
controller will usually maintain a compressor discharge pressure
(deck pressure) approximately 6.5” Hg above the selected manifold
pressure. In this system, the density controller is only effective at
wide open engine throttle conditions.
Ground Boosted or These phrases indicate that the engine depends on a certain amount of
Ground Turbocharged turbocharging at sea level to produce the advertised horsepower. An
engine that is so designed will usually include a lower compression
ratio to avoid detonation.
Deck Pressure The pressure measured in the area downstream of the turb compressor
discharge and upstream of the engine throttle valve. This should not
be confused with manifold pressure.
Manifold Pressure The pressure measured downstream of the engine throttle valve and is
almost directly proportioned to the engine power output.
Bootstrapping This is a term used in conjunction with turbo machinery. If you were
to take all the air coming from a turbocharger compressor and duct it
directly back into the turbine of the turbocharger, it would be called a
bootstrap system and if no losses were encountered, it would theo-
retically run continuously. It would also be very unstable because if
for some reason the turbo speed would change, the compressor would
pump more air to drive the turbine faster, etc. A turbocharged engine
above critical altitude (wastegate closed) is similar to the example
mentioned above, except now there is an engine placed between the
compressor discharge and turbine inlet. Slight system changes caused
the exhaust gas to change slightly, which causes the turbine speed to
change slightly, which causes the compressor air to the engine to
change slightly, which in turn again affects the exhaust gas, etc.
NOTE
Piper considers service bulletins of utmost importance and compliance
mandatory.
d. Place turbine housing insulation blanket in proper position and safety blanket to turbocharger attaching
hardware.
e. Position the exhaust tailpipe and exhaust bypass screw to the turbine outlet, aligning the tailpipe with
the hole cut out in the lower cowl provided for it.
NOTE
Check the position of the exhaust bypass adjustment screw. If 8 minimum, 9
maximum threads are showing, below jam nut no adjustment is required.
(See Figure 8-36).
f. Tighten both turbine housing inlet clamps. (Refer to above note on tightening V-band clamps).
g. Position the engine induction tube to turbocharger compressor outlet connector and the induction air
inlet tube to the turbocharger compressor inlet connector in their proper locations and tighten the
clamps.
h. Connect the oil supply and return lines to the turbocharger center housing. Connect the oil pressure
cockpit gauge line if it was previously disconnected.
i. Perform engine ground run-up and check for normal engine functioning, excessive exhaust manifold
leakage and oil leaks. Repair as necessary.
j. Install the upper cowling.
8-25. ADJUSTMENT OF TURBOCHARGER. (Refer to Paragraph 8-61, Step b)
NOTE
A complete inspection of the power plant system should be performed before
any turbo adjustments are made.
8-31. CLEANING INDUCTION AIR FILTER. The air filter element should be cleaned as often as it becomes
dirty, everyday under severe dust conditions. The filter element should be replaced if any holes or tears exist.
When cleaning the filter, it is a good practice to clean the filter box assembly with a clean cloth dampened with
clean solvent.
CAUTION
Do not allow foreign materials to drop into or otherwise enter the filter box
assembly outlet duct to the turbocharger. Failure to take necessary
precaution could cause failure of the turbocharger.
a. To clean the filter, rap gently on a hard surface to remove embedded debris. Be careful not to damage
the sealing ends.
CAUTION
Never wash the filter element in any liquid or soak it in oil. Never attempt to
blow off dirt with compressed air.
8-35. MAGNETOS.
CAUTION
Ascertain that the primary circuits of both magnetos are grounded before
working on the engine.
NOTE
The magneto service instructions in this manual cover minor repairs and
timing. For further repairs and adjustments of the magnetos, it is
recommended that the magneto manufacturer’s service instructions be
followed. (Refer to Continental Service Bulletin No. M78-8 for additional
ignition maintenance.)
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper Aircraft,
it is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
c. Should the trouble appear definitely associated with the magneto, the most effective measure is to
install a replacement magneto which is known to be in satisfactory condition and send the suspected
unit to the overhaul shop for test and repair.
d. Should this not be possible, a visual inspection may disclose the source of trouble. Remove the harness
outlet plate from the magneto. Inspect for the presence of moisture and foreign matter on the rubber
grommet and high tension outlet side of the distributor block. Check height of block contact springs.
The top of the spring must not be more than 0.422 of an inch below the top of the tower as shown in
Figure 8-9. If the springs are broken or corroded, replace them.
e. Inspect the distributor block for cracks or burned areas. The wax coating on the block should not be
removed. Do not use solvents.
f. Check for excess oil in the breaker compartment. If present, it may mean a bad oil seal or oil seal
bushing at the drive end. Check the magneto manufacturer’s overhaul procedure.
g. Remove the breaker cover and harness securing screws and nuts and separate cover from magneto
housing. Check contact assemblies to see that cam follower is securely riveted to its spring. Examine
the contact points for excessive wear or burning. Figure 8-10 shows how the average contact point will
look when surfaces are separated for inspection. Desired contact surfaces have a dull gray, sandblasted
(almost rough) or frosted appearance over the area where electrical contact is made. This means that
points are worn in and mated to each other, thereby providing the best possible electrical contact and
highest efficiency of performance.
h. Minor irregularities or roughness of point surfaces are not harmful (refer to Figure 8-10, center),
neither are small pits or mounds, if not too pronounced. If there is a possibility of pit becoming deep
enough to penetrate pad, Figure 8-10, right, reject contact assembly.
n. Check the clearance between each flyweight and each stop pin as follows:
1. Bend the end of a stiff piece of wire into a right angle 0.125 inch long (maximum).
2. Hold magneto as shown in Figure 8-12. Pull heel of flyweight outward with the hooked wire and
make certain that feeler gauge of 0.010 inch minimum thickness will pass between stop pin and
the highest point of the flyweight.
NOTE
A true and accurate check of the clearance between flyweight and stop pin
can only be obtained by pulling the flyweight outward as described above.
Do not attempt the check by pushing in on flyweight at point “A.”
o. Check internal timing and reinstall and time magneto to engine.
8-37. REMOVAL OF MAGNETO.
a. Remove the engine cowl.
b. Disconnect the “P” lead from the magneto.
c. Remove the harness outlet plate from the magneto by removing the four attaching screws.
d. Remove the two nuts and washers securing the magneto to the engine accessory housing.
e. Pull the magneto from the engine.
Figure 8-13. Rotor Holding Tool Installed Figure 8-14. Timing Kit Installed
8-38. MAGNETO TIMING PROCEDURE (INTERNAL TIMING). When installing or adjusting breaker
points and before timing the magneto to the engine, it is important that the internal timing of the magneto be
correct. The recommended method of checking the internal timing of the magneto is to use the Bendix 11-8150
Timing Kit using the procedure described in sub-paragraph a. However, if a timing kit is not available, the cast
in timing marks in the breaker housing and a fabricated pointer may be used as described in sub-paragraph b.
a. Check the internal timing with the Bendix 11-8150 Timing Kit using the following procedure:
1. Remove the magneto from the engine and remove the contact point cover.
2. Loosen the nut securing the drive plate to the magneto shaft sufficiently in order to install the
Bendix 11-8465 Rotor Holding Tool under the nut and flat washer as shown in Figure 8-13.
Tighten the nut enough to hold the tool securely.
3. Install the Bendix 11-8147 Plate Assembly to the breaker compartment of the magneto as shown
in Figure 8-14.
4. Remove the timing inspection plug from the top of the magneto and turn the rotating magnet in the
direction of normal rotation until the painted chamfered tooth on the distributor gear is
approximately in the center of the inspection window. Then turn it back until rotating magnet
locates in its neutral position. Tighten adjustment knob of 11-8465 Rotor Holding Tool, holding
the rotating magnet in the neutral position.
CAUTION
Tighten adjusting knob of rotor holding tool only enough to hold magnet
shaft firmly. Do not overtighten.
5. Install the Bendix 11-8149 Pointer Assembly on the cam screw and align pointer with the zero
degree mark on the timing plate.
6. Loosen adjusting knob of rotor holding tool and turn rotating magnet in normal direction of
rotation until pointer indexes with the respective 10° mark (“E” gap). Tighten adjustment knob of
rotor holding tool.
7. With the Bendix 11-9110 Timing Light or equivalent, adjust main breaker contacts to just open at
this position. Loosen holding tool and turn rotating magnet until breaker cam follower is on the
high point of the cam lobe. Tighten holding tool and measure contact clearance. It must be 0.018 ±
0.006. If not, readjust breaker and recheck to be sure that contacts will open within “E” gap
tolerance ± 4°. Replace breaker assembly if “E” gap tolerances and contact clearance cannot be
obtained.
8. After timing is complete, tighten breaker securing screws to 20 to 25 inch-pounds and recheck
settings. Remove timing kit parts.
b. The internal timing can be checked without a timing kit using the cast in marks in the breaker
compartment. These marks indicate “E” gap and limits (refer to Figure 8-15). The point in the center
of the “E” gap boss indicates the exact “E” gap position. The width of the boss on either side of the
point is the allowable tolerance of ± 4°. In addition to these marks, the cam has an indented line across
its end. When the indented line is aligned with the mark at the top of the breaker housing, the rotating
magnet is in its “E” gap position. Check the timing using the following procedure:
1. Install the Rotor Holding Tool 11-8465 under the drive shaft nut and washer as shown in Figure 8-13.
NOTE
The rotor holding tool facilitates the timing procedure. However, it is
possible to manually hold the shaft at the specified angle when setting the
breakers.
2. Turn rotating magnet in direction of rotation until painted chamfered tooth of distributor gear is
just becoming visible in timing window. Continue turning rotating magnet until line on end of cam
is aligned with mark at top of breaker housing. (Refer to Figure 8-15.) Tighten adjusting knob of
the holding tool to hold rotating magnet.
3. Fabricate a pointer as shown in Figure 8-16 and install the pointer under the cam screw so the
pointer indexes in the center of “E” gap position.
4. Connect the 11 -9110 Timing Light or equivalent across breaker assembly. Adjust breaker contacts
to just open at this position.
5. Loosen holding tool and turn rotating magnet until cam follower is on high point of cam lobe.
Tighten holding tool and measure contact clearance. It must be 0.018 ± 0.006. If necessary,
readjust breaker. Check to be sure contacts open within “E” gap tolerance. Replace breaker
assembly if “E” gap tolerance and contact clearance cannot be obtained. Tighten breaker screws to
20 to 25 inch-pounds and recheck breaker settings.
8-39. MAGNETO INSTALLATION AND TIMING PROCEDURE (MAGNETO TO ENGINE). (Refer to
Figure 8-17.)
a. The timing marks are on the outer edge of the crankshaft counterweight blade between No. 2 and No.
4 cylinders. The inspection plug between No. 2 and No. 4 cylinders on the left top side of the
crankcase must be removed to view the marks on the crankshaft.
1. Plug one spark plug hole of the No. 1 cylinder and place a thumb over the other plug hole. Have a
second person stand in front of the engine and turn the crankshaft in a counterclockwise direction
until pressure is felt on the thumb. No. 1 piston is coming up on the compression stroke.
2. Remove the inspection hole plug and turn the crankshaft counterclockwise until the 20 degree
BTC mark appears in the center of the inspection hole. A timing device as described in Service
Bulletin M68-2, Rev. 1 may also be used.
3. Remove the inspection hole plug from the magneto. Turn the magneto coupling until the painted
chamfered tooth on the distributor gear is approximately centered in the inspection hole. Hold the
magneto in its approximate installed position. Note carefully the position of the coupling drive
lugs.
4. Lubricate the gear support shaft with clean lubricating oil and install the drive gear assembly so
the slots of the coupling bushings will be in the approximate position for aligning with the drive
coupling lugs on the magneto.
5. Insert the retainer into the gear hub slot. Apply a film of Lubriplate grease to each of the new
rubber bushings and insert the bushings into the retainers, rounded long edges first.
6. Place a new gasket on the magneto flange. Install the magneto carefully so the drive coupling lugs
mate with the slots of the drive bushings. Install and snug down the two sets of attaching screws.
Do not tighten at this time.
7. Breaker point opening may be checked by use of a suitable timing light. Tap the magneto case
with a non-marring hammer, counterclockwise (from the rear) to make certain the points are
closed. After the timing light indicates that the points are closed, tap the magneto lightly clockwise
until the points are open. Tighten the magneto attaching nuts.
8. Check timing by backing up crankshaft approximately 5 degrees and tapping gently forward until
the timing light indicates opening of breaker points. If timing is correct, the 20 degree mark
(midway between the 16 and 24 stamped on the crankshaft) will appear in the center of the
inspection hole. The crankshaft has punch marks in 2 degree increments with 16 and 24 at each
end. Tighten the magneto attachment nuts and replace the plug in the inspection hole on top of the
engine.
8-40. HARNESS ASSEMBLY.
CAUTION
Insure before every cutting or stripping procedure that braid has not worked
back on lead by grasping lead in one hand and sliding the other hand firmly
along lead toward the outlet plate. If braid is improperly located on lead, the
lead may be trimmed to the wrong length.
10. Pass the lead through the proper hole in outlet plate. Position the Bendix 11-9596 or equivalent
Braid Cutting Backup Tube between the braided shielding and insulation to protect the insulation.
Cut enough braid from the lead to have 1-1/4 inch of insulation extending from end of braid.
CAUTION
Be sure the cutting backup tube is completely under the point at which the
cut is to be made to prevent cutting or nicking insulation.
11. Slide inner ferrule under the braid. The braid should cover approximately two-thirds of the ferrule
taper. Remove the blue silicone coating from the end of the braid over ferrule by lightly scraping
with a knife or wire brush.
CAUTION
When removing silicone coating, care should be taken not to damage the
braided wire shielding.
12. Pull the lead assembly back through cable outlet plate until cleaned braid binds in the outlet well.
Position the Bendix 11-7074 Ferrule Seating Tool (Figure 8-22) over the insulation and firmly seat
the ferrule by tapping the seating tool with a hammer or by using an arbor press.
13. Measure 1/2 inch from tapered ferrule and strip remaining insulation from wire. (Refer to
Figure 8-23.)
14. Insert Bendix 11-7073 Needle (Figure 8-24) through the small hole of the grommet and over the
stripped end of the wire. (Refer to Figure 8-25.) Slide grommet down needle until it seats tightly
against the tapered ferrule.
15. Cut the wire 3/8 inch from the top of the grommet outlet. (See Figure 8-26.) Double the wire over
as shown in A of Figure 8-27. Slide the eyelet over the doubled wire until it is firmly seated in the
recess of the grommet outlet.
16. Using a suitable crimping tool or equivalent, crimp the eyelet to the wire. Approximately 1/32 inch
of wire should extend from the end of the eyelet after crimping. See B of Figure 8-27.
NOTE
If the crimping tool is not available, a satisfactory connection can be made
by soldering with Kester Flux 709 or equivalent and a non-corrosive solder.
After soldering, clean solder joints using denatured alcohol.
Figure 8-22. Ferrule Seating Tool Figure 8-23. Measuring Wire From Top of Ferrule
Figure 8-26. Lead Assembly Installed in Grommet Figure 8-27. Wire Doubled Over
For Installation of Eyelet
17. Install the clamps and cable ties, as necessary, to secure the lead to the engine.
CAUTION
Leads should be dressed away from hot spots, such as manifolds and sharp
edges which cause chafing.
8-44. INSTALLATION OF HARNESS. Before installing the harness plate on the magneto, check the mating
surfaces for cleanliness. Spray the entire face of the grommet with a light coat of Plastic Mold Spray, SM-O-O-TH
Silicone Spray or equivalent. This will prevent the harness grommet from sticking to the magneto distributor block.
a. Place the harness terminal plate on the magneto and tighten the nuts around the plate alternately to seat
the cover squarely on the magneto. Torque the nuts to 18 to 22 inch-pounds.
b. Route the ignition wires to their respective cylinders as shown in Figure 8-28.
c. Clamp the harness assembly in position.
d. Connect the leads to the spark plugs.
8-50. DESCRIPTION. The oil system is a wet sump, force feed system with a capacity of 8 quarts. A
conventional dipstick is provided for determining the oil quantity.
When the engine is running, oil is drawn through a screen and pick up tube which extends from the sump
to a port in the crankcase. Oil then flows to the inlet of the gear type, engine driven oil pump and is forced
under pressure through the pump outlet. A pressure relief valve prevents excessive oil pressure by allowing
excess oil to be returned to the sump. After leaving the pump, the oil under pressure enters a full flow filter and
is passed onto the oil cooler. If the filter element becomes blocked, a bypass relief valve will open to permit
unfiltered oil to flow to the engine. An oil temperature control unit allows oil to bypass the oil cooler when the
oil is cold. Some oil flows through the cooler to prevent congealing in cold weather. When the oil temperature
reaches approximately 170°F, the oil temperature control unit actuates to close off the cooler bypass forcing
the oil to flow through the cooler.
From the oil cooler oil enters the crankcase where it is directed to the bearing surfaces and other engine
components requiring lubrication and cooling. The propeller governor boost engine oil pressure for operation
of the propeller. A tap in the side of the crankcase supplies oil pressure for lubrication of the turbocharger
bearings. Oil is carried to the turbocharger through an external line. After lubricating the turbocharger bearings
it is drawn into a scavenge pump and forced back to the oil sump. Oil within the engine drains, by gravity,
back into the sump.
8-51. OIL FILTER REPLACEMENT. (Refer to Figure 8-30.) The oil filter element should be replaced after
each 50 hours of engine operation. The filter element is mounted on the lower portion of the engine accessory
case. Replace the filter element as follows:
a. Remove the lockwire between the nut on the filter and the oil filter adapter and unscrew the filter
element.
b. Before installing a new filter, lubricate the gasket on the filter with engine oil.
c. Torque the filter 18 to 20 foot-pounds or 3/4 to 1 full turn after the gasket makes contact.
CAUTION
Do not over torque.
d. Run the engine and check for oil leaks; then install lockwire between nut on filter and adapter.
8-52. ENGINE FUEL SYSTEM.
8-53. DESCRIPTION. The fuel injection system is a multi-nozzle, continuous flow, altitude compensating
system that regulates fuel flow to match engine operating conditions. The system consists of an engine driven
fuel pump, a throttle body, a fuel manifold valve and fuel discharge nozzles.
The engine driven fuel pump is a positive displacement, rotary vane type pump with an integral vapor
separator and altitude compensating aneroid valve.
The throttle body consists of a rotary valve metering unit attached to an air throttle that controls the flow of
air to the engine. The position of the cam shaped edge of the rotary valve across the fuel delivery port and
engine driven pump controls the fuel flow to the manifold valve and nozzles, thus controlling the fuel-air ratio.
The fuel manifold valve is the central point for dividing fuel to the individual cylinders. A diaphragm and
plunger valve within the manifold valve raises or lowers by fuel pressure to open or close the individual fuel
supply ports simultaneously.
The fuel discharge nozzles are an air bleed type nozzle with a calibrated orifice. A nozzle is installed in the
cylinder head outside each intake valve for each cylinder.
8-54. FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM MAINTENANCE.
a. Check all attaching parts for tightness.
b. Check all fuel lines for leaks, evidence of damage, or chafing by metal to metal contact.
c. Check control connections, levers, and linkages for safety.
d. Inspect nozzles for cleanliness with particular attention to air screens and orifices. Use a standard 1/2
inch spark plug type deep socket to remove nozzles. Do not remove shield to clean air screens. Do not
use wire or other object to clean orifices. To clean nozzles, remove from engine and immerse in fresh
cleaning solvent. Use compressed air to dry.
e. Unscrew strainer plug from fuel injection control valve and clean screen in solvent. Reinstall, safety,
and check for leaks.
f. During periodic lubrication, add a drop of engine grade oil on each end of the air throttle shaft and at
each end of the linkage between the air throttle and fuel metering valve.
NOTE
Do not use any form of thread compound on fuel line fittings. Use only a
fuel soluble lubricant such as engine oil.
8-60. RIGGING THROTTLE, MIXTURE AND GOVERNOR CONTROLS. (Refer to Figure 8-33.)
a. Rig the throttle control as follows:
1. Place the quadrant throttle lever full forward.
2. With the control arm on the fuel-air control unit in the full throttle position. rig the throttle
quadrant lever to provide a minimum of .032 inches clearance from the forward stop. With the
control arm at the idle stop, the quadrant throttle lever must have a minimum clearance of .032
inches from the aft stop.
3. Rig the aft throttle micro-switch to actuate the gear warning horn and red light at a manifold
pressure of 14 ± 2 inches with the landing gear retracted.
b. Rig the propeller control as follows:
1. Place the propeller control lever full forward.
2. With the propeller governor control arm in the low pitch (high RPM) position, rig the quadrant
control lever to provide .047/.032 inches clearance from the forward stop.
c. Rig the mixture control as follows:
NOTE: Check the routing and security of the mixture cable to prevent interference between the cable and
the gear linkage.
1. Place the mixture control lever full forward.
2. With the mixture control arm on the engine fuel pump in the full rich position, rig the quadrant
mixture lever to provide a minimum of .032 inches clearance from the forward stop.
3. With the mixture control arm at idle cut-off, the quadrant mixture lever must have a minimum of
.032 inches clearance from the aft stop.
8-61. ENGINE SETUP PROCEDURES. The following procedures should be used to check and adjust the
power plant to maintain the required operating limits and insure obtaining good setup results. It is important
that the following leak check be made before proceeding with any actual system adjustments:
a. Leak Check - Gauge Lines:
1. Disconnect the manifold pressure, deck pressure, and fuel pressure lines on the forward side of the
rear engine baffle.
2. Connect surgical tubing to the fuel flow (deck pressure) bulkhead fitting and evacuate the line until
a 10 gallon per hour (maximum) positive indication on the fuel flow gauge is obtained. Clamp off
the tubing and observe the gauge for a steady reading. Any change of this reading would indicate a
leak in the system, which must be repaired prior to continuing with the setup procedures.
NOTE: A static system test unit can be-used to leak check these lines.
3. Check the fuel pressure and manifold pressure lines in the same manner as given in Step 2, except
apply positive pressure to the lines. Do not exceed 4 pounds per square inch (psi) on the fuel
pressure gauge, or 4 inches of mercury (In. Hg) increase on the manifold pressure gauge.
4. Visually inspect manifold pressure, deck pressure and fuel pressure lines forward of the engine
rear baffle for general condition which could cause leakage. Check all “B” nuts for tightness.
5. Reconnect the manifold pressure, fuel flow and fuel pressure lines at the bulkhead fitting.
6. Disconnect the main fuel supply line to the engine driven fuel pump, at the rear engine baffle and
using the auxiliary fuel pump, pump out approximately one quart of gasoline; then reconnect the
line.
7. Using the electric fuel boost pump, purge the air from the fuel flow gauge line at the back of the
instrument; then reconnect the line.
b. Exhaust Bypass Check: Ascertain that the exhaust bypass adjusting screw has from eight to nine
threads showing below the jam nut. This screw is preset at the factory and should not require any
adjustment, unless it is known that critical altitude is not correct; in this case, use procedure given in
Step k. (Refer to Figure 8-36.)
c. Idle Performance Check:
NOTE
It is extremely important that the engine be thoroughly warmed up.
H o w e v e r, excessive engine temperatures must be avoided since setup
temperature must closely parallel temperatures in flight.
1. Remove the cap from the tee fitting on the right side of the throttle body. (Refer to Figure 8-34.)
2. Install a 0-60 psig calibrated pressure gauge (vented to the atmosphere) to the tee, using a suitable
length of flexible tube. The gauge should always be at the same lever as the fuel manifold valve
when checking fuel pressure.
3. Purge the air from the tube.
CAUTION
During all engine operations outlined in these instructions, exercise
CAUTION to avoid harm or damage to personnel and equipment by
propeller blast and rotating propeller blades.
NOTE
Fuel flows are given for sea level density altitude.
1. Set the engine at 40.6 to 40.9 in. Hg manifold pressure (overboost light activated) and engine at
2575 ± 25 RPM. Readjust the throttle as required to maintain 40.6 to 40.9 in. Hg manifold.
2. Fuel flow should be 23.0 to 23.5 gallons per hour (gph), with the mixture controls in the full rich
position.
3. If adjustment is required, loosen the jam nut on the adjusting screw located on the aneroid housing
of the fuel pump. (Refer to Figure 8-35, item 2.) Clockwise adjustment decreases fuel flow
reading; counterclockwise adjustment increases fuel flow reading; one full turn will cause a 1.0 to
1.5 gph change. Use CAUTION when loosening and tightening the jam nut so as not to change
settings or over torque the am nut.
NOTE
If other than minor adjustments are required to the fuel flow, a complete
investigation of interface systems is required.
h. Rechecking System:
1. Recheck the idle settings per instructions c, d, e and f, and adjust as required.
2. Recheck Full Power Fuel Flow settings per instruction g, and adjust as required.
3. With engine operating at 2575 RPM (40.8 to 41.0 in. Hg manifold pressure), lean the mixture to
obtain 21 gph fuel flow readings. The unmetered fuel pressure on the calibrated pressure gauge
should be 37 to 40 psi.
4. With engines operating at 2575 RPM and 40.8 to 41.0 in. Hg manifold pressure, mixture control
full rich, reduce RPM and increase throttle until throttle is open. 41.0 in. Hg manifold pressure
should be obtained at approximately 2225 ± 25 RPM.
i. Remove test equipment; safety wire the exhaust bypass screw and check nut to the bypass screw
housing; reinstall the cap on the tee of the throttle body housing.
j. The accuracy of the cockpit fuel flow gauge at maximum power can be checked against a calibrated
gauge by connecting the calibrated gauge at the manifold valve and maintaining the gauge on the same
level as the valve while checking pressures and using Chart VIII-I.
NOTE
The calibrated gauge fuel line must be purged of air, and the reference side
of the calibrated gauge vented to turbo discharge pressure.
k. Flight Test: A complete flight test should be made for final adjustments of fuel flow and bypass valve.
The following steps should be followed:
1. At 8,000 feet density altitude, set the engines to operate at 2,450 ± 25 RPM and 33.0 to 34.0 in. Hg
manifold pressure.
2. Lean the engine to 25°F rich of peak exhaust gas temperature (EGT).
3. Fuel flow at these conditions should be 12.0 ± 0.5 gph.
4. With full rich mixture, full throttle, 2,575 ± 25 RPM, and 105 MPH airspeed. the manifold
pressure should decrease until the overboost lights goes off (40.8 to 41.0 in. Hg), at some point
between 11,500 feet minimum, l2,500 feet maximum density altitude. This point is known as the
“critical altitude.” At this point the fuel flow should be 22.0 to 24.0 gph indicated.
5. If a discrepancy in critical altitude was noted, adjust the exhaust bypass valve. (Turning the
exhaust bypass valve screw in one full turn will increase the critical altitude approximately 1,000
feet.) Adjustments of critical altitude in excess of 500 feet may require retrimming of the fuel
flows at 100% power.
6. With full rich mixture, 2,575 RPM, 105 MPH airspeed, and 1,000 to 3,000 feet density altitude,
check the operation of the manifold pressure relief valve. Slowly advance one throttle to the wide
open position. The manifold pressure shall stabilize between 42.0 and 44.0 in. Hg; there shall be
no loss of power, and the fuel flow indication shall be well over the red line. Do not exceed 41.0
in. Hg manifold pressure for more than ten seconds.
NOTE
Idle speed and idle mixture indication is a function of engine temperatures.
Therefore, at normal ground idle temperatures (cylinder and oil
temperature indications may or may not be “in the green”) idle speed will be
approximately 700 RPM, and the idle mixture check will result in a 25 to 50
RPM increase in engine speed .
Engine will not No fuel gauge pres- Check fuel control for proper position, auxiliary
start. sure - no fuel to pump “ON” and operating, feed valves open. Fuel
engine. filters open and tank fuel level.
Have gauge pressure - Turn off auxiliary pump and ignition switch; set
engine flooded. throttle to “FULL OPEN” and fuel control to
“IDLE CUTOFF,” and crank engine to clear cylin-
ders of excess fuel. Repeat starting procedure.
Have gauge pres- Check for bent or loose fuel lines. Loosen line
sure - no fuel to at fuel nozzle. If no fuel shows, replace fuel
engine. manifold valve.
Engine starts but Inadequate fuel to Set fuel control in “FULL RICH” position; turn
fails to keep fuel manifold valve. auxiliary pump “ON,” check to be sure feed lines
running. and filters are not restricted. Clean or replace
defective components.
Engine runs rough Improper idle mix- Readjust idle setting. Turn adjustment screw
at idle. ture adjustment. clockwise to lean mixture and counterclockwise
to richen mixture.
Engine runs rough Improper fuel-air Check manifold connections for leaks. Tighten
at speeds above mixture. loose connections. Check fuel control for
idle. setting and adjustment. Check fuel filters and
screens for dirt. Check for proper pump pressure
and readjust as necessary.
Ignition system and Clean and regap spark plugs. Check ignition cables
spark plugs de- for defects. Replace defective components.
fective.
Engine lacks Incorrectly adjusted Check movement of linkage by moving control from
power, reduction throttle control, idle to full throttle. Make proper adjustments and
in maximum man- “sticky” linkage replace worn components. Service air cleaner.
ifold pressure or dirty air cleaner.
or critical al-
titude. Improperly adjusted Check exhaust bypass screw adjustment. (Refer to
waste gate valve. Paragraph 8-61.)
Engine lacks Defective ignition Inspect spark plugs for fouled electrodes, heavy
power, reduction system. carbon deposits, erosion of electrodes, improperly
in maximum man- adjusted electrode gaps and cracked porcelains.
ifold pressure Test plugs for regular firing under pressure. Re-
or critical al- place damaged or misfiring plugs. Spark plug gap to
titude. (cont.) be 0.015 to 0.019 in.
Exhaust system gas Inspect exhaust system for gas leakage, gaskets
leakage. at turbine inlet flanges, etc., and correct.
Low fuel pressure. Restricted flow to Check mixture control for full travel. Check for
fuel metering valve. restrictions in fuel filters and lines; adjust
control and clean filters. Replace damaged parts.
Fuel nozzle vent Check venting system for leaks at connections and
system defective other defects. Tighten connections and replace
causing improper defective parts.
pressure regula-
tion.
Fuel control lever Check operation of throttle control and for possible
interference. contact with cooling shroud. Adjust as required to
obtain correct operation.
Defective fuel in- Replace pump if cleaning and lapping valve does not
jector pump relief correct problem.
valve.
High fuel Restricted flow be- Check for restricted fuel nozzles or fuel manifold
pressure. yond fuel control valve. Clean or replace nozzles. Replace defective
assembly. fuel manifold valve.
Defective relief Check fuel injector pump control line from turbo-
valve operation charger for loose connections and defects. Tighten
in fuel in- connections, replace damaged line.
jector
Fluctuating fuel Vapor in fuel Normally operating the auxiliary pump will clear
pressure. system. system. Operate auxiliary pump and purge system.
Fuel gauge line leak Purge gauge line and tighten connections.
or improperly purged
lines.
Low oil pressure Insufficient oil in Add oil or change oil to proper viscosity.
on engine gauge. oil sump, oil dilu-
tion or using im-
proper grade oil for
prevailing ambient
temperature.
Low oil pressure Leaking oil seal Check for oil in turbocharger exhaust outlet. Re
on engine gauge. in turbocharger. place turbocharger.
(cont.)
Poor engine idle Engine getting fuel. Check fuel control for being in full “IDLE CUTOFF”
cutoff. position. Check auxiliary pump for being “OFF.”
Check for leaking fuel manifold valve. Replace de-
fective components.
POWER PLANT
LYCOMING
(PA-28R-201)
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper Aircraft,
it is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
8A-1. INTRODUCTION. This section covers the power plant used in PA-28R-201 airplanes and is comprised
of instructions for the removal, minor repair, service and installation of the propeller, propeller governor,
engine, induction system, fuel injector, fuel air bleed nozzle, ignition system and lubrication system.
For further instructions on major repairs, consult the appropriate publication of the engine or component
manufacturer.
8A-1a. STANDARD PRACTICES-ENGINE. The following suggestions should be applied wherever they are
needed when working on the power plant.
The following suggestions should be applied wherever they are needed when working on the power plant.
a. To ensure proper reinstallation and/or assembly, tag and mark all parts, clips, and brackets as to their
location prior to their removal and/or disassembly.
b. During removal of various tubes or engine parts, inspect them for indications of scoring, burning or
other undesirable conditions. To facilitate reinstallation, observe the location of each part during
removal. Tag any unserviceable part and/or units for investigation and possible repair.
c. Extreme care must be taken to prevent foreign matter from entering the engine, such as lockwire,
washers, nuts, dirt, dust, etc. This precaution applies whenever work is done on the engine, either on or
off the aircraft. Suitable protective caps, plugs, and covers must be used to protect all openings as they
are exposed.
NOTE
Dust caps used to protect open lines must always be installed OVER the
tube ends and NOT IN the tube ends. Flow through the lines may be
blocked off if lines are inadvertently installed with dust caps in the tube
ends.
d. Should any items be dropped into the engine, the assembly process must stop and the item removed,
even though this may require considerable time and labor. Ensure that all parts are thoroughly clean
before assembling.
e. Never reuse any lockwire, lockwashers, tablocks, tabwashers or cotter pins. All lockwire and cotter
pins must fit snugly in holes drilled in studs and bolts for locking purposes. Cotter pins should be
installed so the head fits into the castellation of the nut, and unless otherwise specified, bend one end
of the pin back over the stud or bolt and the other end down flat against the nut. Use only corrosion
resistant steel lockwire and/or cotter pins. Bushing plugs shall be lockwired to the assembly base or
case. Do not lockwire the plug to the bushing.
f. All gaskets, packings and rubber parts must be replaced with the new items of the same type at
reassembly. Ensure the new nonmetallic parts being installed show no sign of having deteriorated in
storage.
g. When installing engine parts which require the use of a hammer to facilitate assembly or installation,
use only a plastic or rawhide hammer.
h. Anti-seize lubrication should be applied to all loose-fit spline drives which are external to the engine
and have no other means of lubrication. For certain assembly procedures, molybdenum disulfide in
either paste or powdered form mixed with engine oil or grease may be used.
—CAUTION—
Ensure that Anti-seize compounds are applied in thin even coats, and that
excess compound is completely removed to avoid contamination of adjacent
parts.
8A-4. PROPELLER.
NOTE
Nuts with studs will have to be backed out evenly so that propeller may be
pulled forward (approx. 1/4-inch at a time) until all studs are disengaged
from the engine crankshaft flange.
Hartzell McCauley
Blade Angle* Low Pitch (High RPM) 14.0° ± 0.2° 12.5° ± 0.2°
*Measured at 30 inch station. High Pitch (Low RPM) 29.0° ± 2° 27.5° ± 0.5°
Propeller RPM Setting Engine Static High RPM 2700 RPM Max.
8A-13. ENGINE.
NOTE
Bushings should be inspected each 100 hours and should be
replaced upon condition, but no later than 500 hours time in
service.
NOTE
It should not be necessary to replace the pins unless bushing in
lower cowling has worn enough to allow damage to the pin. Any
noticeable notching or cutting of the pin requires replacement.
e. If it is necessary to remove the pins, appropriate tools should be used to remove the fiberglass resin
from around the pin and plate assembly. (A template or adequate measurements should be made to assure
proper alignment of the new pin and plate assembly.)
f. Remove pin and plate assembly
g. To install new pin and plate assembly it will be necessary to prepare the fiberglass surface to accept
the new plate. (See Paragraph 4-56, FIBERGLASS REPAIRS.)
1. Clean area as required, and roughen.
2. Prepare cowling surface by applying resin. Do not allow to harden.
3. Install plate and pin.
4. Lay in a layer of resin impregnated fiberglass cloth over the plate and surrounding fiberglass. (Use
template or measurements from step e to assure alignment.) Allow to cure.
1
1. UPPER COWL ASSEMBLY
2. LOWER COWL ASSEMBLY
4 3. OIL FILLER DOOR ASSEMBLY
4. FASTENER ASSEMBLY
5. PIN PLATE ASSEMBLY
6. PLATE ASSEMBLY, BUSHING,
RETAINING RING, WASHERS, NUTS
2
NOTE
Where a question may arise as where to reconnect hose, line or wire, the
item at the separation should be identified (tagged) to facilitate
reinstallation. Open fuel, oil, vacuum lines and fittings should be covered to
prevent contamination.
k. Disconnect both lines from the oil cooler.
1. Disconnect the magneto “P” leads at the magnetos.
m. Disconnect the engine vent tube at the engine.
n. Disconnect the engine oil temperature lead at the aft end of the engine.
o. Disconnect the tachometer drive cable at the engine.
p. Untie the ignition harness, hoses and lines at the aft end of the engine.
q. Disconnect the vacuum pump lines at pump and remove fittings from pump.
r. Disconnect the oil pressure line at the engine.
s. Disconnect the static and fuel flow line at the right rear engine baffle.
t. Disconnect the manifold pressure line at the right rear side of the engine.
u. Disconnect the injector line at the flow divider.
v. Disconnect the alternator leads and the cable attachment clamps.
w. Attach a one-half ton (minimum) hoist to the hoisting straps and relieve the tension from the engine
mounts.
NOTE
Place a tail stand under the tail of the airplane before removing the engine.
x. Check the engine for any attachments remaining to obstruct its removal.
y. Drain the engine oil, if desired, and then close drain.
z. Remove the four engine mount assemblies and swing the engine free, being careful not to damage any
attaching parts.
8A-15. INSTALLATION OF ENGINE.
a. Attach a one-half ton (minimum) hoist to the engine hoisting straps and swing the engine into
alignment with its attaching points.
b. Insert an engine mount bolt, with washer against head, in the engine mount and slide half of the mount
assembly on the bolt. Repeat this procedure for the other three attachment points. (Refer to Figure 8A-4.)
c. Position the mounting lugs of the engine so that they align with the engine mount attaching points,
then move the engine rearward onto the mounts.
d. Slide onto each mounting bolt a spacer washer, spacer and the forward half of the mount. Install
washer and nut, and torque the nuts of the bolts to 450 to 500 inch-pounds.
e. Connect the alternator leads and secure cable with clamps.
f. Connect the injector line to the flow divider.
g. Connect the manifold pressure line at the right rear side of the engine.
h. Connect the static and fuel flow line at the right rear engine baffle.
i. Connect the oil pressure line.
j. Install the line fitting in the vacuum pump and install lines.
k. Connect the tachometer drive cable.
1. Connect the oil temperature lead.
m. Connect the engine vent tube.
2. Adjust the linkage by rotating the rod end on the cable to obtain 0.010 to 0.030O fan inch spring
back on instrument panel stop when in full throttle position.
3. On aircraft equipped with air conditioning systems, a micro switch is located below the throttle
control which is set to actuate in the full open position. With the throttle control adjusted to obtain
a clearance of .010 to .030, adjust the micro switch to actuate at this point also.
4. Reconnect the rod end to the control arm and safety.
b. The mixture may be adjusted as follows:
NOTE: Check the routing and security of the mixture cable to prevent interference between the cable and
the gear linkage.
1. At the fuel injector, disconnect the rod end of the mixture control cable from the control arm.
Loosen the jam nut that secures the clevis end.
2. Adjust the linkage by rotating the rod end on the cable to obtain 0.010 to 0.030 of an inch spring
back on the instrument stop when in full rich position.
3. Reconnect the rod end to the control arm and safety.
c. Check security of cable casing attachments.
d. Pull the throttle and mixture levers in the cockpit full aft to ascertain that the idle screw contacts its
stop and the mixture control arm contacts its lean position. A mixture control lock is incorporated in
the quadrant cover which prevents the mixture control from being moved to the idle cutoff position
inadvertently. The lock must be depressed before the control can be moved completely aft. Ascertain
that the lock operates freely without any tendency to bind or hang up.
8A-17. INDUCTION AIR FILTER.
a. The filter should be cleaned daily when operating in dusty conditions. If any holes or tears are noticed,
the filter must be replaced immediately.
b. Remove the filter element and shake off loose dirt by rapping on a hard flat surface, being careful not
to damage or crease the sealing ends.
3. Check all fuel lines for tightness and evidence of leakage. A slight fuel stain adjacent to the air
bleed nozzles is not cause for concern.
4. Check throttle and mixture control rod ends and levers for tightness and lock.
5. Remove and clean the injector inlet strainer at the first 25 hours of operation and each 50 hour
inspection thereafter. Check the screen for distortion or openings in the strainer. Replace for either
of these conditions. Clean screen assembly in solvent and dry with compressed air. Damaged
strainer “O” rings should be replaced. To install the screen assembly, place the gasket on the
screen assembly and install the assembly in the throttle body and tighten to 35-40 inch-pounds
torque.
8A-21. ADJUSTMENT OF IDLE SPEED AND MIXTURE.
a. Start the engine and warm up in the usual manner until oil and cylinder head temperatures are normal.
b. Check magnetos. If the “mag-drop” is normal, proceed with idle adjustment.
c. Set throttle stop screw so that the engine idles at 550-600 RPM. If the RPM changes appreciable after
making the mixture adjustment during the succeeding steps, readjust the idle speed to the desired
RPM.
d. When the idling speed has been stabilized, move the cockpit mixture control lever with a smooth,
steady pull toward the “Idle-Cut-Off” position and observe the tachometer for any change during the
leaning process. Caution must be exercised to return the mixture control to the “Full Rich” position
before the RPM can drop to a point where the engine cuts out. An increase of more than 10 RPM
while “leaning out” indicates an excessively rich idle mixture. An immediate decrease in RPM (if not
preceded by a momentary increase) indicates the idle mixture is too lean.
e. If the above indicates that the idle adjustment is too rich or too lean, turn the idle mixture adjustment
in the direction required for correction, and check this new position by repeating the above procedure.
Make additional adjustments as necessary until a check results in a momentary pick-up of
approximately 5 (never more than 10) RPM. Each time the adjustment is changed, the engine should
be run up to 2000 RPM to clear the engine before proceeding with the RPM check. Make final
adjustment of the idle speed adjustment to obtain the desired idling RPM with closed throttle. The
above method aims at a setting that will obtain maximum RPM with minimum manifold pressure. In
case the setting does not remain stable, check the idle linkage; any looseness in this linkage would
cause erratic idling. In all cases, allowance should be made for the effect of weather conditions and
field altitude upon idling adjustment.
8A-22. FUEL-AIR BLEED NOZZLE.
8A-23. REMOVAL OF FUEL-AIR BLEED NOZZLE. The nozzles must be carefully removed as they or the
cylinders may be damaged.
a. Remove the lower engine cowl.
b. Disconnect the fuel line from the nozzle.
c. Carefully remove the nozzle, using the correct size deep socket.
d. Clean and inspect the nozzle as given in Paragraph 8A-24.
8A-24. CLEANING AND INSPECTION OF FUEL-AIR BLEED NOZZLE.
a. Clean the nozzle with acetone or equivalent and blow out all foreign particles with compressed air in
the direction opposite that of fuel flow. Do not use wire or other hard objects to clean orifices. (Refer
to latest revision Lycoming Service Instruction No. 1275.)
b. Inspect the nozzle and cylinder threads for nicks, stripping or cross-threading.
c. Inspect for battered or rounded hexagons.
d. A test procedure for air bleed nozzles is described in latest revision Lycoming Service Instruction
No. 1275.
8A-26. MAGNETO.
CAUTION
Ascertain that the primary circuit of both magnetos is grounded before
working on the engine.
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper Aircraft,
it is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
NOTE
Comply with latest revision of Bendix Service Bulletin No. 608 at first
opportunity, but no later than next magneto overhaul. Install self-locking
cam retaining screw (10-391213) and torque to 21-25 inchpounds. If self-
locking screw is removed at any time always replace with new self-locking
screw and torque to the specified value.
a. After the first 25 hour and 50 hour periods, and periodically thereafter, the contact assemblies should
be checked. Examine the points for excessive wear or burning. Points which have deep pits or
excessively burned areas should be discarded. Examine the cam follower felt for proper lubrication. If
necessary, points can be cleaned by using any hard finished paper. Clean breaker compartment with
dry cloth.
b. If engine operating troubles develop which appear to be caused by the ignition system it is advisable to
check the spark plugs and wiring first before working on the magnetos.
c. Should the trouble appear definitely associated with the magneto, the most effective measure is to
install a replacement magneto which is known to be in satisfactory condition and send the suspected
unit to the overhaul shop for test and repair.
d. Should this not be possible, a visual inspection may disclose the source of trouble. Remove the harness
outlet plate from the magneto. Inspect for the presence of moisture and foreign matter on the rubber
grommet and high tension outlet side of the distributor block. Check height of block contact springs
(0.422 maximum from top of the block tower to the spring). Also check for broken leads or damaged
insulation. If either is present, remove magneto and replace with one known to be in satisfactory
condition.
e. Remove the breaker cover and harness securing screws and nuts and separate cover from magneto
housing. Check contact assemblies to see that cam follower is securely riveted to its spring. Examine
the contact points for excessive wear or burning. Figure 8A-8 shows how the average contact point
will look when surfaces are separated for inspection. Desired contact surfaces have a dull gray, sand-
blasted (almost rough) or frosted appearance, over the area where electrical contact is made. This
means that points are worn in and mated to each other, thereby providing the best possible electrical
contact and highest efficiency of performance.
f. Minor irregularities or roughness of point surfaces are not harmful. (Refer to Figure 8A-8, center.)
Neither are small pits or mounds, if not too pronounced. If there is a possibility of pit becoming deep
enough to penetrate pad, Figure 8A-8, right, reject contact assembly.
NOTE
No attempt should be made to stone or dress contact points. Should contact
assembly have bad points or show excessive wear, the complete contact
assembly should be replaced.
g. Check the condition of the cam follower felt. Squeeze felt tightly between thumb and forefinger. If
fingers are not moistened with oil, re-oil using 2 or 3 drops of Scintilla 10-391200 lubricant. Allow
approximately 30 minutes for felt to absorb the oil. Blot off the excess with a clean cloth. Too much oil
may foul contact points and cause excessive burning.
h. Check the capacitor mounting bracket for cracks or looseness. Using the Scintilla 11-1767-1, -2 or -3
Condenser Tester or equivalent, check capacitor for capacitance, series resistance and leakage.
Capacitance shall be at least 0.30 microfarads.
i. Check magneto to engine timing as follows:
1. Connect Scintilla 11-851 Timing Light or equivalent across the contact assembly.
2. Slowly bring the engine up to number one cylinder advance firing position as instructed in
Paragraph 8A-30. At this instant the timing light should go out. If it does, the magneto is properly
timed to the engine. If the timing light does not go out, removal of the magneto for internal timing
check and inspection is recommended.
NOTE
The magneto service instructions in this manual are to cover minor repairs
and timing. For further repairs and adjustments of the magneto, it is
recommended that the manufacturer ’s recommended service instructions be
followed.
Figure 8A-9. Rotor Holding Tool Installed Figure 8A-10. Timing Kit Installed
8A-28. REMOVAL OF MAGNETO. Before removing the magneto, make sure magneto switches are off.
a. Remove the harness assembly terminal plate from the magneto.
WARNING
The magneto is not internally grounded; when the ground lead is
disconnected, the magneto is hot. Removing the harness assembly terminal
plate first and installing them last minimizes the danger of starting the
engine accidentally when the ground lead is removed from the magneto.
b. Disconnect the ground lead at the magneto.
c. Remove the nuts and washers and draw the magneto from the engine.
8A-29. TIMING PROCEDURE (INTERNAL TIMING).
a. Remove the cover to the contact(s), distributor block, etc.
b. To internally time the contact assembly of the single-breaker magnetos, proceed as follows:
1. Loosen the nut securing the drive plate to the magneto shaft sufficiently in order to install the
Scintilla 11-8465 Rotor Holding Tool under the nut and flat washer as shown in Figure 8A-9.
Tighten the nut securely.
2. Remove the timing inspection plug from the top of the magneto. Turn rotating magneto to proper
neutral position. This position is determined by locating keyways on drive end of magnet shaft at
12 o’clock with respect to name plate on housing. Tighten adjusting knob of 11-8465 Rotor
Holding Tool until pressure is applied on housing flange preventing magnet from turning.
3. Loosen and rotate cam until cam follower of contact assembly rests on highest point of cam lobe.
Adjust contact assembly to obtain the clearance of 0.016 of an inch. Tighten contact assembly
securing screws to 20-25 inch-pounds.
Figure 8A-11. Aligning Timing Marks Figure 8A-12. Checking Flyweight Clearance of
Impulse Coupling
4. Install the 11-8693 Timing Plate Assembly and the 11-8149 Pointer Assembly of the 11-8150
Scintilla Timing Kit to breaker compartment of magneto. (Refer to Figure 8A-10.) Align pointer
assembly with the 0 mark on timing plate. Loosen adjusting knob of 11-8465 Rotor Holding Tool
and turn rotating magnet in normal direction of rotation until pointer indexes with the respective E
gap mark (15° ± 2°). Tighten adjusting knob of 11-8465 Tool and remove the 11-8149 Pointer
Assembly from magneto. Using a timing light, adjust contact points to just open. This adjustment
shall be made by rotating cam, in opposite direction of rotation until contacts just open. While
holding cam in this exact position, push cam on magnet shaft as far as possible with the fingers.
Extreme care must be exercised in this operation. If cam adjustment is changed in the slightest
degree, the timing of the magneto will be thrown off. Do not drive cam on shaft with a mallet or
other instrument. Tighten the securing screw thereby drawing the cam down, evenly and tightly.
Torque screw to 16-20 inch-pounds. Loosen the 11-8465 Rotor Holding Tool adjusting knob and
return rotating magnet to neutral position. Reinstall the 11-8149 Pointer Assembly over 0 mark on
timing plate. Rotate magnet shaft in normal direction of rotation and check for opening of main
contact points at E gap setting (15° ± 2° ).
c. If the distributor block was not removed from the housing, the internal timing may be checked by
turning the magneto in the normal rotation to number one firing position (keyway up and points just
opening). At this position, the reference line on the distributor block should line up between the L and
LB marks on the gear. On single contact magnetos the line should favor the L mark, if possible.
d. If the distributor block was removed from the housing, the distributor gear alignment and internal
check may be accomplished as followed:
1. Turn rotating magnet in direction of rotation until it is located in firing position (keyway up and
points just opening). Tighten adjusting knob of 11-8465 Rotor Holding Tool. Apply a light coating
of Bendix Grease P/N 10-27165 to teeth of distributor gear, if needed. The large distributor gear
incorporates four timing marks, L and LB for left-hand rotation and R and RB for right-hand
rotation.
2. With distributor gear assembled to block, turn gear until raised rib on block lines up between the L
and LB marks. Assemble block and gear into housing, meshing the distributor gears together. The
rib should favor the L mark, if possible. (Refer to Figure 8A-11.)
Revised: 8/31/77 POWER PLANT - LYCOMING
2D15
CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
3. Secure distributor block to housing with studs and washers. Tighten studs finger tight. Loosen the
11-8465 Rotor Holding Tool and turn rotating magnet in reverse direction of rotation until timing
light indicates contact assembly had just opened and check to make certain timing marks align
within tolerance indicated above. Tighten block securing studs, first to 4-8 inch-pounds torque and
then final torque to 20 inch-pounds.
4. Insert the tip of your small finger through timing hole in housing and against large distributor gear
teeth. Rock distributor gear back and forth slightly. There must be perceptible backlash between
teeth of large and small gears. This check should be made at three different points, 120° apart on
gear. If backlash is not evident, replace large distributor gear.
5. Install the breaker cover and complete reassembly of the magneto. Refer to the manufacturer’s
publications for complete disassembly and reassembly procedures.
e. On the magneto employing the impulse coupling, check clearance between each flyweight and each
stop pin as follows:
1. Bend the end of a stiff piece of wire into a right angle 1/8 inch long (maximum).
2. Hold magneto as shown in Figure 8A-12. Pull heel of flyweight outward with the hooked wire and
make certain that feeler gauge of 0.010 inch minimum thickness will pass between stop pin and
the highest point of the flyweight.
NOTE
A true and accurate check of the clearance between flyweight and stop pin
can only be obtained by pulling the flyweight outward as described above.
Do not attempt the check by pushing in on flyweight at point “A.”
f. Install and time magneto, removed from engine, in accordance with Paragraph 8A-30.
g. Secure external switch leads to the breaker cover terminals. Connect harness assembly to the magneto.
8A-30. INSTALLATION AND TIMING PROCEDURE (TIMING MAGNETO TO ENGINE). Although only
the left magneto is equipped with an impulse coupling, the timing procedure, in the following paragraphs, is
the same for both magnetos.
a. Remove the spark plug from No. 1 cylinder and place a thumb over the spark plug hole. Rotate the
crankshaft in direction of normal rotation until the compression stroke is reached, this is indicated by a
positive pressure inside the cylinder tending to push the thumb off the spark plug hole. Continue
rotating the crankshaft in direction of normal rotation until the advance timing mark (25) on the front
face of the starter ring gear is in exact alignment with the small hole located at the two o’clock
position on the front face of the starter housing. (Refer to Figure 8A-13.)
NOTE
The advance timing mark on the top face of the starter ring gear is marked
at both 20° and 25° BTC. Use only the 25° BTC mark when timing the
magnetos to the engine.
NOTE
If the crankshaft is accidentally turned in the direction opposite normal
rotation, repeat the above procedure as accumulated backlash will make the
final timing incorrect.
Figure 8A-13. Engine Timing Marks Figure 8A-14. Magneto Adjustment Limits
b. At this point, the engine is ready for assembly of the magnetos. Remove the inspection plugs from
both magnetos and turn the drive shafts in direction of normal rotation (counterclockwise facing the
coupling), until the first painted chamfered tooth on the distributor gear is aligned in the center of the
inspection window. (Refer to Figure 8A-15.) Being sure that the gear does not move from this
position, install gaskets and magnetos on the engine. Secure with washers and nuts; tighten only finger
tight.
NOTE
The magnetos are held in place by clamps which allows them to be timed in
several positions. Since all positions will not give the required clearance
between magneto and engine mount, the magnetos must be installed from
the horizontal position to 20° above the horizontal as shown in Figure 8A-
14. Improper installation of magnetos could cause damage or failure.
NOTE
In order to turn the shaft on an impulse coupling magneto, depress pawl on
the impulse coupling with the finger.
c. Using a battery powered timing light, attach the positive lead to a suitable terminal connected to the
ground terminal of the magneto and the negative lead to any unpainted portion of the engine. Rotate
the magneto in its mounting flange to a point where the light comes on, then slowly turn it in the
opposite direction until the light goes out. Bring the magneto back slowly until the light just comes on.
Repeat this with the second magneto.
NOTE
AC timing lights operate in the reverse manner as described above; the light
goes out when the breaker points open.
Revised: 8/31/77 POWER PLANT - LYCOMING
2D17
CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
Figure 8A-15. Magneto Timing Marks Figure 8A-16. Removing Spring From Lead
Assembly
d. After both magnetos have been timed, check, as described below, to ascertain that both magnetos are
set to fire together.
e. Back off the crankshaft a few degrees; the timing lights should go out. Bring the crankshaft slowly
back in direction of normal rotation until the timing mark and the hole in the starter housing are in
alignment. At this point, both lights should go on simultaneously. Tighten nuts to specified torque.
f. After magnetos have been properly timed, replace breaker cover and secure.
g. Install the ground lead and the retard spark lead on the left magneto.
h. Place the harness terminal plate on the magneto and tighten nut around the plate alternately to seat
cover squarely on magneto. Torque nuts to 18 to 22 inch-pounds.
8A-31. HARNESS ASSEMBLY.
Figure 8A-20. Cutting Metallic Braid From End Figure 8A-21. Unbraiding Metallic Shielding
of Lead
6. Cut lead assembly to the length determined in Step 5. Mark ferrule on spark plug end of lead with
a metal stamp, scribe or rubber stamp to correspond with correct cylinder number.
7. Starting at spark plug location, thread new cable through grommets and clamps as necessary for
correct routing of cut end of cable to magneto location.
8. Using electrician’s scissors, carefully remove 1.250 inch of outer braid from end of lead. (Refer to
Figure 8A-20.)
CAUTION
Use care not to nick or cut insulation when removing braid.
9. Using a scribe or similar pointed tool, unbraid 3/8 inch of braided shielding. (Refer to Figure 8A-
21.) Wrap a single thickness of electrical tape around unbraided strands to facilitate insertion of
lead end through hole in cable outlet plate.
10. Remove cable outlet plate from magneto. Support plate securely and, using suitable cutting pliers,
split and remove eyelets from leads adjacent to lead being replaced. When splitting eyelet make
certain that wire strands are not cut. Removal of eyelets on adjacent leads will allow grommet to
be pulled away from outlet plate to facilitate insertion of new lead.
11. Pass the taped end of new lead through hole in outlet plate. Remove electrical tape from lead and
install tapered end of ferrule under the unbraided strands of shielding. Form strands of shielding
evenly as shown in Figure 8A-22 and pull lead assembly back through cable outlet plate until
ferrule binds in the outlet well. Position the Scintilla 11-7074 Ferrule Seating Tool (Figure 8A-23)
over the wire and firmly seat the ferrule by tapping the seating tool with a hammer or by using an
arbor press.
12. Measure 1/2 inch from tapered ferrule and strip remaining insulation from wire. (Refer to Figure
8A-25.)
13. Insert Scintilla 11-7073 Needle (Figure 8A-24) through small hole of grommet and over stripped
end of wire. (Refer to Figure 8A-26.) Slide grommet down needle until it seats tightly against the
tapered ferrule.
14. Cut wire 3/8 inch from top of grommet outlet. (Refer to Figure 8A-27.) Double wire over as
shown in A of Figure 8A-28. Slide eyelet over doubled wire until it is firmly seated in recess of
grommet outlet.
15. Using the “AB” groove of Scintilla 114152 Crimping Tool, or equivalent, crimp eyelet to wire.
Approximately 1/32 of an inch of wire should extend from end of eyelet after crimping. (Refer to
B of Figure 8A-28.)
NOTE
If the crimping tool is not available, a satisfactory connection can be made
by soldering with Kester Flux 709 or equivalent and a non-corrosive solder.
After soldering, clean solder joints using denatured alcohol.
16. Install clamps and cable ties as necessary to secure lead to the engine.
Figure 8A-25. Measuring Wire From Top of Figure 8A-26. Installing Grommet Over Lead
Ferrule Assemblies
Figure 8A-27. Lead Assembly Installed in Grommet Figure 8A-28. Wire Doubled Over for Installation
of Eyelet
Revised: 8/31/77 POWER PLANT - LYCOMING
2D23
CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
8A-35. INSTALLATION OF HARNESS. Before installing harness on magneto, check mating surfaces for
cleanliness. Spray entire face of grommet with a light coat of Plastic Mold Spray, SM-OOTH Silicone Spray or
equivalent. This will prevent harness grommet from sticking to magneto distributor block.
a. Place the harness terminal plate on the magneto and tighten nuts around the plate alternately to seat
cover squarely on magneto. Torque nuts to 18 to 22 inch-pounds.
b. Route ignition wires to their respective cylinders.
c. Clamp the harness assembly in position.
d. Connect the leads to the spark plugs.
8A-36. SPARK PLUGS.
d. Removal of seized spark plugs in the cylinder may be accomplished by application of liquid carbon
dioxide by a Conical metal funnel adapter with a hole at the apex just large enough to accommodate
the funnel of a CO2 bottle. (Refer to Figure 8A-29.) When a seized spark plug cannot be removed by
normal means, the funnel adapter is placed over and around the spark plug. Place the funnel of the
CO2 bottle inside the funnel adapter and release the carbon dioxide to chill and contract the spark
plug. Break the spark plug loose with a wrench. A warm cylinder head at the time the carbon dioxide
is applied will aid in the removal of an excessively seized plug.
e. Do not allow foreign objects to enter the spark plug hole.
8A-38. INSPECTION AND CLEANING OF SPARK PLUG.
a. Visually inspect each spark plug for the following non-repairable defects:
1. Severely damaged shell or shield threads nicked up, stripped or crossthreaded.
2. Badly battered or rounded shell hexagons.
3. Out-of-round or damaged shielding barrel.
4. Chipped, cracked or broken ceramic insulator portions.
5. Badly eroded electrodes worn to approximately 50% of original size.
b. Clean the spark plug as required, removing carbon and foreign deposits.
c. Set the electrode gap at .015 to .018 inches.
d. Test the spark plug both electrically and for resistance.
8A-39. INSTALLATION OF SPARK PLUGS. Before installing spark plugs, ascertain that the threads within
the cylinder are clean and not damaged.
a. Apply anti-seize compound sparingly on the threads and install gasket and spark plugs. Torque 360 to
420 inch-pounds.
CAUTION
Make certain the deep socket is properly seated on the spark plug hexagon
as damage to the plug could result if the wrench is cocked to one side when
pressure is applied.
b. Carefully insert the terminal insulator in the spark plug and tighten the coupling unit.
8A-40. LUBRICATION SYSTEM.
8A-41. OIL PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE. The function of the oil pressure relief valve, which is located
between the upper right engine mounting lug and No. 3 cylinder, is to maintain engine oil pressure within
specified limits by withdrawing a portion of the oil from the circulating system and returning the oil to the
sump should the pressure become excessive. This valve is not adjustable; however, particles of metal or other
foreign matter lodged between ball and seat will result in a drop in oil pressure. It is advisable, therefore, to
disassemble, inspect and clean the relief valve if excessive pressure fluctuations are noted.
The oil pressure relief valve is by no means to be confused with the oil cooler by-pass which is located on
the oil pressure screen housing mounting pad. The sole purpose of the by-pass valve is to serve as a safety
measure, permitting pressure oil to by-pass the oil cooler entirely in case of an obstruction within the cooler.
8A-42. ENGINE OIL QUICK DRAIN VALVE. When replacing the engine oil quick drain, refer to the Piper
Parts Catalog for the correct part number. Installation of an incorrect drain could lead to damage of the sump or
the drain itself. This may result in loss of engine oil and a possible engine seizure.
High oil temperature. Insufficient oil supply. Fill oil sump to proper
(cont.) level with specified oil.
Revised: 01/31/09
2E8
CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
SECTION IX
FUEL SYSTEM
9-1. INTRODUCTION. The fuel system components covered in this section consist of the fuel tanks, selector
valves, filter screens, fuel pumps and quantity transmitter units. Instructions are given for remedying
difficulties which may arise in the normal operation of the fuel system. The instructions are organized so the
mechanic can refer to: Removal, Repair, Installation and Adjustment of each part of the system.
Maintenance for fuel injection may be found under Power Plant, Section VIII or VIIIA.
9-2. DESCRIPTION.
PA-28R-201 (Refer to Figure 9-1.)
The fuel system was designed with simplicity in mind. It incorporates two fuel tanks, one in each wing
containing 38.5 U.S. gallons, giving a total capacity of 77 gallons, of which 72 gallons are usable. The tanks
are attached to the leading edge of the wing with screws and are an integral part of the wing structure. This
allows for removal for service. An auxiliary electric fuel pump is provided in case of a failure of the engine
driven pump. A rocker type switch for controlling the electric pump is located on the switch panel above the
throttle quadrant. The electric pump should be on for take-off, switching tanks and during landing.
The fuel tank selector, which allows the pilot to control the flow of fuel to the engine, is located on the left
side wall below the instrument panel. It has three positions: OFF, LEFT TANK and RIGHT TANK. The arrow
on the handle of the selector points to the tank which is supplying fuel to the engine. The valve also
incorporates a safety latch which prevents inadvertently selecting the “OFF” position.
Each tank has an individual quick drain located at the bottom inboard rear corner. The fuel strainer also
incorporates a quick drain which is located in the left front comer of the firewall. The quick drain protrudes
from the cowling to allow easy draining of the fuel strainer. All three drains should be drained before every
flight and checked for contamination.
The fuel tanks are vented individually by a vent tube which protrudes below the bottom of the wing at the
rear outboard corner of each fuel tank. The vent should be checked periodically to ascertain that the vent is not
obstructed and allows free passage of air.
Fuel quantity and pressure are indicated on gauges located in the instrument cluster to the left of the switch
panel.
PA-28R-201T (Refer to Figure 9-2.)
The fuel system was designed with simplicity in mind. It incorporates two fuel tanks, one in each wing
containing 38.5 U.S. Gallons, giving a total capacity of 77 gallons, of which 72 gallons are usable. The
minimum fuel grade is 100/130 octane (green) or 100LL (blue). The tanks are attached to the leading edge of
the wing with screws and are an integral part of the wing structure. This allows for removal for service. The
tanks are vented individually by a vent tube which protrudes below the bottom of the wing at the rear inboard
corner of each tank. The vents should be checked periodically to ascertain that the vent is not obstructed and
will allow free passage of air.
Each fuel tank has as individual quick drain located at the bottom inboard rear corner. The fuel strainer
also incorporates a quick drain, which is located on the left lower portion of the firewall. The quick drain
protrudes thru the cowling to allow easy draining of the fuel strainer.
A fuel tank selector allows the pilot to control the flow of fuel to the engine, and is located on the left side
wall below the instrument panel. It has three positions: OFF, LEFT TANK and RIGHT TANK. The arrow on
the handle of the selector points to the tank which is supplying fuel to the engine. The vapor return from the
engine is also routed back to the tank selected. When the selector valve is in the OFF position, vapor return is
routed back to the right fuel tank. The valve also incorporates a safety latch which prevents inadvertently
selecting the “OFF” position.
The engine fuel injection system is a “continuous flow” type, which utilizes a vapor return line leading
back to the fuel tanks. This line provides a route back to the tanks for vapor laden fuel that has been separated
in the injector pump swirl chamber. The engine has an engine driven fuel pump that is a part of the fuel
injection system. As auxiliary fuel system is provided. The purpose of the electrically powered auxiliary fuel
system is to supply fuel to the engine in case of engine driven fuel pump shaft failure or malfunction, for
ground and inflight engine starting, and for vapor suppression. The auxiliary fuel pump switch is located on
the instrument panel above the engine control quadrant, and is a three position rocker switch; LO, HI and OFF.
The LO auxiliary fuel pressure is selected by pushing the top of the switch. The HI auxiliary fuel pressure is
selected by pushing the bottom of the switch, but this can be done only after unlatching the adjacent guard.
When the HI auxiliary fuel pump is activated, an amber light near the annunciation panel is illuminated. This
light dims whenever the pump pressure reduces automatically and manifold pressure is below approximately
21 inches.
In case of a failed engine-driven fuel pump, the auxiliary electric fuel pump should be set on HI. Adequate
pressure and fuel flow will be supplied for up to approximately 75% power. Manual leaning to the correct fuel
flow will be required at altitudes above 15,000 feet and for engine speeds less than 2300 RPM. An absolute
pressure switch automatically selects a lower fuel pressure when the throttle is reduced below 21” Hg manifold
pressure and the HI auxiliary fuel pump is on.
NOTE
Excessive fuel pressure and very rich fuel/air mixtures will occur if the HI
position is energized when the engine fuel injection system is functioning
normally.
Low auxiliary fuel pressure is available and may be used during normal engine operation both on the
ground and inflight for vapor suppression should it be necessary as evidenced by unstable engine operation or
fluctuating fuel flow indications during idle or at high altitudes.
A spring loaded OFF primer button switch, located on the instrument panel and is used to select HI
auxiliary fuel pump operation for priming, irrespective of other switch positions. The primer button may be
used for both hot or cold engine starts.
On airplanes equipped with an optional engine primer system (identified by Placard below primer button
shown in Figure 9-4). the primer switch location and actuation is the same as the basic airplane. However, this
system does provide a separate primer system as an integral part of the engine fuel system. An electrically
operated diverter valve is located in the metered fuel supply line between the air throttle valve and the
manifold valve. Other components are two primer nozzles, located in the intake manifold on each side of the
engine, the interconnecting fuel lines, and fine wire spark plugs. Actuation of the engine primer switch
operates the auxiliary electric fuel pump on HI and energizes the diverter valve which supplies fuel to each
primer nozzle. The diverter valve does not shut off all fuel flow to the manifold valve, therefore some quantity
of fuel is also supplied to each cylinder nozzle during priming. Operation of the auxiliary fuel pump on HI and
LO is unchanged.
9-3. TROUBLESHOOTING. Troubles peculiar to the fuel system are listed in Table IX-III along with their
probable causes and suggested remedies. When troubleshooting, check from the power supply to the items
affected. If no trouble is found by this method, the trouble probably exists inside individual pieces of
equipment; they may be removed from the airplane and an identical unit or units, tested and known to be good,
installed in their place.
PA-28R-201
S/N: 28R-7737002 to 28R-7737161 inclusive
PA-28R-201T Inboard Outboard
S/N: 28R-7703001 to 28R-7703380 inclusive
PA-28R-201
S/N: 28R-7737162 and up
PA-28R-201T Outboard Inboard
S/N: 28R-7703381 and up
Note:
Fuel quantity sender Piper P/N: 550 504 requires fiber washer insulators. Refer to Figure 9-3, View B-B.
d. Fill the fuel tank with fuel. During filling check for proper fuel quantity gauge readings. Check for any
leaks around the sender unit attachment surface by looking through the access opening on the lower
surface of the wing.
e. Upon completion of the leak check, install the lower access panel and secure with required attachment
screws.
9-11. FUEL QUANTITY TRANSMITTER/GAUGE CHECK. Fuel quantity transmitter units and gauges may
be checked, while installed in the airplane, by the following procedure:
NOTE
To externally check the float assembly, see Figure 9-3 and Table IX-II.
When using the following procedure, the electrical system should apply 14-
volts to the gauge.
a. Turn the fuel selector valve off.
b. Completely drain the fuel tank that relates to the gauge to be checked.
c. Level the airplane longitudinally and laterally.
d. Turn the master switch on and observe the fuel quantity gauge. It should read empty. Refer to Table
IX-II for tolerances that are permitted between the fuel gauge reading and the actual fuel in the tank.
e. Add fuel to the tank in the amount of five U.S. gallon increments until the tank is full and observe
gauge readings.
NOTE
It is permissible to adjust the float assembly to obtain specified tolerances.
This adjustment should be accomplished per instructions titled Check and
Adjustment of Fuel Quantity Transmitters.
9-20. REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF ELECTRIC FUEL PUMP. The electric rotary vane type fuel
pump is mounted in a bracket on the forward side of the firewall. To remove pump, proceed as follows:
a. Remove engine cowl to gain access to the pump.
b. Remove fuel lines from the pump and disconnect the electrical leads.
c. Remove straps holding pump in position.
d. Do not attempt to disassemble or repair the fuel pump. If fuel pump proves to defective, it should be
replaced.
e. Reinstall pump in reverse order of removal.
9-20a. AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP SYSTEM ADJUSTMENT. (INSTALLED)
a. Install a calibrated pressure gauge in the fuel line between the electric fuel pump and engine.
b. Remove the aft access panel in the baggage compartment. The slider resistor is located at station 165.5
attached to the plate containing the voltage and overvoltage relays.
Full F 2
32.5 30 2
22.5 20 2
12.5 10 1
2.5 Zero Plus 0 - Minus 1
0 Empty Empty Dot 1/2
CAUTION
Using a crow’s foot adapter other than a tubing type will result in
deformation or severe damage to the union nut and will probably cause a
leak which will require replacement of the union and tubing.
NOTE
If during the torque check a galled nut and union are suspected, back off
the nut and inspect the threads. If the union is serviceable, apply a thread
lube such as Slip Spray Lubricant (DuPont) or Ferrulube (Parker-
Hannifin) and torque the nut to the proper values as listed in step d. If the
union is unserviceable, it must be replaced per instructions given in
paragraph titled Replacement of Fittings following this paragraph.
When applying thread lubricant, ensure its application to the male connector threads only. Care should be
taken that no lubricant enters the throat of the connector seat or contacts the ferrule seat face.
e. After torquing each fitting, measure the distance between the face of the union nut and face of tubing
nut. Refer to Figure 9-8 for tolerance.
f. Any fitting found out of tolerance must be replaced in accordance with instructions given in paragraph
titled Replacement of Fittings.
g. After all unions have been checked for proper tightness and all repairs (if any) have been made, ensure
that the airplane is full of fuel and run the engine for three to five minutes on each tank. Ensure engine
operation in a safe manner and location.
h. After engine shut down, wiggle all unions. If any fittings are found leaking, repairs must be
accomplished in accordance with paragraph titled Replacement of Fittings.
i. When system is found leak free, replace the side panel, carpet, access plates and seat.
j. Make an appropriate logbook entry.
NOTE
Defueling of airplane may be required for union and/or tubing replacement.
a. If fittings show evidence of galling, or does not meet the dimensional requirements of Figure 9-8 or
continues to leak after being tightened, it must be repaired.
b. The recommended repair is to remove the leaking union and replace it using a standard AN fitting as
outlined in AC43.13-1A, paragraph 392. This will require cutting off the swaged ferrule and adding a
short length of tubing.
c. If a replacement tube and union purchased from Piper is being used, the ferrule is pre-swaged onto the
tube. Install the pre-fabricated tube as follows:
1. Apply a thread lube as recommended in step d of paragraph titled Inspection and Tightening of
Fuel Line Union Fittings to the threads of the union.
2. Carefully align the tube into the union and snug up the nut using a wrench.
3. Then using the wrench, tighten the nut one to two flats (1/6 to 1/3 of a turn).
d. If a repair is being made using a Parker-Hannifin unions and tubes without pre-swaged ferrules they
should be installed as follows:
1. Cut off the tubing at a convenient location back from the fitting.
2. De-burr the end of the tube and prepare a short length of tube to splice into the line.
3. Screw the nut and ferrule onto the union until solidly finger tight.
4. Insert the tubes into the unions, being careful to ensure proper straight alignment of the tubing and
union.
5. Using a tubing wrench, tighten the nut one and one-quarter (1-1/4) turns.
e. After corrective action has been completed, perform leak test as outlined in steps g and h of paragraph
titled Inspection and Tightening of Fuel Line Union Fittings.
NOTE
Refer to Table VIII-III for additional Fuel Troubleshooting on PA-28R-
201T airplanes.
SECTION X
INSTRUMENTS
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper aircraft, it is the user’s responsibility to
refer to the applicable vendor publications.
10-1. GENERAL. The instrumentation is designed to give a quick and actual indication of the attitude,
performance and condition of the airplane. Maintenance, other than described in these sections, shall be done
by the instrument manufacturer or an authorized repair station.
The two types of instruments have been classified in this section as non-electrical and electrical. The first
part of this section will pertain to maintenance and troubleshooting of all the instruments and their systems
which depend on non-electrical sources for their operation.
10-2. NON-ELECTRICAL INSTRUMENTS.
10-3. VACUUM SYSTEM DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION. The following information is provided to
familiarize field service personnel with a means to diagnose vacuum systems malfunctions on those
components which are serviced by removal or replacement, along with recommended service practices. This
system operates the gyro instruments and consists of an engine driven dry vacuum pump, a vacuum regulator
and filter, and necessary hoses and lines that connect these components. Serial numbers 2837001 and up of the
PA-28R-201 and serial numbers 2803001 and up of the PA-28R-201T have auxiliary electrically operated dry
vacuum pumps incorporated in the system that provides a back-up source to operate the gyro flight instruments
if the engine driven pump fails. A vacuum gauge is used to constantly monitor the system.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE PIPE DOPE or any anti-seize tape or compound. The
AIRBORNE fittings are cadmium plated and need no other anti-seize
materials. Any ingested anti-seize materials may cause premature system
service. If a thread lubricant is required, use a powdered moly sulfide or
graphite in dry form or in an evaporating vehicle; or employ a silicone
spray. Apply sparingly to external threads of fittings only.
10-4. VACUUM SYSTEM SERVICE TIPS. (Refer to Table 10-1 for Troubleshooting Tips.)
CAUTION
Failure to inspect vacuum system hoses, clamps, and other components
periodically for leaks and security, will result in unreliable gyro instrument
indications.
10-5. HOSES AND CLAMPS. (Refer to Table 10-1 for Troubleshooting Instructions.)
a. Hoses and clamps should be examined periodically and inspected carefully when engine maintenance
activities cause hose disconnections to be made at the pump(s), regulating valve, gyro instruments, or
vacuum gauge.
CAUTION
Slivers of rubber from the hoses can become detached and sucked into the
pump, causing damage and a shorter pump life.
b. Examine the ends of the hoses for rubber separation and slivers on the inside diameter. The slivers can
detach, enter the vacuum pump, filter, and cause premature pump service.
c. Replace any hoses, clamps, or fittings that are broken, damaged, or corroded.
CAUTION
Immediately plug holes with shipping plugs after removing any component,
opening any line, ore removing any gyro instrument, or warranty will be
voided due to contamination.
NOTE
Vacuum gauges are replaced when malfunctions occur. The failure of the
gauge does not impair safety of flight.
a. If the vacuum gauge malfunctions in a manner to cause an incorrect reading in normal cruise power
conditions, the gauge must be checked by comparing the reading with a gauge of known accuracy. If
the gauge is indicating correct and the system vacuum level is not in accordance with the specific
vacuum; then and only then should the regulator be adjusted.
b. Visually examine gauge performance as follows:
1. When the engine not operating and no vacuum is applied to the gauge, the pointer on the gauge
should rest against the internal stop in the 9 o’clock position. If the gauge pointer appears in any
other position, the gauge is faulty and requires replacement.
2. A slight overshoot during engine startup, not to exceed one half inch of mercury is normal and is
not cause to replace the gauge.
3. With the engine running at normal cruise power rpm, the indication on the gauge should read 4.8
to 5.2 inches of mercury.
4. At 1200 rpm, the vacuum gauge indication should read in excess of four inches of mercury.
10-7. GYRO FILTERS. (Refer to Table 10-1 for Troubleshooting Instructions.)
CAUTION
Service gyro filters per Piper recommended scheduled basis, but no later
than 100 hours, or sooner as conditions may require. Operations in dusty
conditions, or if heavy concentrations of smoking occur in the aircraft, are
conditions that warrant sooner inspection considerations.
NOTE
The vacuum system has a large central filter and a differential vacuum
gauge that monitors the filter condition while gaining vacuum indication.
CAUTION
The central filter combined with a differential vacuum gauge will give a
decline in panel gauge indication when filter is clogged and vacuum
declines below recommended adjustment settings. Filters should be replaced
when gauge indication declines below the recommended adjustment setting;
do not readjust the regulator because accurate adjustment can only be
obtained with clean system filters.
10-9. ENGINE DRIVEN VACUUM PUMP. (Refer to Table 10-1 for Troubleshooting Tips,) The engine driven
vacuum is a dry rotary vane positive displacement type, located on the rear accessory section of the engine. It
consists of an aluminum housing that contains a tempered sleeve in which an offset rotor is incorporated. The
assembly is driven by a series of engine driven gears mated to a coupling on the pump
CAUTION
Never install a pump that has been dropped or damaged.
a. Before installing any fittings on the pump, check for thread damage.
CAUTION
Do not secure the pump in the raw steel jaws of a vice for installation of
fittings. Caution must be taken to avoid pump damage by installing
protective sleeves to the vice and using only enough pressure to hold the
pump firmly. Do not apply vise pressure to the outside diameter or overall
length of the pump.
b. With the pump properly secured, insert fittings into the ports and hand tighten firmly; then using a
wrench, tighten each fitting from one-half to two additional turns.
CAUTION
The only pump mounting gasket authorized and approved for use on the
AIRBORNE vacuum pump is AIRBORNE gasket B3-1-2, Piper Part
Number 751 859. Any other gasket could result in oil seepage or leakage at
the mounting flange.
c. Place pump gasket in place and align spline on pump drive with spline on engine drive assembly.
d. Secure pump to engine with four plain washers, lockwashers, and retaining nuts.
e. Tighten the four nuts to a torque of 50 to 70 inch-pounds.
f. Snug one locknut on each of the four retaining nuts.
g. Remove all plugs and caps from the fittings and hoses and secure the hoses to the pump with clamps.
h. After a functional operation check, replace the top cowling.
10-12. AUXILIARY VACUUM PUMP (Serial Numbers 2837001 and up of PA-28R-201 and 2803001 and up
of PA-28R-201R models). (Refer to Table 10-1 for Troubleshooting Instructions.)
CAUTION
When replacement of the auxiliary pump is required, the complete pump
and motor must be replaced with a new operational unit. It is important that
repair is made by authorized maintenance personnel only for proper
operation.
a. The auxiliary vacuum pump is mounted on the right side of the firewall and serves as a backup to the
engine operated pump if it should fail to operate the gyro instruments. There is a 20 amp circuit
breaker in the system that protects the pump motor and a 5 amp circuit breaker that protects the
annunciator light switch.
b. Auxiliary Vacuum Pump Engine Off Operational Check.
CAUTION
Excessive running of the auxiliary pump will weaken the battery to an
unreliable charge level. Ensure that all electrical equipment is off before
beginning engine off operational check. Operate system as short a time as
possible.
1. Press battery master switch ON. Check the VAC OFF annunciator illuminates.
2. Press VAC OFF/AUX ON annunciator switch. Ensure that AUX ON annunciator illuminates and
VAC OFF annunciator goes out. Observe that the vacuum gauge indicates between 4.8 and 5.2 in.
Hg.
3. Press VAC OFF/AUX ON annunciator switch to cycle it to the OFF position. Ensure that AUX
ON annunciator goes out and VAC OFF annunciator illuminates.
4. Press the battery master switch to OFF.
c. Removal of Auxiliary Vacuum Pump.
WARNING
Verify that the battery master switch is in the OFF position.
CAUTION
The auxiliary vacuum pump and motor are one sealed assembly and must
be removed and replaced with another sealed assembly. The elapsed time
indicator is matched to the pump/motor assembly and must be removed and
replaced with the pump/motor assembly as one unit. Insulate and secure all
electrical leads that remain loose, if replacement is not installed
immediately.
1. Remove the top cowling.
2. Disconnect hoses from pump/motor assembly.
3. Disconnect electrical leads at terminals of the pump/motor assembly.
4. Insulate and secure disconnected electrical leads.
5. Loosen the band clamps and remove pump/motor from firewall brackets.
6. Locate the elapsed time indicator under the right instrument panel; disconnect the electrical leads.
7. Remove the elapsed time indicator.
8. Insulate and secure the electrical leads at the elapsed time indicator.
9. If a replacement auxiliary pump is not installed now, place protective plugs or caps over open ends
of vacuum hoses and secure them. Install the top cowling.
d. Installation of Auxiliary Vacuum Pump Assembly.
WARNING
Verify that the battery master switch is OFF.
CAUTION
Never install an auxiliary pump assembly that has been dropped or
damaged. The matched elapsed time indicator must be installed with the
matched pump/motor assembly.
1. Remove temporary insulators and connect elapsed time indicator to two-pin connector on the leads
coming from the back of the switch, at rear right side of instrument panel.
2. Secure elapsed time indicator to wire harness with a strap (zip strip). Ensure that elapsed time
indicator can be easily located and inspected.
WARNING
Do not attempt adjustment of this valve with engine in operation. This
procedure may be done with the engine running provided a qualified pilot
or maintenance person is at the controls, but is considered dangerous and
not recommended by Piper.
CAUTION
Before any adjustments are made to the vacuum regulator, verify that the
system filters and lines are clean.
a. Bend locking tabs up (if applicable) then loosen locking nut or remove protective cap from valve per
type installed.
b. Start the engine and allow for engine warm-up at a medium rpm setting.
c. With the engine running at medium rpm, the suction gauge should indicate 5.0 ± 0.2 inches of
m e r c u r y. If the indication is not within this range, shut down the engine and adjust regulator
(clockwise to increase pressure or counterclockwise to decrease pressure).
d. Again, start the engine and repeat this procedure until an indication of 5.0 ± 0.2 inches of mercury is
obtained at a medium power setting.
NOTE
If airplane is not equipped with a suction gauge, connect a temporary gauge
of known accuracy by removing the plug from back of the artificial horizon
and attaching it there.
e. After satisfied that pressure is adjusted correctly to 5.0 ± 0.2 inches of mercury, remove gauge and
install plug; replace protective cap and tighten locknut per type valve installed.
10-15. REMOVAL AND REPLACEMENT OF REGULATOR VALVE.
a. Disconnect the three lines and remove mounting nut. Remove valve from airplane.
b. Install regulator in reverse order of removal.
c. Verify that complete vacuum system is operational.
AUX ON annunciator will Restriction in hose lines. Inspect and repair hole lines.
not illuminate. Replace if necessary.
10-17. GENERAL. The suction gauge is mounted in the right side of the instrument panel to the left and up
from the cigar lighter. This gauge is calibrated in inches of mercury and has a direct pressure line and vent line.
Therefore, the gauge indicates the differential pressure or actual pressure being applied to the gyro instruments.
As the system filter becomes clogged or lines obstructed, the gauge will show a decrease in pressure. Do not
reset the regulator until the filter and lines have been checked.
10- 18. TROUBLESHOOTING. For troubleshooting of this instrument, refer to Table X-I of this section.
NOTE
For ease of pitot line installations in later models, changes of some lines
have been made, but in no way change the design or operation of the
system.
10-19. PITOT-STATIC SYSTEMS. (Refer to Figure 10-2.) Pitot pressure for the airspeed indicator is sensed
by the pitot mast mounted under the left wing. Static pressure for the altimeter, vertical speed and airspeed
indicators is sensed by two static pressure units, one located on each side of the rear part of the fuselage.
A drain is provided in the lower left front side panel to drain moisture from the pressure line running
between the pitot mast and the instrument panel.
When installed, an alternate static source control valve is located below the instrument panel to the right of
the power quadrant. If one or more of the pitot static instruments malfunctions these pressure systems should
be checked for leaks, dirt or water. If moisture is present, the static system can be drained by turning on the
alternate static system. The selector valve is located at the low point of the system.
At any time an instrument fitting, line, pitot head or static button is disconnected, tests must be performed
prior to the next flight. Refer to AC43.13- 1 A for the testing procedures.
TABLE XI-II. DIRECTIONAL GYRO INDICATOR
10-21. GENERAL. The directional gyro is a flight instrument incorporating an air driven gyro stabilized in the
vertical plane. The gyro is rotated at high speed by lowering the pressure in the air tight case and
simultaneously allowing atmospheric air pressure to enter the instrument against the gyro buckets. Due to
gyroscopic inertia, the spin axis continues to point in the same direction even though the aircraft yaws to the
right or left. This relative motion between the gyro and the instrument case is shown on the instrument dial
which is similar to a compass card. The dial, when set to agree with the airplane magnetic compass provides a
positive indication free from swing and turning error. However, the directional gyro has no sense of direction
and must be set to the magnetic compass, since the magnetic compass is subject to errors due to magnetic
fields, electric instruments, etc., the directional gyro is only accurate for the heading it has been set for. If the
gyro is set on 270°, for instance, and the aircraft is turned to some other heading, there can be a large error
between the gyro and the magnetic compass due to the error in compass compensation, the will appear as gyro
precession. The gyro should only be checked on the heading on which it was first set, also due to internal
friction, spin axis error, air turbulence and airflow, the gyro should be set at least every 15 minutes for accurate
operation, whether it has drifted or not.
10-22. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-II. GYRO HORIZON INDICATOR
Instrument does not Instrument not level Loosen screws and level
indicate level flight. in panel. instrument.
Aircraft out of trim. Trim aircraft.
10-23. REMOVAL AND REPLACEMENT. (Refer to Paragraphs 10-74 and 10-78 of this section.)
10-25. GENERAL. The gyro horizon is essentially an air driven gyroscope rotating in a horizontal plane and is
operated by the same principal as the directional gyro. Due to the gyroscopic inertia, the spin axis continues to
point in the vertical direction, providing a constant visual reference to the attitude of the airplane relative to
pitch and roll axis. A bar across the face of the indicator represents the horizon and aligning the miniature
airplane to the horizon bar simulates the alignment of the airplane to the actual horizon. Any deviation
simulates the deviation of the airplane from the true horizon. The gyro horizon is marked for different degrees
of bank.
10-26. TROUBLESHOOTING.
10-27. REMOVAL AND REPLACEMENT. (Refer to Paragraphs 10-74 and 10-78 of this section.)
10-29. GENERAL. The rate of climb indicator measures the rate of change in static pressure when the airplane
is climbing or descending. By means of a pointer and dial, this instrument will indicate the rate of ascent or
descent of the airplane in feet per minute. But due to the lag of the instrument, the aircraft will be climbing or
descending before the instrument starts to read and the instrument will continue to read after the aircraft has
assumed level flight. In rough air, this should not be considered a malfunction.
10-30. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-IV. RATE OF CLIMB INDICATOR
NOTE
When any connections in the static system are opened for checking, system
must be rechecked per Part 23.1325.
10-33. GENERAL. The altimeter indicates pressure altitude in feet above sea level. The indicator has three
pointers and dial scale, the long pointer is read in hundreds of feet. the middle pointer in thousands of feet and
the short pointer in ten thousands of feet. A barometric pressure window is located on the right side of the
indicator dial and is set by the knob located on the lower left comer of the instrument. The altimeter consists of
a sealed diaphragm that is connected to the pointers through a mechanical linkage. The instrument case is
vented to the static air system and as static air pressure decreases, the diaphragm expands, causing the pointers
to move through the mechanical linkage.
10-34. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-V. ALTIMETER
10-37. GENERAL. The airspeed indicator provides a means of indicating the speed of the airplane passing
through the air. The airspeed indication is the differential pressure reading between pitot air to pressure and
static air pressure. This instrument has the diaphragm vented to the pitot air source and the case is vented to the
static air system. As the airplane increases speed, the pitot air pressure increases, causing the diaphragm to
expand. A mechanical linkage picks up this motion and moves the instrument pointer to the indicated speed.
The instrument dial is calibrated in knots and miles per hour and also has the necessary operating range
markings for safe operation of the airplane.
10-38. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-VI. AIRSPEED TUBES AND INDICATOR
Pointers of static Leak in instrument case Check for leak and seal.
instruments do not or in pitot lines.
indicate properly.
Pointer of instrument Defective mechanism. Replace instrument.
oscillates.
NOTE
When any connections in static system are opened for checking, system
must be checked per Part 23.1325.
10-41. GENERAL. The magnetic compass is a self-contained instrument. This instrument has an individual
light which is connected to the instrument lighting circuit. The compass correction card is located in the card
holder mounted on the instrument. The compass should be swung whenever instruments or radios are changed
and at least once a year.
10-41a. ADJUSTMENT OF COMPASS. Before attempting to compensate compass, every effort should be
made to place the aircraft in simulated flight conditions; check to see that the doors are closed, flaps in
retracted position, engine running, throttle set at cruise position and aircraft in level flight attitude. Aircraft
master switch, alternator switch and all radio switches should be in the ON position. All other cockpit
controlled electrical switches should be in the OFF position.
a. Set adjustment screws of compensator on zero. Zero position of adjusting screws is when the dot of the
screw is lined up with the dot of the frame.
b. Head aircraft on a magnetic North heading. Adjust N-S adjustment screw until compass reads exactly
North.
c. Head aircraft on a magnetic East heading and do the same as step b, adjusting E-W adjusting screw.
d. Head aircraft on a magnetic South heading and note resulting South error. Adjust N-S adjusting screw
until one-half of this error has been removed.
e. Head aircraft on magnetic West and do same as step d, adjusting E-W adjusting screw.
f. Head aircraft in successive magnetic 30° headings and record compass readings on appropriate
deviation card. Deviations must not exceed ± 10° on any heading.
10-42. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-VII. MAGNETIC COMPASS
10-44. GENERAL. The manifold pressure gauge is a vapor proof, absolute pressure type instrument. Pressure
from the intake manifold of the engine is transmitted to the instrument through a line. A pointer indicates the
manifold pressure available at the engine in inches of mercury.
10-45. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-VIII. MANIFOLD PRESSURE INDICATOR
10-48. GENERAL. The tachometer is connected to the engine accessory by a flexible cable and provides an
indication of crankshaft speed in revolutions per minute. The instrument has a recording mechanism for
recording the time that the engine is in actual operation.
10-49. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-IX. TACHOMETER
10-52. GENERAL. The oil pressure gauge is mounted in the cluster on the instrument panel. This gauge will
indicate the amount available at the pressurized engine oil passage.
10-56. GENERAL. The fuel pressure gauge instrument is mounted in the cluster on the instrument panel. This
gauge is connected to the fuel system at the carburetor fuel inlet fitting.
10-57. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-XI. FUEL PRESSURE GAUGE
10-61. GENERAL. The turn and bank indicator is an electrical instrument. The turn portion of the indicator is
driven by a permanent magnet DC governor controlled gyro motor. Damping action is provided by a precision
air dashpot. The indicator is designed to indicate the rate of turn and roll; which means, if the aircraft is rolled
right and left rapidly, the indicator will move, indicating a turn, but if the aircraft is held in a bank, by applying
rudder, the indicator will come back to zero indicating no turn. The bank portion of the indicator is a ball
sealed in a curved glass tube filled with damping fluid. In an improperly coordinated turn, the ball is forced
from the center of the tube, thus indicating attitude error.
10-62. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-XII. TURN AND BANK INDICATOR
10-65. GENERAL. The two quantity gauges are mounted in the cluster on the instrument panel. These
instruments are calibrated in divisions of 10, 20, 30 gallons and full. Two transmitter units are installed in each
fuel cell. These units contain a resistance strip and a movable control arm. The position of this arm is
controlled by a float in the fuel cell and this position is transmitted electrically to the indicator gauge to show
the amount of fuel in the cell.
10-66. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-XIII. FUEL QUANTITY INDICATORS
10-69. GENERAL. The oil temperature indicator is mounted in the instrument cluster on the instrument panel.
This instrument will provide a temperature indication of the engine oil in degrees Fahrenheit. The instrument
has a temperature bulb located in the oil screen assembly on engines with screens, and on the top of the oil
cooler mounting flange on engines with an oil filter, located on the engine accessory section.
10-70. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-XIV. OIL TEMPERATURE INDICATORS
Instrument fails to show Broken or damaged bulb. Check engine unit and
any reading. Wiring open. wiring to instrument.
Excessive scale error. Improper calibration Repair or replace.
adjustment.
Pointer fails to move as Broken or damaged bulb Check engine unit and
engine is warmed up. or open wiring. wiring.
Dull or discolored Age. Replace instrument.
marking.
10-72. AMMETER.
10-73. GENERAL. The ammeter is mounted in the instrument panel. This instrument measures the output of
the alternator into the entire electrical system including the battery charging demand.
10-77. GENERAL. Since all instruments are mounted in a similar manner, a description of a typical removal
and installation is provided as a guide for the removal and installation of the instruments. Special care should
be taken when any operation pertaining to the instruments is performed.
a. Remove the face panel by removing the screws from around the perimeter of the panel.
b. With the face panel removed, the mounting screws for the individual instruments will be exposed.
Remove the connections to the instrument prior to removing the mounting screws of the instrument to
be removed.
NOTE
Tag instrument connections for ease of installation.
c. Installation of the instruments will be in the reverse given for removal. After the installation is
completed and before replacing the instrument face panel, check all components for security and
clearance of the control column.
10-79. GENERAL. A cluster, located on the instrument panel, contains five individual instruments. Removal
of these instruments can be accomplished by the following procedure:
a. Remove the face panel by pulling from retaining channels at top and bottom.
b. With the face panel removed, the clear plastic cover on the cluster assembly will be exposed. Remove
the cover and cluster by removing the two mounting screws.
c. Remove the connection to the individual instrument to be removed and remove the instrument from
the cluster assembly.
d. Replace instrument in the reverse order of removal. Check all mountings and connections for security.
10-80. GYRO FITTING INSTALLATION PROCEDURE. The following procedure applies to those aircraft
having the Edo-Aire air driven gyro installation. The use of teflon tape on fitting threads is recommended.
CAUTION
Permit no oil, grease, pipe compound or any foreign material to enter ports
prior to installation of fittings. Make certain all air lines are clean and free
of foreign particles and/or residue before connecting lines to gyro.
NOTE
Use of thread lube on fittings or in ports will create a warranty void
condition.
a. Carefully lay teflon tape on the threads allowing one thread to be visible from the end of the fitting.
Hold in place and wrap in the direction of the threads so tape will remain tight when fitting is installed.
b. Apply sufficient tension while winding to assure that tape forms into thread grooves. One full wrap
plus 1/2 inch overlap is sufficient.
c. After wrap is completed, maintain tension and tear tape by pulling in direction of wrap. The resulting
ragged end is the key to the tape staying in place.
d. Press the tape well into the threads.
e. Screw fitting into port being careful not to exceed torque requirements as noted on decal on gyro
cover.
10-81. CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE GAUGE.
10-82. GENERAL. The cylinder head temperature gauge is in the instrument cluster, located on the instrument
panel. This instrument measures the cylinder head temperature using a sender located in a cylinder head. The
head location is determined by the manufacturer. It is an electrical instrument and is wired thru the instruments
circuit breaker.
10-83. TROUBLESHOOTING.
TABLE X-XV. CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE GAUGE
10-87. GENERAL. The annunciator panel for both the PA-28R-201 and the PA-28R-201T consists of three
amber lights and a push-button test switch located on the upper left center portion of the instrument panel. Two
additional amber lights come with the PA-28R-201T model. (Refer to Figure 10-1.) The panel monitors
alternator output, oil pressure and the vacuum system. The ALT warning light will illuminate when alternator
output is zero; the VAC light when the pressure difference is below 3.5 in. Hg; OIL light when the oil pressure
is below 35 psi on PA-28R-201 or 30 psi on PA-28R-201T and the over BST light (PA-28R-201T only) when
the engine manifold pressure exceeds 40.75 + .15 in. Hg. A smaller light (PA-28R-201T only) indicates when
the auxiliary fuel pump is on. A test Button is included to check the operation of all the lights except for the
auxiliary fuel pump light. Refer to Section XI for service information.
Revised: 2/13/89
2G15
Aerofiche
Paragraph Grid No.
SECTION XI
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper aircraft, it
is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
11-1. Introduction. This section contains instructions and schematics for correcting difficulties which may arise
in the operation of the electrical system in PA-28R-201 and PA-28R-201T airplanes.
The instructions are organized so the mechanic can refer to: Description and Principles of Operation for a
basic understanding of the various electrical system; Troubleshooting for a methodical approach in locating the
difficulty; Corrective Maintenance of removal, repair and installation of components; and adjustments and
tests for operation of the repaired system. Schematics for the individual systems are located at the end of this
section. For information concerning electronic equipment, refer to Section XII, Electronics.
11-2. DESCRIPTION. Electrical power is supplied by a 14 volt, direct current, negative ground electrical
system. A 12 volt battery is incorporated into the system to furnish power for starting and as a reserve power
source in case of alternator failure. Access to the battery is through the aft side of the baggage compartment.
The electrical generating system consists of an engine driven 60 amp alternator for the PA-28R-201 or a 65
amp alternator for the PA-28R-201T. A solid state voltage regulator maintains the system bus voltage at 14
volts. Also incorporated is an overvoltage relay, which prevents damage to electrical and avionics equipment
in case of a regulator malfunction. The loads from the electrical bus systems are protected by manual reset type
circuit breakers mounted on the lower right hand side of the instrument panel.
The master switch must be ON before any electrical equipment will operate. The master switch controls
the battery relay and field circuit. This switch is a double pole single throw type.
The lighting system for night time operation is optional equipment and consists of a landing light,
anticollision lights and navigation lights.
11-3. TROUBLESHOOTING. Troubles peculiar to the electrical system are listed in Table XI-V at the back of
this section along with their probable causes and suggested remedies. The wiring diagrams included at the end
of this section will give physical breakdown of the different electrical circuits used in these airplanes.
After the trouble has been corrected, check the entire system for security and operation of its components.
WARNING
All checks and adjustments of the alternator and/or its components should
be made with the engine stopped. Therefore, to complete some checks or
adjustments, it will be necessary to remove these units from the airplane and
place on a test stand.
11-4. ALTERNATOR SYSTEM. The PA-28R-201 alternator is located on the front lower right side of the
engine and utilizes a belt drive from the engine crankshaft. The PA-28R-201T alternator is mounted on the
accessory case at the rear of the engine. Many advantages, both in operation and maintenance, are derived
from this system. The main advantage is that full electrical power output is available regardless of engine rpm.
The alternator has no armature or commutator and only a small pair of carbon brushes, which make
contact with a pair of copper slip rings. The rotating member of the alternator, known as the rotor, is actually
the field windings. The rotor draws only 1/20th of the current output. Therefore, there is very little friction and
negligible wear and heat in this area. The alternating current is converted to direct current by diodes pressed
into the end bell housing of the alternator. The diodes are highly reliable solid state devices, but are easily
damaged if current flow is reversed through them.
The alternator system does not require a reverse current relay, because of the high back resistance of the
diodes and the inability of the alternator to draw current or motorize. A current regulator is unnecessary
because the windings have been designed to limit the maximum current available. Therefore, the voltage
regulator is the only control needed.
An additional latching circuit is used to help keep the master solenoid closed when the battery voltage is
low and the engine starter is being operated. This circuit transfers voltage from the alternator to the master
solenoid coil, thus holding the master solenoid in the closed position and allowing the starter to function. This
circuit will also supply some voltage to the battery. A diode is placed into this circuit to prevent the reverse
flow of current from the battery to the alternator.
The circuit breaker panel contains a 5-ampere circuit breaker marked ALT FIELD. If the field circuit
breaker trips it will result in a complete shutdown of power from the generating system. After a one or two
minute cool-down period, the breaker can be reset manually. If tripping recurs and holding the breaker down
will not prevent continual tripping, then a short exists in the alternator field.
Unlike previous systems, the ammeter does not indicate battery discharge, but displays the load in amperes
placed on the generating system. With all electrical equipment off, except the master switch, the ammeter will
indicate the amount of charging current demanded by the battery. This amount will vary, depending on the
percentage of charge in the battery at the time. As the battery becomes charged, the amount of current
displayed on the ammeter will reduce to approximately two amperes. The amount of current shown on the
ammeter will tell immediately whether or not the alternator system is operating normally, if the following
principles are kept in mind.
NOTE
The amount of current shown on the ammeter is the load in amperes that is
demanded by the electrical system from the alternator. As a check, take for
example a condition where the battery is demanding 10-amperes charging
current, then switch on the landing light. Note the value in amperes
placarded on the panel for the landing light fuse (10 amps) and multiply
this by 80 percent, you will arrive at a current of 8-amperes. This is the
approximate current drawn by the light. Therefore, when the light is
switched on, there will be an increase of current from 10 to 18-amperes
displayed on the ammeter. As each unit of electrical equipment is switch on,
the currents will add up and the total, including the battery, will appear on
the ammeter.
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper aircraft, it
is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
11-8. FIELD CURRENT DRAW. Connect a test ammeter in series between a 12-volt battery positive post and
the alternator field terminal. (Refer to Figure 11-3.) Connect a jumper wire to a machined surface on one of the
alternator end shields (ground) and to the negative battery post. The reason for connecting to the machined
surface is to ensure a good electrical connection. The end shields are treated to oppose corrosion. The material
used to treat the end shields is not a good electrical conductor.
Observe the ammeter to determine the current flowing through the rotor coil and connected circuit and
record the amount. Slowly rotate the rotor with the pulley while watching the meter. The current will be a little
less while rotating the rotor than when stationary. However, if the slip rings are clean and the brushes are
making good contact, the reading should be fairly even. A slight fluctuation will be normal due to variation in
turning speed when operated by hand.
The current draw should not be less than 2.3-amperes nor more than 2.7-amperes. A reading of less than
2.3-amperes indicated high resistance due to poorly soldered coil leads at the slip rings, dirty, oily slip rings or
poor brush contact. A reading higher than 2.7-amperes indicates shorted coil windings.
Figure 11-3. Checking Field Circuit Figure 11-4. Testing Field Circuit
11-9. TESTING ALTERNATOR INTERNAL FIELD CIRCUIT FOR A GROUND. To test the alternator
internal field circuit for a short circuit foreground, proceed as follows:
a. Remove the ground brush and using a 110-volt test lamp, place one test probe to the field terminal and
the remaining test probe to a machined surface at one of the alternator end shields. (Refer to Figure 11-4.)
The test land should not light.
If the test lamp lights, carefully observe the order in which the parts were installed as you remove the
insulated brush assembly. Remove the three through bolts. Then, separate the two end shield assemblies.
Touch one of the test lamp probes to one of the slip rings and the remaining test probe to the rotor shaft. The
lamp should not light. If the lamp lights, the rotor assembly is grounded and requires replacement.
If the test lamp does not light, the ground condition was in the insulated brush assembly and the parts were
either assembled wrong or damaged and short circuiting through to ground. Inspect the brush holder and
insulated washer. Replace if damaged. The stack of parts attaching the insulated brush holder assembly to the
end shield must always be installed in the proper sequence as follows: Insulated brush holder, “FLD” terminal,
insulating washer, lockwasher and attaching screw.
11-10. INSPECTION. Inspect the condition of the alternator components paying special attention to the
condition of the slip rings for indications of oil, being burnt or worn. Inspect brushes for signs of sticking in
holder or shield and for wear.
Inspect the bearing surface of the rotor shaft and the roller bearings at the rectifier end. Rotate the rotor in
the drive end shield to feel roughness in the drive end bearing. Inspect the grease retainer. Inspect the rectifier
leads especially at connections for a good solder joint, also inspect insulation. Rectifier/stator lead must be
pushed down into the slots that are cast into the end shield and cemented with MoPar Cement #2299314.
11-11. TESTING RECTIFIERS (POSITIVE). (Refer to Figure 11-5.) Special test box tool C-3829 has been
developed to test the diode rectifiers without opening the “Y” connection as is necessary where the test lamp
method is used.
Due to the short leads at the “Y” connection, it is quite difficult to separate and reconnect them properly.
This tool, C-3829, will save much time and is accurate.
Insulate alternator from metal bench and plug tester tool C-3829 into a 110-volt supply. Connect the
alligator clip of tool C-3829 to the alternator “BAT” terminal and touch the bare metal of each of the positive
case rectifier lead wires in the heat sink at the rectifiers.
The meter reading for each of the rectifiers should be the same. Always contact the connection nearest the
rectifiers.
Do not break the sealing on the rectifier lead wire or on the top of the rectifiers. The sealing material is
used for corrosion protection.
The reading on the meter will indicate 1.7 or over for good rectifiers. Where two of the rectifiers are good
and one is shorted, the reading taken at the good rectifiers will show low. The reading at the shorted rectifier
will be zero. Cut the lead at the bad rectifier and the reading at the two good rectifiers will come up to normal.
Where one of the rectifiers is open, it will read low (1 amp or less) the two good rectifiers will show normal.
11-12. TESTING RECTIFIERS (NEGATIVE). To test the negative case rectifiers in the end shield, connect
the alligator clip of tool C-3829 to the end shield.
Touch the test prod to the bare wire of the rectifier leads at the rectifiers in the end shield. The meter will
indicate the condition of the rectifier.
The test indications are the same for the negative case rectifiers in the end shield as they are for the
positive case rectifiers in the heat sink. However, the meter will read at the opposite end of the scale.
NOTE
If all three of the negative rectifiers read low, before condemning the
rectifiers, test for a grounded stator. A grounded stator will cause the
negative rectifiers (in the end shield) to read low.
Figure 11-7. C-3928 Fixture and Adapters Figure 11-8. Removing Rectifiers
NOTE
A common cause of an open or a shorted rectifier is a defective capacitor or
a battery that has been installed in reverse polarity. If the battery is installed
properly and the rectifiers are open, test the capacitor with a condenser
tester.
11-13. REMOVING AND INSTALLING RECTIFIERS. The use of proper tools for the removal and
installation of rectifiers cannot be over emphasized. A special tool kit has been developed to remove and
replace new rectifiers without damage.
NOTE
Only new rectifiers should be installed. It is not recommended to reinstall
rectifiers once they have been removed.
The tool kit can be used on all Chrysler built alternators. A press is not required when using the C-3928
tool kit for removing or installing rectifiers. Three diode rectifiers are pressed into the heat sink and three in
the end shields.
The new tool consists of a clamp type fixture with special adapters. This tool makes it unnecessary to use a
press.
The tool assembly consists of the following components:
11-14. REMOVING RECTIFIERS. After cutting the lead from the malfunctioning rectifier, position the
fixture with the rectifier to be removed over the fixture anvil.
Position the removing adapter SP-3821 around the rectifier. Rotate the threaded screw clockwise. As the
screw approaches the removing adapter, guide its shank into the hole in the end of the screw.
Just before the downward motion of the screw bottoms, recheck the adapter to be sure it is in the proper
position. Then continue to rotate the screw until the rectifier is free of the end shield or heat sink.
Reverse the screw by rotating it counterclockwise. Remove adapter and old rectifier.
Remove the end shield assembly from the fixture and position SP-3820 installing support on the fixture
anvil.
11-15. INSTALLING RECTIFIERS. Start the new rectifier as squarely as possible into the hole the old
rectifier was removed from after first checking to be sure it is of the proper polarity. The negative rectifiers are
marked with black numerals and the positive with red.
Reposition the end shield in the fixture, locating the hole over the installing support.
With the installing adapter SP-3818 positioned on the rectifier, rotate the screw clockwise.
Guide the shank of the adapter into the screw. Continue to move the screw downward until just before
bottoming.
CAUTION
Check carefully to be certain that the adapter is positioned properly over the
rectifier and the rectifier is started squarely in the hole.
Rotate the screw clockwise pressing the rectifier in place until it bottoms. When the rectifier bottoms, it
can easily be felt. Remove the end shield assembly from the fixture and inspect to see that rectifier is installed
properly.
NOTE
After soldering, to quickly cool the soldered connection, touch a dampened
cloth against it. This will aid in forming a solid joint.
With the rectifier properly installed, test to ensure that the rectifier has not been damaged while installing.
If the lead wires have been pulled away from the end shield, recement them.
11-16. TESTING STATOR COILS FOR GROUND. The stator coils are insulated form the core. A break in
the installation, allowing the bare wire to touch the core, will ground the coil and result in no output.
To test the stator for a ground (end shields separated), lift the stator away from the end shield and place
wooden blocks approximately .50 inch thick between the stator and the shield to keep them separated.
Using a 110-volt test lamp, place one test probe on the core and the other test probe to one of the rectifier
leads, making certain to have good electrical connections at both test probes. The lamp should not light. If the
lamp lights, it is an indication that the coil windings are grounded to the core and a replacement of the stator is
required.
11-17. TESTING ALTERNATOR CAPACITORS. Capacitors are used in connection with alternators to
suppress any transient peak voltage that may occur. It is essential, therefore to test the capacitor when servicing
the alternator.
This is especially true where diode rectifiers test open or short circuited.
The capacitor is connected to the inner end of the alternator “BAT” terminal screw and to the inner surface
of the rectifier end shield (Ground).
Connect the capacitor tester to the alternator “BAT” terminal screw and the disconnected ground lead.
CAUTION
Do not allow the tester probes or clips to touch the end shield or the rectifier
leads while the test is in progress or damage to the rectifiers may occur.
The specified capacity for the alternators (capacitor part of terminal screw) is .5 ± .1 MFD (min.). Replace
capacitors with low capacity, shorted or with high series resistance.
Figure 11-12. Removing End Bearing Figure 11-13. Installing End Bearing
11-18. REMOVING NEEDLE BEARING FROM END SHIELD. (Refer to Figure 11-12.) If inspection
indicates that the needle bearing is faulty, it may be replaced.
The bearing is a press fit in the end shield. To protect the end shield, it is necessary to support it with tool
C-3925 while pressing the bearing out with tool C-3770-A.
NOTE
Tool C-3925 is a double end tool. One end will only fit into the counterbore
on alternators provided with the grease retainer. The opposite end is used as
a support for end shields without the grease retainer counterbore.
11-19. INSTALLING NEEDLE BEARING IN END SHIELD. (Refer to Figure 11-13.) Support the end shield
on the C-3925 tool and press the bearing into the end shield with tool SP-3381. Tool SP-3381 has a concaved
end that is shaped to fit over the end of the bearing case. It is essential to use this tool to prevent damage to the
bearing.
The face of the tool has been relieved to prevent pressure being applied on the center of the bearing. The
use of a flat object to press in the bearing can cause the bearing to become distorted and result in a noisy
bearing. Tool SP-3381 will also position the bearing properly. When the tool contacts the end shield the
bearing is in the end shield, the proper distance.
NOTE
New bearings are prelubricated, additional lubrication is not required and
should not be used.
Figure 11-14. Removing Drive Pulley Figure 11-15. Removing Drive End Bearing
11-20. REMOVING DRIVE PULLEY. The drive pulley is an interference fit on the rotor shaft. The pulley is
removed with puller C-4068. The use of this puller set to remove the pulley will prevent damage to the pulley.
11-21. REMOVING DRIVE END BEARING. The drive end bearing is an interference fit on the rotor shaft. It
is also retained in the end shield by a retainer. The retainer is of spring steel construction and three integral
fingers snap over a shoulder on the end shield.
Remove the drive end shield from the bearing by removing either the three retaining nuts from the retainer
studs or by unsnapping the spring retainer fingers with a screwdriver. The end shield may then be removed by
tapping on the end of the rotor shaft with a soft hammer while holding the end shield.
Remove the drive end bearing from the rotor shaft with puller C-4068 and special adapters as follows:
a. Position the center screw of tool C-4068 on the rotor shaft.
b. Place the thin lower end of the adapters SP-3375 under the bearing equally spaced and the upper end
of the adapters around the center screw.
c. Hold adapters and center screw in position with the tool sleeve.
CAUTION
Tool sleeve must bottom on bearing, otherwise adapters may be damaged.
d. Turning the center screw while holding the outer body of the tool will withdraw the bearing from the
shaft.
11-22. REPLACING SLIP RINGS. Slip rings that are damaged may be replaced. Rotor shafts are knurled and
the slip rings are pressed on the knurled surface of the shaft. The rotor shaft has a grease retainer and an
insulator. The retainer is pressed on over the insulator ahead of the slip rings.
Figure 11-16. Removing Slip Ring Figure 11-17. Installing Slip Ring
11-25. INSTALLING GREASE RETAINER. (Refer to Figure 11-19.) If the solder connection where the rotor
field coil lead is soldered to the insulated brush ring lug has a sharp point or if the blob solder is excessive,
smooth with a scraper or file before installing the grease retainer insulator. If smooth, place fibre insulator on
shaft and press the retainer (cupped side to end of shaft) on the shaft with tool C-3921 in an arbor press.
11-26. INSTALLING DRIVE END BEARING. (Refer to Figure 11-20.) Insert the sealed drive end bearing in
the drive end shield and install the bearing retainer. Install the washers and nuts to hold the bearing in place on
all early production. Snap the spring steel retainer fingers in place on all later production models.
If the rotor and its components require no service, position the bearing and the drive end shield assembly
on the rotor shaft and while supporting the parts on the end of the rotor shaft, press the bearing and end shield
assembly in position on the rotor shaft using an arbor press and tool C-3858.
CAUTION
Make sure that the bearing is installed squarely at the start; otherwise,
damage to the bearing will result. Press the bearing on the rotor shaft until
the bearing contacts the shoulder on the rotor shaft.
Figure 11-20. Installing Drive End Shield and Figure 11-21. Installing Pulley
Bearing (Typical)
11-27. INSTALLING PULLEY. (Refer to Figure 11-21.) Install pulley on the rotor shaft using an arbor press
before the rectifier end shield is assembled to the drive end shield.
WARNING
Do not press pulley on with a vise. Use a press.
The shaft must be the support while the pulley is pressed on with the pressure being applied to the pulley
hub.
NOTE
Do not exceed 6800 pounds pressure. Press the pulley on the rotor shaft
until the pulley contacts the inner face of the drive end bearing.
11-28. ASSEMBLING END SHIELD SUB-ASSEMBLIES. Position the rotor and drive end shield assembly
on the rectifier end shield. Align the through bolt holes through the drive end shield, stator and the rectifier end
shield.
Compress stator and both end shields by hand and install the through bolts.
Install the insulated brush and holder, terminal, insulating washer, lockwasher and terminal attaching
screw. Install the ground brush and attaching screw.
Rotate the pulley slowly by hand to be sure that the rotor fans do not hit the rectifiers and stator
connectors.
After installing the alternator on the engine, always test the complete charging system to be certain it is
functioning properly.
NOTE
New through bolt locking tabs should be installed at each alternator
disassembly. Torque through bolts evenly to 25 inch pounds and bend both
ears of the locking tabs against bolt head. Check proper belt tension.
11-29. BENCH RUN-UP TEST. This test it to be performed at room ambient conditions and consists of four
checks which are to be made quickly to avoid heating of the windings. These are as follows:
NOTE
For test c and d, external field excitation may be used but must be removed
and self excitation used to obtain output amperes. (Refer to Figure 11-22 for
meter connections.)
a. With the alternator at rest, supply 15-volts between the alternator battery terminal and ground with
polarity such that the rectifiers will block current flow (positive of supply to positive of the alternator).
Monitor rectifier reverse current which shall be not more than 1 milliampere.
b. With the alternator at rest, apply 15-volts to the field circuit and monitor field current. This shall be
between the limits of 3.3-amperes minimum and 3.6-amperes maximum.
c. Drive the alternator at 1500 rpm with an electrical load connected to the alternator. Adjust the load to
obtain 15-volts. Net output (not including field current) shall be not less than 26.5-amperes.
d. Drive the alternator at 2500 rpm with an electrical load connected to the alternator. Adjust the load to
obtain 15-volts. Net output (not including field current) shall be not less than 49.0-amperes.
11-30. BENCH HOT STABILIZATION OUTPUT TEST. To determine the hot stabilized output, the alternator
must be driven with a suitable driving mechanism. During this test, the following shall be monitored: (Refer to
Figure 11-22 for meter connections.)
a. Alternator output voltage.
b. Alternator output current.
c. Field current.
d. Alternator rpm.
Drive the alternator at sufficient rpm to obtain 14-volts at the alternator battery terminal. Alternator shall
be self excited, otherwise no external load shall be applied. An external DC power source may be used to
polarize the field but must be removed as soon as the alternator is self sustaining. Maintain 14-volts at no load
by adjusting rpm for a period of 15 minutes, at which time record the above specified data.
Apply an electrical load to the alternator and increase speed so as to obtain 5-amperes output (not
including field excitation) at 14-volts. Maintain this condition for 15 minutes by adjusting the rpm. At the end
of this period, record the above specified data.
Maintain output voltage at 14-volts and vary the load in 5-ampere intervals. At each 5-amp intervals, allow
a 15 minute stabilization period maintaining output by varying rpm. Record the required data at each interval.
Continue this procedure through the maximum output (approximately 10,000 rpm).
Torque indicated at
Width of Belt Condition alternator pulley
NOTE
The higher tension specified for a new belt is to compensate for the initial
stretch that takes place as soon as it is operated. These higher tension values
should not be applied to belts which have previously been used.
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper aircraft, it
is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
a. Bearings: These units have a sealed ball bearing at the drive end and a two-piece roller bearing at the
slip ring end. The inner race is pressed onto the rotor shaft and the rest of the bearing is in the slip ring
end head. When the unit is assembled, the inner race aligns with the bearing. When the bearing is
replaced, the new inner race must be installed on the rotor shaft.
b. Lubrication: The slip ring end bearing should be lubricated whenever the alternator is disassembled.
The bearing should be thoroughly cleaned and repacked with Shell Alvania No. 2 or an equivalent
bearing lubricant. The cavity behind the bearing should be packed one-third to one-half full with the
same lubricant.
c. Brushes: These units have a separate brush holder assembly that is installed after the alternator has
been assembled. The brush holder has a small hole that intersects the brush cavities. Use a pin or a
piece of wire, as shown in Figure 11-35, to hold the brushes in the holder during assembly. Remove
the pin after the brush holder retaining screws have been tightened. Make a continuity check to be sure
the brushes are seated against the slip rings.
d. Drive Pulley: On PA-28R-201, torque the drive pulley retaining nut to 35 foot-pounds.
11-34. ALTERNATOR SERVICE PRECAUTIONS. Since the alternator and regulator are designed for use on
only one polarity system, the following precautions must be observed when testing or servicing the electrical
system. Failure to observe these precautions will result in serious damage to the electrical equipment.
a. Disconnect the battery before connecting or disconnecting test instruments (except voltmeter) or
before removing or replacing any unit or wiring. Accidental grounding or shorting at the regulator,
alternator, ammeter or accessories, will cause severe damage to the units and/or wiring.
b. The alternator must not be operated on open circuit with the rotor winding energized.
c. Do not attempt to polarize the alternator. No polarization is required. Any attempt to do so may result
in damage to the alternator, regulator or circuits.
d. Grounding of the alternator output terminal may damage the alternator and/or circuit and components.
e. Reversed battery connections may damage the rectifiers, wiring or other components of the charging
system. Battery polarity should be checked with a voltmeter before connecting the battery. Most
aircraft are negative ground.
f. If a booster battery or fast charger is used, its polarity must be connected correctly to prevent damage
to the electrical system components.
g. When using an auxiliary power unit, make sure the voltage and polarity are set to correspond with the
aircraft system voltage and polarity.
Figure 11-24. Removal of Slip Ring End Figure 11-25. Removal of Rectifier
Bearing
11-36. OVERHAUL OF ALTERNATOR. When repairing the alternator, complete disassembly may not be
required. In some cases, it will only be necessary to perform those operations which are required to effect the
repair. However, in this section, the complete overhaul is covered step-by-step to provide detailed information
on each operation. In actual service practice, these operations may be used as required.
Figure 11-26. Removal of Drive End Head Figure 11-27. Removal of End Head Bearing
g. On PA-28R-201 models, to remove the drive end head from the rotor shaft, use a puller that grips on
the bearing retainer plate as shown in Figure 11-26. Do not attempt to remove by supporting the end
head and pressing on the shaft as this may result in distortion of the end head or stripping of the
retainer plate screws. Remove the three retainer plate screws and press the bearing out of the end head.
(Refer to Figure 11-27.) On PA-28R-201T models, support the drive end head and carefully press out
the rotor assembly. Remove the three retainer plate screws and press the bearing from the end head.
(Refer to Figure 11-27.)
11-38. INSPECTION AND TESTING OF COMPONENTS. Upon completion of the disassembly, all parts
should be cleaned and visually inspected for cracks, wear or distortion and any signs of overheating or
mechanical interference.
a. Rotor: The rotor should be tested for grounded or shorted windings. The ground test can be made with
test probes, connected in series with a 110-volt test lamp, an ohmmeter or any type of continuity tester.
(Refer to Figure 11-28.) There must not be any continuity between the slip rings and the rotor shaft or
poles. To test for shorted turns in the rotor windings, connect a voltmeter, ammeter and rheostat as
shown in Figure 11-29, or use an ohmmeter. Rotor current draw and resistance are listed in the
Alternator Service Test Specifications paragraph. Excessive current draw or a low ohmmeter reading
indicates shorted windings. No current draw or an infinite ohmmeter reading would indicate an open
winding.
b. Rectifiers: A diode rectifier tester will detect and pin point open or shorted rectifiers without going
through the operation of disconnecting the stator leads. However, if a tester is not available, test probes
and a No. 57 bulb, connected in series with a 12-volt battery, can be used in the following manner.
Touch one test probe to a rectifier heat sink and the other test probe to a lead from one of the rectifiers
in that heat sink. Then reverse the position of the leads. The test bulb should light in one direction and
not light in the other direction. If the test bulb lights in both directions, one or more of the rectifiers in
the heat sink is shorted. To pin point the defective rectifier, the stator leads must be disconnected and
the above test repeated on each rectifier. Open rectifiers can only be detected, when using the test bulb,
by disconnecting the stator leads. The test bulb will fail to light in either direction if the rectifier is
open.
Figure 11-28. Testing Rotor for Ground Figure 11-29. Testing Rotor for Shorts
c. Stator: The stator can be tested for open or grounded windings with a 12-volt test bulb, described in
the rectifier section, or an ohmmeter, in the following manner. Separate the stator from the slip ring
end head just far enough to insert a fold of rags or blocks of wood. In other words, insulate the stator
from the end head. To test for grounded windings, touch one test bulb or ohmmeter probe to the
auxiliary terminal or any stator lead and the other test bulb or ohmmeter probe to the stator frame. If
the test bulb lights, or the ohmmeter indicates continuity, the stator is grounded. To test for open
windings, connect one test probe to the auxiliary terminal or the stator winding center connection and
touch each of the three stator leads. The test bulb must light or the ohmmeter must show continuity.
Due to the low resistance in the stator windings, shorted windings are almost impossible to locate.
However, shorted stator windings will usually cause the alternator to “growl” or be noisy during
operation and will usually show some signs of overheating. If all other electrical checks are normal
and alternator fails to supply its rated output, the stator should be replaced to determine whether or not
it is the faulty component.
d. Bearings and Seals: Whenever the alternator is overhauled, new bearings and oil or grease seals are
recommended, even though the bearings and seals appear to be in good condition. A faulty seal can
cause an alternator to fail within a very short period of time.
11-39. ASSEMBLY OF ALTERNATOR.
a. Press the ball bearing into the drive end head using a flat block approximately two inch square so that
the pressure is exerted on the outer race of the bearing. Install the retainer plate. With the snap ring and
retainer cup in place on the rotor shaft, use a tool that fits over the shaft and against the inner bearing
race, and press until the inner bearing race is against the snap ring retainer cup. (Refer to Figure 11-
30.)
b. Carefully install the rectifiers in the slip ring end head or rectifier mounting plate by supporting the
unit and using the special tools illustrated in Figure 11-31.
Figure 11-30. Installation of Drive End Head Figure 11-31. Installation of Rectifier
CAUTION
Use an arbor press, do not hammer. Reconnect the stator leads to the
rectifiers. When soldering these connections, use pliers as a heat dam on the
lead between the solder point and the rectifier. Too much heat will damage
the rectifiers.
c. Reassemble the rectifier mounting plate studs and insulators, making sure they are in the correct order.
(Refer to Figure 11-32.)
d. After the slip ring end head is completely assembled, the stator and rectifier leads must be secured to
the rectifier mounting plate with epoxy. Make sure the stator leads are positioned so that they do not
interfere with the rotor.
e. Install the slip ring end bearing and oil seal. Make sure the lip of the oil seal is toward the bearing. Stake
the seal in place. Correct assembly of bearing, seal, inner race and spacer as shown in Figure 11-33.
f. Assemble the alternator and install the through bolts. Spin the rotor to make sure there is no
mechanical interference. Torque the through bolts to 30 to 35 inch-pounds. Safety wire should be
installed after the unit has been bench tested for output.
g. On PA-28R-201, install spacer, woodruff key, fan, pulley, lockwasher and nut. Torque the nut to 35
foot pounds, using a strap wrench to hold the pulley.
h. Install the brush and holder assembly and retaining screws. Spin the rotor and check for interference
between the brush holder and rotor. Check between the field terminal and ground with an ohmmeter.
The ohmmeter must indicate the amount of rotor resistance listed with paragraph 11-41, Alternator
Service Test Specifications.
CAUTION
Do not test alternators used on PA-28R-201T at full rated output for more
than 30 seconds unless adequate-air pressure for cooling is supplied.
11-41. ALTERNATOR SERVICE TEST SPECIFICATION. Prestolite specifications for the 14-volt alternators
installed on PA-28R-201T. Prestolite alternators are also used on PA-28R-201 airplanes equipped with air
conditioning.
Figure 11-33. Slip Ring End Bearing Figure 11-34. Testing Alternator
Assembly
Rotor
Current Draw (77°F) 3.0 to 3.3 amps @ 12.0-volts 2.4 to 4.0 amps @ 12.0-volts
Resistance (77°F) 3.6 to 3.9 ohms 3.0 to 5.0 ohms
11-42. CHECK ALTERNATOR BELT TENSION. PA-28R-201. For aircraft with air conditioning installed,
see Paragraph 14-22, Section XIV, Replacement of Compressor and/or Alternator Drive Belts.
11-44. CHECKING VOLTAGE REGULATOR. The regulator is a fully transistorized unit in which all of the
components are encapsulated in epoxy, which makes field repair of the unit impractical, and if it does not meet
the specifications, it must be replaced. The regulator may be tested by the following procedure:
a. Be sure that the battery is fully charged and in good condition.
b. Check the alternator according to the manufacturer’s instructions to determine if it is functioning
properly. This test must be done with the regulator out of the circuit. After completing this test,
reconnect the regulator into the circuit.
c. Use a good quality accurate voltmeter with at least a 15-volt scale.
d. Connect the positive voltmeter lead to the red wire at the regulator harness connector or terminal
block. Connect the negative voltmeter lead to the regulator housing. (Note) Do not connect the
voltmeter across the battery because the regulator is designed to compensate for resistance contained
within the wiring harness.
e. With the alternator turning at sufficient rpm to produce a half load condition, or approximately 25
amperes output, the voltmeter should read between 13.6 and 14.3-volts. The ambient temperatures
surrounding the voltage regulator should be between 50°F to 100°F while this test is being made.
f. The voltage regulator heat sink, or case, is the ground connection for the electronic circuit. Therefore,
if this unit is tested on the bench it is most important that a wire, No. 14, be connected between the
regulator case and the alternator. If the regulator does not regulate between 13.6 and 14.4-volts, one of
the following conditions may exist:
1. Regulates, but out of specification. The regulator is out of calibration and must be replaced.
2. The voltmeter continues to read battery voltage.
a. Poor or open connections within the wiring harness.
b. The regulator is open.
11-46. CHECK OVERVOLTAGE RELAY. The relay may be tested with the use of a good quality, accurate
voltmeter, with a scale of at least 20-volts and a suitable power supply, with an output of at least 20-volts, or
sufficient batteries with a voltage divider to regulate voltage. The test equipment may be connected by the
following procedure:
a. B+ is connected to BAT of the overvoltage control.
b. B- is connected to the frame of the overvoltage control.
c. Be sure both connections are secure and connected to a clean, bright surface.
d. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the BAT terminal of the overvoltage control.
e. Connect the negative lead of the voltmeter to the frame of the overvoltage control.
f. The overvoltage control is set to operate between 16.2-volts to 17.3-volts. By adjusting the voltage, an
audible click may be heard when the relay operates.
g. If the overvoltage control does not operate between 16.2 and 17.3-volts, it must be replaced.
11-47. STARTING MOTORS. (Prestolite)
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper aircraft, it
is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
11-48. DESCRIPTION. On PA-28R-201 airplanes, the gear reduction starting motor consists of six major
components: the commutator end head assembly, the armature, the frame and field assembly, the gear housing,
the pinion housing, and the Bendix drive assembly. (Refer to Figure 11-37.) On PA-28R-201T, the starting
motor consists of five major components: the commutator end head assembly, the brush set and plate assembly,
the frame and field assembly, the armature, and the drive end head assembly. (Refer to Figure 11-38.)
11-49. OPERATION. When the starting circuit is energized, battery current is applied to the starting motor
terminal. Current flows through the field coils creating a strong magnetic field. At the same time, current flows
through the brushes to the commutator, through the armature windings to ground. The magnetic force created
in the armature combined with that created in the field windings begins to turn the armature.
The following information concerning starting motors operation, refer to the PA-28R-201 only. The gear
cut on the drive end of the armature shaft extends through the gear housing, where it is supported by a roller
bearing. The gear mates with the teeth of the reduction gear that drives the Bendix shaft. The shaft is keyed to
the reduction gear. The Bendix drive is held in position on the shaft by a spirol pin. The shaft is supported in
the gear housing by a closed end roller bearing and in the pinion housing by a graphitized bronze bearing.
When the armature turns the reduction gear, the Bendix drive pinion meshes with the flywheel ring gear by
inertia and action of the screw threads within the Bendix sleeve. A detent pin engages in a notch in the screw
threads which prevents demeshing if the engine fails to start when the starting circuit is de-energized.
When the engine reaches a predetermined speed, centrifugal action forces the detent pin out of the notch in
the screw shaft and allows the pinion to demesh from the flywheel.
11-50. MAINTENANCE. The starting circuit should be inspected at regular intervals, the frequency of which
should be determined by the amount of service and the conditions under which the aircraft is operated. It is
recommended that such inspection be made at each 100 hours and include the following:
a. The battery should be checked with a hydrometer to be sure it is fully charged and filled to the proper
level with approved water. A load test should be made to determine battery condition. If dirt and
corrosion have accumulated on the battery, it should be cleaned with a solution of baking soda and
water. Be sure none of the solution enters the battery cells.
b. The starting circuit wiring should be inspected to be sure that all connections are clean and tight and
that the insulation is sound. A voltage loss test should be made to locate any high-resistance
connections that would affect starting motor efficiency. This test is made with a low-reading voltmeter
while cranking the engine or at approximately 100 amperes and the following limits should be used:
1. Voltage loss from insulated battery post to starting motor terminal -0.3-volt maximum.
2. Voltage loss from battery ground post to starter frame -0.1-volt maximum.
NOTE
If voltage loss is greater than the above limits, additional tests should be
made over each part of the circuit to locate the high-resistance connections.
c. On PA-28R-201 airplanes, no lubrication is required on the starter motor except at the time of
overhaul. Then lubricate the entire shaft under Bendix drive, fill grooves in armature shaft at drive end
and pack gear box with 1.3 to 2.0 ounces of lithium soap base grease No. 1925 Molytex “O” or
equivalent.
On PA-28R-201T airplanes, no lubrication is required on the starting motor except at the time of
overhaul. Soak new absorbent bronze bearings in SAE 20 oil before installation. Saturate the felt
oiling pad in the commutator end head with SAE 20 oil. Allow excess oil to drain out before installing
end head on motor. Put a light film of Lubriplate 777 on the drive end of the armature shaft before and
after installing the drive end head.
d. The starting motor should be operated for a few seconds with the ignition switch off. This is to
determine that the starter engages properly and that it turns freely without binding or excessive noise.
Start the engine two or three times to check the starter drive assembly.
NOTE
Refer to Bendix for service information concerning the starter drive
mechanism.
11-51. OVERHAUL. If during the above inspection any indication of starting motor difficulty is noted, the
starting motor should be removed from the engine for cleaning and repair.
11-52. REMOVAL. To remove the starting motor from the engine, first disconnect the ground cable from the
battery post to prevent short circuiting. Disconnect the lead from the starting motor terminal, then take out the
mounting bolts. The motor can then be lifted off and taken to the bench for overhaul.
Figure 11-39. Turning Starting Motor Figure 11-40. Testing Motor Armature for
Commutator Short
11-53. DISASSEMBLY.
a. Disassembly of starter motor used on PA-28R-201 airplanes is as follows:
1. Remove the frame screws from the commutator end head and pull end head and armature from
frame. Lift the brushes and lock in elevated position with brush springs. Use a puller to remove the
end head from the armature. Use a special bearing puller to remove the sealed ball bearing from
the armature shaft
2. Remove the frame screws that secure the gear housing to the frame. Remove bolts and nuts
holding the gear housing to the pinion housing and separate the two units. Pull Bendix shaft from
pinion housing. Do not lose the steel spacer that is located on the pinion end of the shaft. Remove
reduction gear, woodruff key and steel spacer from shaft.
3. Turn the Bendix pinion until it locks in the extended position. Locate spirol pin and use a punch to
remove. Slide drive assembly off the shaft. Do not attempt to disassemble the drive and do not dip
it in cleaning solvent.
4. To remove the roller bearings from the gear housing, use an arbor press and the correct bearing
arbor. DO NOT HAMMER OUT. Each part should be cleaned and inspected for excessive wear or
damage. Bearings should be checked for proper clearance and evidence of roughness or galling.
Oil and dirt should be removed from insulation and the condition of the insulation checked.
b. Disassembly of starter motor used on PA-28R-201T airplanes is as follows:
1. Remove the safety wire and thru bolts from the commutator end and pull the end head from the
frame.
2. Pull the drive end head and armature from the frame and separate the drive end head from the
armature.
3. The drive end bearing may be removed by pressing out of the drive end head.
4. Each part should be cleaned and inspected for excessive wear or damage. Bearing should be
checked for proper clearance and evidence of roughness or galling. Oil and dirt should be removed
from insulation and the condition of the insulation checked.
Figure 11-41. Testing Motor Field for Grounds Figure 11-42. No-Load Test Hook-Up
11-54. BRUSHES. Check the brushes to see that they slide freely in their holders and make full contact on the
commutator. If worn to half their original length or less, they should be replaced.
11-55. ARMATURE.
a. Check the commutator for uneven wear, excessive glazing or evidence of excessive arcing. If only
slightly dirty, glazed or discolored, the commutator can be cleaned with 00 to 000 sandpaper. If the
commutator is rough or worn, it should be turned in a lathe. Refer to Figure 11-39. The armature shaft
should be inspected for rough bearing surfaces and rough or damaged splines.
b. To test the armature for grounds, a set of test probes connected in series with a 110-volt light should be
used. Touch one probe to a commutator segment and the other to the armature core. If the test lamp
lights, the armature is grounded and should be replaced.
c. To test for shorted armature coils, a growler is used. (Refer to Figure 11-40.) The armature is placed on
the growler and slowly rotated by hand while a steel strip is held over the core so that it passes over
each armature core slot. If a coil is shorted, the steel strip will vibrate.
d. A quick check for opens can be made by inspecting the trailing edge (in direction of rotation) of the
commutator segments for excessive discoloration. This condition indicates an open circuit.
11-56. FIELD COILS.
a. Check the field coils for grounds (refer to Figure 11-41) by placing one test probe on the frame and the
other on the starter terminal. Be sure the brushes are not accidentally touching the frame. If the lamp
lights, the fields are grounded. Repair or replace.
b. Inspect all connections to make sure they are clean and tight and inspect insulation for deterioration.
11-57. BRUSH HOLDERS.
a. To test brush holders, touch one test probe to the brush plate and the other to each brush holder.
b. The test lamp should light when the grounded brush holders are touched and should not light when the
insulated brush holders are touched.
11-58. GEAR AND PINION HOUSING. (PA-28R-201) Inspect housings for cracks and bearings for excessive
wear. Remove rust, paint or grease from mounting surfaces.
11-59. BENDIX DRIVE. (PA-28R-201) The Bendix drive should be wiped clean with a dry cloth. The pinion
should turn smoothly in one direction and should lock in the other direction. Replace drive if it fails to check
as above or if the pinion teeth are excessively worn or damaged.
11-60. ASSEMBLY.
a. On PA-28R-201, when assembling the starter motor, always use an arbor press and the proper bearing
arbor for installing graphitized bronze and roller bearings. The Bendix shaft should have a thin film of
Lubriplate No. 777 or equivalent on the Bendix portion of the shaft. End play should be .005 to .050 of
an inch.
On PA-28R-201T, when assembling the starting motor, always use a arbor press and the proper bearing
arbor for installing graphitized bronze bearings. Soak new absorbent bronze bearings in SAE 20 oil before
installation. Saturate the felt oiling pad in the commutator end head with SAE 20 oil. Allow excess oil to drain
out before installing end head on motor. Put a light film of Lubriplate No. 777 on the drive end of the armature
shaft before and after installing the drive end head.
b. New brushes should be properly seated when installing by wrapping a strip of 00 sandpaper around the
commutator (with the sanding side out) 1-1/4 to 1-1/2 times maximum. Drop brushes on sandpaper
covered commutator and turn the armature slowly in the direction of rotation. Dust should be blown
out of the motor after sanding.
NOTE
The spring tension is 32 to 40 ounces with new brushes. This tension is
measured with the scale hooked under the brush spring near the brush and
the reading is taken at right angles to the line of force exerted by the brush
spring.
c. On PA-28R-201, check the position of the pinion to be sure the unit will mesh properly with the
flywheel ring rear. See specifications of unit for correct dimensions. Refer to paragraph 11-63.
11-61. BENCH TESTS.
a. After the starting motor is reassembled, it should be tested to see that the no-load current at a certain
voltage is within specifications as given in paragraph 11-62. To make this test, connect as shown in
Figure 11-42. If current is too high, check the bearing alignment and end play to make sure there is no
binding or interference. Two or three sharp raps on the frame with a rawhide hammer will often help to
align the bearings and free the armature.
b. If no difficulty is indicated in the above test, a stall torque test may be made to see if the starting motor
is producing its rated cranking power. Make test connections as shown in Figure 11-43.
c. If torque and current are not within specifications, check the seating of the brushes and internal
connections for high resistance. If these checks are made and found to be in good order, replace frame
and field assembly and retest starter.
11-62. STARTING MOTOR CONTROL CIRCUIT.
a. Inspect the control circuit wiring between the battery, solenoid and manual starting switches for
breaks, poor connections and faulty insulation. Tighten all connections and make sure solenoid is
firmly mounted and makes a good ground connection.
b. Check the voltage loss across the switch contacts during normal starting. If loss is in excess of 0.2
volts per 100 amperes, the solenoid should be replaced.
c. If solenoid fails to operate when the manual starting switch is turned on or if it fails to release when
the manual starting switch is released, it should be removed and tested to specifications. If either
opening or closing voltages are not to specifications, replace the solenoid.
11-63. STARTING MOTOR SERVICE TEST SPECIFICATIONS. Prestolite specifications for standard
equipment 12-volt starting motors installed on both model aircraft are as shown in Table XI-III.
11-64. BATTERY.
11-65. SERVICING BATTERY. Access to the battery is through the aft side of the baggage compartment. It is
enclosed in a thermoplastic box with a vent system and a drain. The vents allow fresh air to enter the box and
draw off fumes that may accumulate due to the charging process of the battery. The drain is clamped off and
should be opened occasionally to drain any accumulation of liquid or during cleaning of the box. The battery
should be checked for fluid level but must not be filled above the baffle plates. A hydrometer check should be
performed to determine the percent of charge in the battery. All connections must be clean and tight.
Stall Torque
Amps 560 410
Min. Torque, Ft.-Lbs. 38.0 8
Approx. Volts 4.0 2.0
Pinion Position*
Drive at Rest 1.748 in. to 1.855 in.
Drive Extended 2.388 in. to 2.495 in.
*This dimension is measured from the centerline of the mounting hole nearest the drive end head to
the edge of the pinion.
1280 100
1250 75
1220 50
1190 25
1160 Very little useful capacity
1130 or below discharged
11-69. BATTERY BOX CORROSION PREVENTION. The battery should be checked for spilled electrolyte
or corrosion at least each 50 hour inspection or at least every 30 days, whichever comes first. Should this be
found in the box, on the terminals or around the battery, the battery should be removed and both the box and
battery cleaned by the following procedure:
a. Remove the box drain cap from the underside of the fuselage and drain off any electrolyte that may
have overflowed into the box.
b. Clean the battery and the box. Corrosion effects may be neutralized by applying a solution of baking
soda and water mixed to a consistency of thin cream. The application of this mixture should be applied
until all bubbling action has ceased.
CAUTION
Do not allow soda solution to enter battery.
c. Rinse the battery and box with clean water and dry.
d. Place the cap over the battery box drain.
e. Reinstall the battery.
11-70. STARTING THROUGH EXTERNAL POWER RECEPTACLE AND AIRPLANE’S BATTERY
NEARLY DEPLETED.
NOTE
Should the hydrometer reading indicate less than 1190, the battery should
be removed and recharged or replaced.
a. When using a 12-volt battery for external power starting and the airplane’s battery is nearly depleted,
the following procedure should be used:
1. Disconnect the airplane’s battery at the negative terminal to prevent excessive loading of the
external starting battery.
2. Check that all of the airplane’s electrical equipment is turned OFF.
3. Connect the external battery to the external power receptacle; turn master switch ON and start
engine using normal starting procedure.
4. Turn master switch OFF; remove external battery and then reconnect the battery at the negative
terminal.
5. Turn master switch ON and check ammeter for battery charging current.
b. When starting with a power cart and the airplane’s battery is nearly depleted, the procedure in step a.
need not be followed. The capacity of a power cart is sufficient to start an aircraft with a low battery. If
a 6-volt battery is available, it can be connected in series with the 12-volt external battery to supply
18-volts for starting. In this case, use the same starting procedure as used with a power cart.
CAUTION
If aircraft battery is weak, charging current will be high. Do not take off
until charging current falls below 20 amps.
Never use a 12 or 24-volt battery in place of a 6-volt battery since electrical
damage may result.
11-72. DESCRIPTION. The landing and taxi light consists of one light bulb. It is 100 watts and located in the
nose cowl. The light is controlled by a switch to a 10 amp circuit breaker.
11-73. REMOVAL.
a. Remove the retaining bracket from the lamp.
b. Pull lamp out and remove the two electrical leads from the back of the lamp. Lamp is now free.
NOTE
Make note of the placement of the wires to facilitate reinstallation.
11-74. INSTALLATION.
a. Replace electrical leads and secure with appropriate screws.
b. Insert lamp into position fit retaining bracket and secure with appropriate hardware.
11-75. NAVIGATION LIGHTS.
11-76. DESCRIPTION. There are three navigation lights; one on each wing tip and one on the tail. The
navigation lights are controlled by a single switch and a 10 amp circuit breaker.
11-82. DESCRIPTION. The lights are located on each wing tip in the same assembly with navigation lights on
the fin tip. They are rated to flash at approximately 50 times a minute.
11-87. TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURE. The strobe light functions as a condenser discharge system. A
condenser in the power supply is charged to approximately 450 volts dc discharged across the Xenon flash
tube at intervals of approximately 50 flashes per minute. The condenser is parallel across the Xenon flash tube
which is designated to hold off the 450 volts dc applied until the flash tube is triggered by an external pulse.
This pulse is generated by a solid state timing circuit in the power supply.
When troubleshooting the strobe light system, it must first be determined if the trouble is in the flash tube
or the power supply. Replacement of the flash tube will confirm if the tube is defective. A normally operating
power supply will emit an audible tone of 1 to 1.5 kHz. If there is no sound emitted, check the system
according to the following instructions. When troubleshooting the system, utilize the appropriate schematic at
the back of this section.
a. Ascertain the input voltage at the power supply is 14 volts.
CAUTION
When disconnecting and connecting the power supply input connections, do
not get the connections reversed. Reversed polarity of the input voltage for
just an instant will permanently damage the power supply. The reversed
polarity destroys a protective diode in the power supply, causing self-
destruction from overheating of the power supply. This damage is
sometimes not immediately apparent, but will cause failure of the system in
time.
b. Check for malfunction in interconnecting cables.
1. Ascertain Pins 1 and 3 of interconnecting cable are not reversed.
2. Using an ohmmeter, check continuity between Pins 1 and 3 of interconnecting cable. If a reading
is obtained on the meter, the cable is shorted and should be replaced.
NOTE
A short of the type described in Steps 1 and 2 will not cause permanent
damage to the power supply, but the system will be inoperative if such a
short exists. Avoid any connection between Pins 1 and 3 of the
interconnecting cable as this will discharge the condenser in the power
supply and destroy the trigger circuits.
CAUTION
When disconnecting the power supply, allow five minutes of bleed down
time prior to handling the unit.
c. Check interconnecting cables for shorts.
1. Disconnect the output cables from the power supply outlets.
2. The following continuity check can be made with an ohmmeter.
3. Check for continuity between the connectors of each interconnecting cable by checking from Pin 1
to Pin 1, Pin 2 to Pin 2, and Pin 3 to Pin 3. When making these checks if no continuity exists, the
cable is broken and should be replaced.
4. Check continuity between Pins 1 and 2, 1 and 3, 2 and 3 of the interconnecting cable. If continuity
exists between any of these connections, the cable is shorted and should be replaced.
11-88. INSTRUMENT AND PANEL LIGHTS. The instrument and panel lights are broken up into three
groups; Lower Panel Light, Upper Panel Lights, and Compass Light. The instrument lights are controlled by a
5 amp circuit breaker through a transistorized dimmer. A second dimmer control is connected to a variable
resistor which controls the light intensity for all the avionic equipment. The dimmer controls are located in the
middle of the instrument panel just above the pedestal. It may be necessary to gain access to the Dimmer
Control Assembly; if so, follow the instructions given below.
11-92. DESCRIPTION. The annunciator panel is a small cluster of lights which warn of malfunctions in the
various circuits or systems. A malfunction is identified by the illumination of an individual warning light.
There are three warning lights on the PA-28R-201 models and four warning lights on the PA-28R-201T
models. The PA-28R-201T also has a smaller light which indicates when the auxiliary fuel pump is on. Power
is supplied from the bus bar through a 5 amp fuse located behind the switch panel.
The VAC warning light is controlled by a vacuum sensor switch located at the firewall and is attached to
the vacuum regulator. The sensor switch will activate when the differential pressure is below 3.5 in. Hg.
The OIL warning light is controlled by an oil pressure sensor switch incorporated in the oil line to the oil
pressure gauge and is located at the firewall. The sensor switch will activate when the oil pressure is below 35
psi on PA-28R-201 or 30 psi on PA-28R-201T models.
The ALT warning light is illuminated by current flowing from the bus bar to the alternator circuit. This
condition exists when the alternator is not operating properly and the output is zero. During normal operation,
the alternator warning circuit is also supplied with power from the top diode terminal. This current flows
through a 5 amp fuse, located near the diode heat sink, to the resistor and diode creating a no-flow condition
which does not allow the warning light to light.
The OVER BST warning light used on PA-28R-201T is activated whenever the engine manifold pressure
exceeds 40.75 ± .15 inches of mercury. The manifold pressure sensor is incorporated in the manifold pressure
gauge.
A press-to-test button is used to check the operation of the lights when the engine is running. The lights
will work when the engine is not running with the master switch turned on. The auxiliary fuel on light is not
tested with the press-to-test button.
11-93. REMOVAL OF OIL PRESSURE SENSOR. Access to the sensor unit is gained by reaching up under
the instrument panel. Removal is accomplished by the following.
a. Disconnect the two electrical leads.
b. Unscrew the sensor unit from the bulkhead fitting.
c. Catch spillage and cover hole to prevent foreign matter from entering oil line.
11-98. REMOVAL OF IGNITION SWITCH. Access to the ignition switch is gained by reaching up under the
instrument panel.
a. Ensure the ignition switch is in the OFF position.
b. Disconnect the power lead from the battery.
c. Remove the retaining nut from the ignition switch on the front side of the instrument panel.
d. Pull the switch from the back side of the instrument panel and remove wires.
11-99. INSTALLATION OF IGNITION SWITCH. (Refer to Figure 11-44b.)
a. Using the illustration as a reference, attach the wires to the ignition switch.
b. Before proceeding, check for proper operation of the ignition switch as follows:
1. Remove the P-lead from the right magneto.
2. Attach the P-lead of the right magneto to an ohmmeter and to airframe ground.
3. With the switch in the OFF, L or START positions, the ohmmeter should indicate a closed circuit.
4. With the switch in the R or BOTH position, the ohmmeter should indicate an open circuit.
5. Reconnect the P-lead to the magneto.
c. Position the ignition switch in the instrument panel and secure with the retaining nut.
d. Reconnect the power lead to the battery.
ALTERNATOR
Zero output indicated Open field circuit. With master switch turned
on ammeter regardless on, check for battery voltage
of rpm (refer to alternator from airplane’s main buss
system test procedure). through entire field circuit
to alternator field terminal.
Measure voltage from ground
(-) to the following points
(+) in sequence: buss bar,
output circuit diodes, field
circuit breaker (SA), field
terminals of master switch,
voltage regulator and
alternator field terminal.
Interruption of voltage
through any of these points
isolates the faulty components
or wire which must be placed.
(See wiring schematic.)
ALTERNATOR (cont)
CAUTION
ALTERNATOR (cont)
ALTERNATOR (cont)
ALTERNATOR (cont)
CAUTION
ALTERNATOR (cont)
NOTE
ALTERNATOR (cont)
STARTER
STARTER (cont)
STARTER (cont)
BATTERY
Impurities in Replace.
electrolyte.
BATTERY (cont)
BATTERY (cont)
ANNUNCIATOR PANEL
All warning lights fail Blown fuse. Replace the 5 amp fuse
to operate. behind instrument panel.
No current from bus. Check all wire segments,
connections, and the
receptacle at the left side
of the annunciator panel.
All the warning lights Test switch grounded Check terminals and
fail to extinguish after out. replace switch if
engine is running. necessary.
CIRCUIT FUNCTION
LETTER CIRCUITS
A AUTOPILOT
B CONTROL SURFACE
E ENGINE INSTRUMENT
F FLIGHT INSTRUMENT
G LANDING GEAR
L LIGHTING
P POWER
RP RADIO POWER
J IGNITION
RG RADIO GROUND
W WARNING
K STARTER
Figure 11-50. Overhead Flood Lights Figure 11-51. Pitch Trim, PA-28R-201 and 201T
PA-28R-201 and 201T
Figure 11 -52. Pitot Heat, PA-28R-201 and 201T Figure 11-53. Radio Lights, PA-28R-201 and 201T
Figure 11-56. Turn and Bank, Figure 11-57. A/C Blower, PA-28R-201 and 201T
PA-28R-201 and 201T
Figure 11-66a. Landing Gear, Without Backup Extender Functional or Installed PA-28R-201 and 201T
12-1. INTRODUCTION TO AUTOFLIGHT. Due to the wide variety of A.F.C.S. (Automated Flight Control
System) options, it is mandatory to follow the service literature published by the individual manufacturer of
the A.F.C.S. equipment installed in any particular airplane. This includes mechanical service such as: adjusting
bridle cable tension, servo removal and installation, servo clutch adjustments, etc.
WARNING
When servicing or inspecting vendor equipment installed in Piper aircraft, it
is the user’s responsibility to refer to the applicable vendor publication.
12-2. NON-PIPER A.F.C.S. EQUIPMENT CONTACTS. Refer to the following list of Autopilot/Flight
Director manufacturers to obtain service direction, parts support, and service literature.
Global Navigation
2144 Michelson Drive
Irvine, California 92715
(714) 851-0119
12-3. PIPER A.F.C.S. EQUIPMENT. In the case of early models, Piper autopilot equipment bears the Piper
name and the appropriate Piper Autopilot/Flight Director Service Manual shall be used.
NOTE
If a Roll Axis-only Autopilot is installed, or if no Autopilot is installed,
consult the Piper Pitch Trim Service Manual - 753 771 for manual electric
pitch trim service information.
The following is a complete listing of Piper A.F.C.S. equipment service literature. It is imperative to correctly
identify the Autopilot system by “faceplate” model name in order to consult the appropriate service manual.
Each manual identifies the revision level and revision status as called out on the Master Parts Price List-
Aerofiche published monthly by Piper. Consult the aircraft’s parts catalog for replacement parts.
SECTION XII
ELECTRONICS
12-4. INTRODUCTION. This section of the manual contains information necessary to perform operational
checks of the Emergency Locator Transmitter (ELT), with and without a pilot’s remote switch. Included are the
appropriate removal and installation instructions to facilitate battery replacement.
12-6. DESCRIPTION. The ELT is an automatically activated emergency locator transmitter which, when
activated, will radiate an omni-directional RF signal on the international distress frequencies. The radiated
signal is modulated with a distinctive audio swept tone.
Electrical power for the ELT transmitter is supplied by its own self-contained magnesium or alkaline
battery. Per FAA regulations, a magnesium battery must be replaced 2 years from the date of manufacture
stamped on the battery pack and an alkaline battery must be replaced after 5 years of shelf life (replacement
date is marked on the transmitter label). The battery must be replaced if the transmitter has been used in an
e m e rgency situation or if accumulated test time exceeds one hour. To replace the battery pack in the
transmitter, it is necessary to remove the ELT from the airplane.
12-7. BATTERY REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION. (Communications Components Corp.) The ELT is
located on the right side of the airplane tail section, ahead of the stabilator.
a. Remove the access plate on the right side of fuselage aft of sta. 228.30.
b. Rotate the ON/ARM/OFF switch to the OFF position.
c. Disconnect the antenna coax cable (twist left, then pull outwards).
d. Disconnect the harness to the pilot’s remote switch.
e. Remove the forward mounting bracket by pulling the black plastic knob out. Remove the transmitter
from the airplane.
f. Remove the six Phillips-head screws securing the transmitter cover. Remove the cover.
g. Lift out the old battery pack.
h. Copy the expiration date on the battery into the space provided on the external ELT name and date
plate.
i. Disconnect and replace with a new battery pack. The nylon battery connector is a friction fit and is
easily removed by pulling on the exposed end.
j. Insert transmitter into airplane and fit into place. Replace mounting bracket by pushing the black
plastic knob into place.
k. Reconnect the pilot’s remote switch harness and the antenna coax cable to the transmitter.
l. Set the ON/ARM/OFF switch to the ARM position.
m. Reinstall the access plate previously removed.
NOTE
It may be advisable to test the unit operation before installing the access
plate. (See paragraph 12-9.)
NOTE
Inspect the external whip antenna for any damage. Avoid bending the whip.
Any sharply bent or kinked whip should be replaced. Antenna damage may
cause structural failure of whip in flight.
12-8. REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION (NARCO). The ELT is located on the right side of the airplane tail
section ahead of the stabilator.
1. Remove the access panel at fuselage station 228.30.
2. Set the ON/OFF/ARM switch on the transmitter to OFF.
3. Disconnect antenna coaxial cable from ELT.
4. Remove ELT from its mounting bracket by releasing the latch on the strap and sliding the ELT off
the bracket.
5. Extend the portable antenna.
6. Unscrew the four screws that hold the control head to the battery casing and slide apart.
7. Disconnect the battery terminals from the bottom of the circuit board.
8. Discard old battery pack. (DO NOT EXPOSE TO FLAME.)
CAUTION
The battery pack is shipped with a sealant on the inside lip so that a water
tight seal will be retained. DO NOT REMOVE THIS SEALANT.
9. Connect new battery pack terminals to the bottom of the circuit board.
10. Reinsert the control head section into the battery pack being careful not to pinch any wires, and
replace the four screws. If the four holes do not line up, rotate the battery pack 180° and reinsert.
11. Slide the portable antenna back into the stowed position.
12. Place transmitter into its mounting bracket and fasten the strap latch.
13. Connect the antenna coaxial cable to the ELT and ensure that the contact separator is inserted
between the antenna contact finger and the portable antenna.
14. Press RESET button and set ON/OFF/ARM switch to ARM.
15. Make an entry in the aircraft logbook, including the new battery expiration date.
16. A unit operational check may now be performed on the ELT. (Refer to Testing Emergency Locator
Transmitter, paragraph 12-10.)
NOTE
Inspect the external whip antenna for any damage. Avoid bending the whip.
Any sharply bent or kinked whip should be replaced. Antenna damage may
cause structural failure of whip in flight.
12-9. PILOT’S REMOTE SWITCH. A pilot’s remote switch, located on the left side panel, is provided to
allow the transmitter to be controlled from inside the cabin. The pilot’s remote switch is placarded ON,
AUTO/ARM and OFF/RESET. The switch is normally left in the AUTO/ARM position. The aircraft master
switch must be ON to turn the transmitter OFF. To actuate the transmitter for tests or in the event the automatic
feature was not triggered by impact, move the switch upward to the ON position and leave it in that position as
long as transmission is desired.
12-10. TESTING EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER. The transmitter operates on the emergency
frequencies of 121.5 and 243 mHz; both of these frequencies are monitored by the various FAA installations.
Before performing any operational test of the ELT, the following precautions should be observed:
CAUTION
Testing of an ELT should be conducted in a screen room or meter enclosure
to ensure that electromagnetic energy is not radiated during testing. If a
shielded enclosure is not available, testing may be performed in accordance
with the following procedures:
1. Test should be no longer than three audio sweeps.
2. If the antenna is removed, a dummy load should be substituted during
the test.
3. Test should be conducted only within the time period made up of the
first five minutes after any hour.
4. If the operational tests must be made at a time not included within the
first five minutes after the hour, the test should be coordinated with the
closest FAA Tower or Flight Service Station.
Consult FAA Advisory Circular AC 20-81 for detailed information
concerning above caution.
a. Remove the access plate on the right side of the fuselage aft of sta. 228.30.
b. Tune the aircraft communications receiver to 121.5 mHz and switch the receiver ON; deactivate the
squelch and turn the receiver volume up until a slight background noise is heard.
NOTE
If the aircraft is not fitted with a communications receiver, request that the
tower listen for your test.
c. On the transmitter, set the ON/ARM/OFF switch to the ON position. Keep the switch in this position
for only a few seconds; then set to the OFF position. Return to the ARM position.
NOTE
The test transmission should have been picked up by the aircraft
communications receiver and/or control tower. During cold weather, there
may be a slight delay before transmission occurs.
d. A transmitter which is functioning properly should emit a characteristic downward swept tone.
e. When the test is completed, ascertain the transmitter ON/ARM/OFF switch is in the ARM position.
f. Place the access panel on the right side of the fuselage aft of sta. 228.30.
WARNING
Whenever the unit is checked by moving the transmitter ON/ARM/OFF
switch from the ARM to the ON position, it must then be moved to the OFF
position before reverting to the ARM position again.
CAUTION
Under normal conditions, the transmitter switch must be set to arm.
12-11. TESTING PILOT’S REMOTE SWITCH. Before performing any operational test of the pilot’s remote
switch, the same precautions noted in paragraph 12-10 must be observed.
a. Tune the aircraft communications receiver to 121.5 mHz and switch the receiver ON, deactivate the
squelch and turn the receiver volume up until a slight background noise is heard.
NOTE
If the aircraft is not fitted with a communications receiver, request that the
tower listen for your test.
b. Set the pilot’s remote switch to the ON position. Hold the switch in this position for only a few
seconds.
NOTE
The test transmission should have been picked up by the aircraft
communications receiver and/or control tower. During cold weather, there
may be a slight delay before transmission occurs.
c. Set the pilot’s remote switch to the momentary OFF, RESET position. The switch is spring loaded to
automatically return to the ARM position.
12-12. INADVERTENT ACTIVATION. The remote switch allows the pilot to turn off the transmitter
inadvertently activated by impact or improper switch position. The pilot simply selects the momentary OFF,
RESET position. The transmitter shuts off and the spring loaded switch automatically returns to the ARM
position. The aircraft master switch must be ON to turn transmitter OFF with the remote switch. Stopping
inadvertent activation at the transmitter itself is accomplished in the following manner:
a. Improper switch selection is corrected by rotating the switch to the OFF position and then to the ARM
position.
b. If the transmitter is inadvertently activated through impact, deactivate by pushing in on the
OFF/ARM/ON switch.
NOTE
As a routine precaution, it is recommended that the ELT battery be replaced
at the earliest opportunity after inadvertent activation and a functional test
be made in accordance with paragraph 12-10. Note, however, that the
problem may not be in the transmitter. Check the following:
1. Proper spacing of antennas so as to minimize antenna conducted RF.
2. Rigidity of the transmitter installation.
CAUTION
Under normal conditions, the pilot’s remote switch must be set to ARM
position.
NOTE: AIRCRAFT POWER USED TO SHUT OFF THE ELT WITH REMOTE SWITCH.
ELECTRONICS
2K4
SECTION XIII
HEATING AND VENTILATING
Aerofiche
Paragraph Grid No.
SECTION XIII
13-1. INTRODUCTION. Because of the simplicity of the heating and ventilating system installed on both the
PA-28R-201 and PA-28R-201T models, the operation and maintenance instructions of the components are
contained in paragraph 13-3. A pictorial description of these systems may be found in Figure 13-1 or 13-2 and
Figure 13-3.
13-2. DESCRIPTION. On the PA-28R-201 model, the heat for the cabin is provided by a hot air muff installed
on the exhaust manifold. Fresh air enters the engine compartment through the nose cowling, passes over the
engine and is vented to the heater muff through a flexible hose located on the baffling at the rear of the engine.
With the PA-28R-201T model, heat is supplied by a hot air exchanger installed on the exhaust tail pipe. In this
case, the fresh air enters through the area surrounding the landing light and is vented to the heat exchanger,
through a hose aft of the landing light. In both models, the air is then heated and vented into the cabin area
through a valve which can be controlled from the instrument panel. When the valve is completely closed off,
the heated air is vented back into the engine compartment. The heater outlet in the cabin is located between the
two front seats. Control for the heater system is located on the right panel below the instruments. The
windshield is kept clear of frost, ice, etc. by a defroster system which also operates from the above mentioned
muff or exchanger but has an individual control.
Fresh air for both models is picked up from an inlet in the leading edge of each wing. The air passes
through the wings to individually controlled outlets located just forward of each seat. An air vent is located in
the bottom of the fuselage to take the exhaust air from the cabin interior.
13-3. HEATER MAINTENANCE. If the exhaust manifold should become defective, carbon monoxide fumes
may be discharged into the cabin area, therefore, it is imperative that the exhaust manifold (on PA-28R-201) be
inspected regularly. (Refer to the latest revision Piper Service Bulletin 691 for Muffler Assembly Inspection
Procedure.) The heater exchanger must be removed in order to inspect the tailpipe on PA-28R-201T, the heat
muff must be removed before the manifold assembly can be inspected on PA-28R-201. Check the operation of
the push-pull controls to ensure the valve doors function properly. When the controls are pulled out, the door
should be completely open to permit full air flow. When the controls are pushed in, the valves should close off
all air passage and vent the air into the engine compartment. Refer to either Figure 13-1 or 13-2 for an
illustration of the heater system.
13-4. OVERHEAD VENT SYSTEM. “NOT AVAILABLE WITH AIR CONDITIONING.” The overhead vent
system utilizes the ducting noted in Figure 13-3. Air enters an inlet at the top of the fin and is ducted through
the vent system. Small louvers control the flow of air into the cabin. This vent system may also be equipped
with a blower (optional). This blower, mounted aft of the close-out panel underneath the top of the fuselage,
will force air through the overhead vent system whenever desired.
2K10
ARROW III - TURBO ARROW III
ARROW
SERVICE MANUAL
CARD 3 OF 3
PA 28R-201/201T
3A1
CHEROKEE ARROW III SERVICE MANUAL
Service manual information incorporated in this set of Aerofiche cards is arranged in accordance with the
general specifications of Aerofiche adopted by the General Aviation Manufacturer’s Association. Information
complied in this Aerofiche service manual is kept current by revision distributed periodically. There revisions
supersede all previous revisions and are complete Aerofiche card replacements and supersede Aerofiche cards
of the same number in the set.
Revisions to Service Manual 761 639 issued December 15, 1976 are as follows:
Consult the latest Customer Services Information Aerofiche for current revision dates for this manual.
3A2
TABLE OF CONTENTS
NO. AEROFICHE CARD NO. 1 GRID NO.
I INTRODUCTION lA13
IV STRUCTURES lD17
X INSTRUMENTS 2F5
3A3
LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS (cont.)
Aerofiche
Figure Grid No.
14-1. Air Conditioning System Installation................................................................................ 3A8
14-2. Service Valves ................................................................................................................... 3A12
14-3. Test Gauge and Manifold Set ........................................................................................... 3A13
14-4. Manifold Set Operation..................................................................................................... 3A14
14-5. Leak Test Hook-Up ........................................................................................................... 3A15
14-6. Evacuation Hook-Up......................................................................................................... 3A17
14-7. Charging Stand.................................................................................................................. 3A19
14-8. Charging Hook-Up............................................................................................................ 3A20
14-8a. Top Dead Center Casting Mark (Sankyo Compressor)..................................................... 3B1
14-8b. Rotation of Clutch Front Plate (Sankyo Compressor Oil Check) ..................................... 3B1
14-9. York Compressor and Fabricated Oil Dipstick (PA-28R-201).......................................... 3B2
14-9a. Compressor and Alternator Belt Installation..................................................................... 3B3
14-10. Magnetic Clutch (York Compressor)................................................................................. 3B6
14-11. Condenser Air Scoop Installation...................................................................................... 3B9
14-12. Expansion Valve................................................................................................................ 3B10
14-13. Components Installation.................................................................................................... 3B12
14-14. Adjustment of Air Conditioning Throttle Switch (PA-28R-201)...................................... 3B13
14-15. Air Conditioning Wiring Schematic.................................................................................. 3B14
14-16. Oxygen Installation ........................................................................................................... 3C2
14-17. Test Apparatus for Testing Oxygen System...................................................................... 3C3
14-18. Oxygen Tubing Installations.............................................................................................. 3C4
14-19. Installation of Swageloc Fittings....................................................................................... 3C7
14-20. Portable Oxygen Installation............................................................................................. 3C14
LIST OF TABLES
Aerofiche
Table Grid No.
XIV-I. Temperature Pressure Chart............................................................................................... 3A9
XIV-II. Aluminum Tubing Torque................................................................................................. 3A12
XIV-III. Compressor Oil Charge..................................................................................................... 3A24
XIV-IV. Troubleshooting Chart (Air Conditioner).......................................................................... 3B16
XIV-V. Blower System Wire Color Codes..................................................................................... 3B23
XIV-VI. Oxygen System Component Limits................................................................................... 3C15
XIV-VII. Troubleshooting Chart (Oxygen System).......................................................................... 3C17
LIST OF CHARTS
Aerofiche
Chart Grid No.
VIII-III. Oxygen System Limits...................................................................................................... 3C8
VIII-IV. Filling Pressure for Certain Ambient Temperatures.......................................................... 3C13
Revised: 2/13/89
3A4
SECTION XIV
ACCESSORIES AND UTILITIES
Aerofiche
Paragraph Grid No.
14-1. Air Conditioning Installation............................................................................................. 3A4
14-2. Description ........................................................................................................................ 3A4
14-3. Air Conditioning System Operation.................................................................................. 3A4
14-4. Malfunction Procedures..................................................................................................... 3A7
14-5. Special Servicing Procedures............................................................................................ 3A8
14-6. Service Valves ................................................................................................................... 3A9
14-7. Service Valves Replacement.............................................................................................. 3A10
14-8. Test Gauge and Manifold Set ............................................................................................ 3A10
14-9. Checking the System for Leaks......................................................................................... 3A12
14-10. Leak Check - Method I...................................................................................................... 3A12
14-11. Leak Check - Method II .................................................................................................... 3A13
14-12. Discharging........................................................................................................................ 3A13
14-13. Evacuating the System ...................................................................................................... 3A14
14-14. Charging the System.......................................................................................................... 3A15
14-15. With a Charging Stand....................................................................................................... 3A15
14-16. Using the Airplane Compressor to Charge the System..................................................... 3A16
14-17. Addition of Partial Charge to System................................................................................ 3A18
14-18. Compressor Service........................................................................................................... 3A18
14-19. Compressor Removal ........................................................................................................ 3A19
14-20. Compressor Installation..................................................................................................... 3A19
14-21. Checking Compressor Oil ................................................................................................. 3A20
14-22. Replacement of York Compressor and/or Alternator Drive Belts..................................... 3A21
14-23. Adjustment of Drive Belt Tension..................................................................................... 3B2
14-24. Magnetic Clutch (York Compressor)................................................................................. 3B3
14-25. Magnetic Clutch Removal................................................................................................. 3B3
14-26. Magnetic Clutch Installation ............................................................................................. 3B3
14-27. Refrigerant Lines and Routing .......................................................................................... 3B4
14-28. Receiver-Dehydrator ......................................................................................................... 3B4
14-29. Receiver-Dehydrator Removal.......................................................................................... 3B4
14-30. Receiver-Dehydrator Installation ...................................................................................... 3B4
14-31. Condenser.......................................................................................................................... 3B5
14-32. Condenser Assembly Removal.......................................................................................... 3B5
14-33. Condenser Installation....................................................................................................... 3B5
14-34. Condenser Door Actuator.................................................................................................. 3B5
14-35. Condenser Assembly Rigging Instructions ...................................................................... 3B5
14-36. Expansion Valve................................................................................................................ 3B7
14-37. Expansion Valve Removal................................................................................................. 3B7
14-38. Expansion Valve Installation............................................................................................. 3B7
14-39. Evaporator Assembly ........................................................................................................ 3B8
14-40. Evaporator Assembly Removal......................................................................................... 3B8
SECTION XIV
14-2. DESCRIPTION. These installations consist of a compressor with its special bracketry, an evaporator, a
condenser, a receiver-dehydrator, circulating fan, thermal expansion valve, and related plumbing.
The evaporator filters, dehumidifies and cools the air. The evaporator is mounted in a fabricated housing
along with the receiver-dehydrator, circulating fan, thermal expansion valve and related plumbing. This
housing is located at the rear of the cabin, aft of the baggage area. The compressor is a piston type unit which
is supported by special bracketry at the front of the engine on PA-28R-201 and at the rear of the engine on
PA28R-201T models. A V-belt connection drives the compressor through a magnetic clutch (refer to Figure
14-1). The condenser is installed on a hinge mounted door that is located on the bottom portion of the fuselage
tail section. The condenser door is mounted to allow extension into the airstream during system operation. The
condenser door is electrically activated to provide the following positions (system on-fully extended or system
off-fully retracted).
The system is protected by a Ranco type pressure switch which automatically controls the condenser
maximum head pressures by temporarily de-clutching the compressor in the event the pressure becomes
excessively high. The controls are located on the aircraft instrument panel adjacent to the heater and defroster
levers, and consist of an Air Conditioning ON-OFF control, a three position fan control (LOW-MED-HIGH) to
govern the cold air velocity, and a temperature control.
The system design is much that there is no increase in drag to the aircraft during its takeoff flight
conditions. During maximum power demands, the compressor is de-clutched and the condenser door is
automatically retracted.
14-3. AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM OPERATION. The air conditioning system in these airplanes are a
recirculating, independent unit. Its filters dehumidifies and cools the air as it cycles through the evaporator.
The unit is operated from controls mounted on the right side of the instrument panel. The air conditioning
master switch has three positions: FAN only, OFF and AIR COND. When the AIR COND position is selected
the compressor clutch engages, the condenser scoop opens and the circulating fan is turned on. The
temperature is controlled by a thermostat operated by the temperature control selector. A three position fan
switch (LOW-MED-HIGH) operated the blower. The fan may be operated to circulate air without using the air
conditioning unit.
The air conditioning system uses Refrigerant 12 ad the refrigerant. The refrigerant enters the compressor
as a vapor. The compressor pressurized the heat-laden vapor until its pressure and heat reach a point much
hotter than the outside air. The compressor then pumps the vapor to the condenser where it cools and changes
to a liquid. The liquid then passes to the receiver-dehydrator. Its function is to filter, remove any moisture and
ensure a steady flow of liquid refrigerant into the evaporator through the expansion valve. The expansion valve
is a temperature controlled metering valve which regulates the flow of the liquid refrigerant to the evaporator.
The evaporator absorbs the heat from the air passing over the coils. From the evaporator the refrigerant vapor
returns to the compressor where the cycle is repeated.
NOTE
A table at the end of these instructions will assist in locating and correcting
malfunctions which may arise in this system.
NOTE
The air conditioning system should be operated at least once a month to
prevent sticking valves and keep the system lubricated.
14-4. MALFUNCTION DETECTION. The detection of system malfunction largely depends on the
mechanic’s ability to interpret the gauge pressure readings into system problems. A system operating normally
will have a low side gauge pressure reading that will correspond with the temperature of the refrigerant
evaporating in the evaporator, allowing for a few degrees temperature rise due to loss in the tube walls and
fins. The high side will have a gauge pressure that will correspond with the temperature of the refrigerant
condensing in the condenser, allowing for a few degrees temperature drop due to loss in the tube walls and
fins.
Any deviation from that which is normal indicates a malfunction within the system due to a faulty control
device, obstruction, defective part, or improper installation.
Detection of system malfunction is made easier with the knowledge that the temperature and pressure of
Refrigerant 12 is in close proximity between the pressures of twenty and eighty pounds per square inch (psi).
A glance at the temperature-pressure chart will show that there is only a slight variation between the
temperature and pressure of the refrigerant in the lower range.
It is correct to assume that for every pound of pressure added to the low side, a temperature increase of
about one degree Fahrenheit takes place. For instance, a pressure of 23.8 on the chart indicates a temperature
of 24°F. A change of pressure of almost one pound to 24.6 psi gives us a temperature increase to 25°F.
NOTE
For each 1,000 feet of elevation above sea level, the gauge readings will be
about one inch of mercury or 1/2 psi higher than the chart indicates.
It must be pointed out that the actual temperature of the air passing over the coils of the evaporator will be
several degrees warmer allowing for a temperature rise caused by the loss in the fins and tubing of the
evaporator.
The importance of a seasonal check up of the air conditioning system should be brought to the attention of
the customer whenever possible. A thorough check of the system performed in a methodical manner will
reveal trouble the customer is often not aware of. Locating and repairing the trouble early will usually result in
savings to the customer both in time and additional troubles that too often result from neglect.
A Performance Test of the system is the only positive way in which the complete system can be checked
for efficient operation. The air conditioning system should be given this test before work is begun on the
system whenever possible, however, if the system is completely inoperative, repairs must be performed before
the system can be properly tested. The test can uncover further work that must be performed before the system
is brought to its full operating efficiency. The Performance Test should always be performed after repair work
has been done and before the aircraft is released to the customer. The serviceman performing this test carefully
will ensure that the repairs have been properly performed and that the system will operate satisfactorily.
The Performance Test, when properly performed, includes a thorough examination of the outside of the
system as well as the inside. Many related parts are overlooked because it is felt they are of no bearing on the
operating efficiency of the unit. For this reason, a thorough visual inspection of the complete system should be
performed, followed by an operating inspection of the system.
14-5. SPECIAL SERVICING PROCEDURES. The air conditioning system should be serviced by a qualified
shop with trained personnel. The following procedure and precautions should be observed.
The efficiency of this system depends upon the pressure-temperature relationship of pure refrigerant. As
long as the system contains only pure refrigerant plus a specified amount of compressor oil (which is mixed
with the refrigerant) it is considered to be chemically stable. Foreign materials within the system will affect the
chemical stability, contaminate the system, and decrease its efficiency.
I. GENERAL REFRIGERATION SYSTEM PROCEDURES.
A. REFRIGERANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS.
1. Refrigerant 12 (commonly known at R-12 or Freon 12) is odorless and colorless in either the
liquid or gaseous state. R-12 for charging refrigeration systems is supplied in pressurized
containers (approx. 70 psi at 70°F) in liquid form. Since this material is essentially inert at
room temperatures, the dangers are primarily associated with the pressure and the refrigeration
effects of the release and subsequent evaporation of this pressurized liquid.
2. Wear suitable eye protection when handling R-12 due to the possibility of freezing of the eye
if contacted by escaping liquid refrigerant. If liquid R-12 does strike the eye, the following
action should be taken.
a. DO NOT RUB THE EYE.
b. Splash large quantities of cool water into the eye to raise the temperature.
c. Tape on an eye patch to avoid the possibility of dirt entering the eye.
d. Rush to a physician or hospital for immediate professional aid.
e. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO TREAT IT YOURSELF.
3. If liquid R-12 strikes the skin, frostbite can occur. Treat with cool water and protect with
petroleum jelly.
4. Do not discharge large quantities of R-12 into closed rooms. It may displace most of the air in
the room and this could cause oxygen starvation. Gaseous R-12 is heavier than air and flows
to the bottom of a container.
5. Do not discharge R-12 into an open flame or onto a very hot surface (500°F+). Poisonous
phosgene gas is generated by the action of the heat on the refrigerant.
6. Do not apply direct flame or other high heat source to a R-12 container due to the high
pressures which will result. If any heating is done to R-12 containers, the container pressure
should be monitored and kept below 150 psi.
B. SYSTEM SERVICING PRECAUTIONS.
1. Systems should be discharged slowly to prevent the escape of liquid refrigerant and the loss of
the lubricating oil.
2. Systems should not be left open to the atmosphere when discharged. Moisture and other
contamination may enter and damage open systems.
3. Never introduce anything but pure refrigerant and refrigerant oil into a system.
4. Keep refrigerant oil containers tightly sealed and clean to prevent absorption of moisture or
other contamination.
5. Use only approved refrigeration oil in the compressor. If any doubt exists about the cleanliness
of the compressor oil, replace it with new oil.
6. Never reuse oil removed from the system. Discard it.
7. When Loctite Refrigerant Sealant has been used on a joint it must be heated to 400°F prior to
disassembly. Loctite must be used to seal any pipe threads in the system lines.
8. Replace the receiver-dehydrator assembly on any system which has been operating with a leak
allowing air to enter the system. If a receiver-dehydrator is left open to the atmosphere it
should be replaced due to the loss of effectiveness of the drying compound it contains.
NOTE
A very strong acid (HCL) is formed when R-12 comes in contact with
moisture.
A new receiver-dehydrator should be opened and connected to the system
only when ready to charge the system with refrigerant.
9. Recommended torque values must be used on all flare fitting and O-ring joints. See Table XIV-II.
14-6. SERVICE VALVES. The purpose of the service valve is to service the air conditioning system (Testing,
Bleeding, Evacuating and Charging). This aircraft is equipped with service valves mounted in the suction and
discharge lines of the evaporator assembly. These valves are the “2” position type Schrader valves. All normal
air conditioning service should be performed at the evaporator assembly mounted valves.
NOTE
Service valves are also located on the compressor. However, use of these
valves in servicing is not recommended.
NOTE
If a Schrader service valve is not serviceable, the core assembly must be
replaced.
14-7. SERVICE VALVE REPLACEMENT. The valves on the York compressor are sealed with a gasket placed
in the valve port boss. Lubricate the gasket with refrigerant oil of the type used in the compressor, place the
valves with the tube fitting aft and secure with .312 bolts, torque to 15-23 inch pounds.
NOTE
Whenever the air conditioning refrigerant lines or system is opened for any
reason, the lines and fittings should be capped and sealed immediately to
prevent dirt and other contaminants from entering the system. (It is not
advisable to put a plug into the hoses or fittings.)
14-8. TEST GAUGE AND MANIFOLD SET. The proper testing and diagnosis of the air conditioning system
require that a manifold gauge set be attached into the system. This set consists of two gauges mounted to a
manifold. One gauge is a high pressure gauge used in the discharge side of the system. The other is a low
pressure gauge used in the suction side of the system. The manifold is a device having fittings for both gauges
and connection hoses with provisions for controlling the flow of refrigerant through the manifold. See Figures
14-3 and 14-4.
The center port of the manifold set is used for charging or evacuation procedures, or any other service that
may be necessary.
Both the high and low side of the manifold have hand shutoff valves. When the hand valve is turned all the
way in, in a clockwise direction, the manifold is closed. The pressures on the side of the system will, however,
be recorded on the gauge above the hose.
Cracking the hand valve, in the counterclockwise direction, opens the system to the middle service port of
the manifold set. This is desirable only when it is necessary to let refrigerant out or into the system. Refer to
Figures 14-3 and 14-4.
14-9. CHECKING THE SYSTEM FOR LEAKS. There are several methods of doing this operation,
depending on the type of equipment which is available. Two methods of performing this check will be covered
in the following paragraphs.
NOTE
Evacuate system prior to leak check.
14-10. LEAK CHECK - METHOD I.
a. Connect the manifold gauge set into the system and determine if there is any refrigerant in the
system. A minimum of 50 psi refrigerant pressure in the system is needed for leak detection.
(Refer to Figure 14-5.)
b. Purge the hoses of air by allowing some refrigerant to escape from the connections at the service
valves. Then tighten connections at the service valve.
c. Close the low side manifold valve and open the high side manifold valve.
d. Open the refrigerant container service valve and allow the pressure at the low side gauge to reach
50 psi at which time close the high side manifold valve.
e. Close the refrigerant container service valve and remove the hose if no leaks are evident.
f. It is advisable to use an electronic leak detector to check this system instead of an open flame leak
detector due to the possible presence of gasoline fumes in the engine area.
g. If any leaks are found, purge the system of refrigerant, make the necessary repairs and check the
compressor oil.
h. Add oil, if required, (refer to paragraph 14-21 and Table XIV-II) then repeat steps a. thru e.
i. If no further leaks are found, the system may be evacuated and charged. Refer to paragraphs 14-13
and 14-14.
27.99 100
COMPOUND GAUGE 28.89 80
READING IN INCHES 29.40 60
OF MERCURY VACUUM 29.71 40
29.82 20
29.88 0
NOTE
For each 1,000 feet of elevation above sea level, the compound gauge
reading will be about one inch lower, numerically.
b. Connect the manifold gauge set to the airplane service valves. (Refer to Figure 14-6.)
c. The high and low manifold hand valves should be in the closed position. (Refer to Figure 14-3 and
14-4.)
d. Connect the center manifold hose to the inlet of the vacuum pump.
NOTE
Make sure the exhaust port on the vacuum pump is open to avoid damage to
the vacuum pump.
e. Start the vacuum pump and open the low side manifold hand valve. Observe the compound, low
pressure gauge needle, it should show a slight vacuum.
f. Continue to operate the vacuum pump until 26 to 28 inches of vacuum is attained on the low
pressure gauge, then extend the operation for another 25 minutes.
g. If the system cannot maintain 26 to 28 inches of vacuum, close both manifold hand valves and
observe the compound gauge.
h. Should the compound gauge show a loss of vacuum, there is a leak in the system which must be
repaired before continuing with evacuation.
i. If no leaks are evident, reopen both manifold hand valves and continue the evacuation for another
30 minutes.
j. Close both manifold hand valves, stop vacuum pump and disconnect center manifold hose from
the vacuum pump.
k. Proceed to charge the system in accordance with paragraph 14-14.
NOTE
The system should be charged as soon as it has been evacuated.
14-14. CHARGING THE SYSTEM. When the system is completely evacuated in accordance with instructions
given in paragraph 14-13, one of the following procedures should be used to charge the system.
14-15. WITH A CHARGING STAND. This is the preferred method of charging the system.
NOTE
The following instructions apply to Kent Moore, J23500 charging stand.
Refer to Figure 14-7.
a. With the system discharged and evacuated, proceed to hook-up the charging stand. (Refer to
Figure 14-8.)
b. Fill the charging cylinder by opening the valve at the base of the charging cylinder and filling the
sight glass with two pounds of liquid refrigerant.
c. As refrigerant stops filling the sight glass, open the valve at the top of the gauge neck assembly
intermittently to relieve head pressure and allow refrigerant to continue filling the sight glass to the
required amount.
d. When refrigerant reaches the required level in the sight glass, close both the valve at the base of
the cylinder and the valve at the bottom of refrigerant tank. Be sure the top valve is fully closed.
14-16. USING THE AIRPLANE COMPRESSOR TO CHARGE THE SYSTEM. This method is the least
desirable due to the requirement of operating the airplane’s engine to run the compressor.
WARNING
If the air conditioner is to be operated during ground servicing, the test area
should be clean and free of any loose objects lying on the ramp. Only the
service valve located on the evaporator assembly should be used for testing.
a. With the system evacuated as outlined in paragraph 14-13, connect the refrigerant charging hose to
the manifold (refer to Figure 14-8) and purge the charging hose of air.
b. Place the refrigerant container on a scale to observe the amount of refrigerant entering the system.
Open the high pressure valve and add as much refrigerant as possible.
c. Close the high pressure valve, start the engine and operate it at 900 to 1000 rpm.
d. Operate the air conditioner and set controls to maximum cooling.
e. Open the low pressure valve and complete charging the system.
f. Close the low pressure valve after two pounds of refrigerant has been added to the system.
g. With the system still operating, observe the sight glass in the top of the receiver-dehydrator by
removing the plastic plug.
h. The sight glass should be clear of any bubbles or foam. If bubbles or foam are seen passing
through the sight glass, it is an indication of a low refrigerant charge in the system and more
refrigerant is required. This check should be made with OAT of 70°F or higher and with the air
conditioner operating.
i. If more refrigerant must be added to the system, open the low pressure valve and increase engine
speed to 2000 rpm and observe the sight glass. After the sight glass has cleared, close the low
pressure valve and observe the pressure gauges. At 1000 rpm, the gauge pressure should be 15 to
20 psi on the low side and 150 to 200 on the high side.
NOTE
Suspect leaks or an inaccurate scale if two pounds of refrigerant does not
fill the system.
j. Shut off the air conditioning system and airplane engine. Then, remove the charging lines from the
Schrader valves with care due to the refrigerant remaining in the hose.
NOTE
A shop cloth should be used to divert escaping refrigerant when
disconnecting the charging hose from the Schrader valve. Recap the valve.
14-17. ADDITION OF PARTIAL CHARGE TO SYSTEM. It is possible to top off this system with refrigerant
by the following method.
a. Remove the access panel at the rear of the cabin.
b. Connect a charging hose to a refrigerant cylinder and also to the Schrader valve fitting on the
suction line. (Refer to Figure 14-8.)
c. Purge the charging hose by allowing a small amount of refrigerant gas to escape at the Schrader
valve fitting.
d. Start the engine and operate at 1000 rpm and turn the air conditioner on maximum cool.
e. Remove the plastic plug from the sight glass in the top of the receiver-dehydrator.
f. With a low refrigerant charge in the system, bubbles will be seen passing thru the sight glass when
the system is operating.
g. Open the valve on the refrigerant cylinder.
h. Allow refrigerant to flow into the system until the bubbles disappear from the sight glass.
i. Close the refrigerant valve and check to see that the sight glass remains clear during system
operation.
j. When the sight glass stays clear of bubbles, add an additional 1/4 pound of refrigerant to the
system. (Engine should be operating at 1000 rpm.)
NOTE
This should be done with OAT at 70°F, or higher, with the air conditioner
operating.
k. Shut off the air conditioner and engine. Remove the charging hose from the Schrader valve with
care due to refrigerant remaining in the line.
1. Replace the access panels.
14-18. COMPRESSOR SERVICE. It is not advisable to service the compressor in the field. It should be done
by a qualified shop which has the special equipment and trained personnel required to properly service the
unit.
Maintenance of the York unit and its related components is limited to the replacement of worn drive belt
and magnetic clutch Any other service requires removal of the compressor from the system. Maintenance to
the Sankyo compressor is limited to replacement of worn drive belt. Contact Sankyo International, 3529 Miller
Park Drive, P.O. Box 2903, Garland, Texas 75042 for special tools and instructions for detailed compressor
maintenance.
NOTE
An important factor in air conditioning servicing is cleanliness and care
should be exercised to prevent dirt or foreign material from entering the
system. All hose and tubing ends should be capped immediately. Any
lubrication required in the assembly of the components should be
refrigerant oil of the type used in the compressor.
14-19. COMPRESSOR REMOVAL. (The removal of the compressor requires a complete system discharge.)
See paragraph 14-12.
a. The removal instructions for the York compressor are as follows:
1. Be certain the circuit protector is off for the air conditioning system.
2. Remove the engine cowling and right front baffles.
3. Disconnect the electrical leads to the magnetic clutch on the compressor.
4. Depressurize the air conditioning system.
5. Remove the suction and discharge lines from the service valves on the compressor.
NOTE
All open lines should be capped immediately to prevent dirt and moisture
from entering the system.
6. Loosen the bolt securing the compressor idler pulley to release the belt tension and remove
belt from compressor pulley. (Do not force belt over the pulleys.)
7. Support the compressor and remove the six bolts securing the compressor to the engine
mounting brackets.
b. The removal instructions for the Sankyo compressor are as follows:
1. Ascertain that air conditioning circuit protector is in the off position.
2. Remove engine cowling.
3. Disconnect the electrical leads to the magnetic clutch on the compressor.
4. Depressurize the air conditioning system.
5. Remove the suction and discharge line from the service valves on the compressor.
NOTE
All open lines should be capped immediately to prevent dirt and moisture
from entering the system.
6. Loosen the four bolts securing the compressor in the mounting brackets. Rotate the
compressor in the bracket slots to disconnect drive belt.
7. Support compressor and remove the attachment bolts.
CAUTION
Do not force the belt into the pulley sheave. If necessary, remove the idler
assembly.
4. Connect the discharge and suction lines to their respective service valve fittings.
5. Evacuate and charge the system per paragraphs 14-13 and 14-14.
WARNING
If the air conditioner is to be operated on the ground for servicing, the test
area should be clean and free of any loose objects lying on the ramp. Only
the service valves located on the evaporator assembly should be used for
testing.
b. The installation instructions for the Sankyo compressor are as follows:
1. Place the compressor in the mounting brackets and install attachment bolts. Do not torque
attachment bolts at this time.
2. Install compressor drive belt. Rotate compressor drive belt. Rotate compressor in mounting
bracket slots to obtain a belt tension of 85 to 90 lbs. Torque the four attachment bolts 300 to
350 in.-lbs. (Also, refer to paragraph 14-23.)
3. Check the oil level in the compressor in accordance with instructions given in paragraph 14-
21.
4. Connect the discharge and suction lines to their respective fittings.
WARNING
If the air conditioner is to be operated on the ground for servicing, the test
area should be clean and free of any loose objects lying on the ramp. Only
the service valves located on the evaporator assembly should be used for
testing.
14-21. CHECK COMPRESSOR OIL. The oil level should be checked any time the system is discharged.
a. The following steps should be followed to perform York compressor oil check.
1. It will be necessary to discharge the system. (Refer to paragraph 14-12.)
2. Fabricate an oil dipstick. (Refer to Figure 14-9.)
3. Remove the oil fill plug. (A.375 inch plug in the top side of the compressor crankcase.)
4. Before inserting the dipstick, the crankshaft Woodruff key should be located in the up
position. (The front face of the compressor clutch is marked with a stamped “K” indicating the
key position.) The oil level should be measured from the lowest point in the crankcase. Use
the long end of the dipstick. (See Figure 14-9.)
5. With the compressor in the installed position, use Table XIV-III to determine the amount of oil
in crankcase.
6. The compressor should never be operated with less than 6 ounces of oil. When oil is added,
the level should not go above 10 ounces. Piper refrigerant oil PMS-L2000 or equivalent 500
viscosity refrigerant oil must be used.
7. Evacuate and charge system. (Per paragraphs 14-13 and 14-14.)
NOTE
The 10 ounce oil level is required in compressors installed on new systems.
Some oil is distributed in the system during operation. Replacement
compressors should be charged with 10 ounces of oil.
CAUTION
The oil plug should not be removed with pressure in the system.
b. Use the following instructions for checking Sankyo compressor oil level.
1. Run the compressor for 10 minutes with engine at 1900 rpm.
WARNING
If the air conditioner is to be operated on the ground for servicing, the test
area should be clean and free of any loose objects lying on the ramp. Only
the service valves located on the evaporator assembly should be used for
testing.
2. Discharge the system per paragraph 14-12; be careful not to loose any oil.
3. Remove the oil fill plug.
4. Position the rotor to top dead center (refer to Figure 14-8a) by rotating the clutch front plate
until the casting mark is visible in the center of the hole.
5. Rotate the clutch front plate clockwise by approximately 110° (refer to Figure 14-8b).
6. Insert dipstick No. 32447 purchased from Sankyo (see paragraph 14-18 for Sankyo address).
7. Remove the dipstick and count the number of increments of oil. The acceptable oil level in
increments is 7 to 10. This represents between 2.6 and 4.4 fluid ounces.
8. When oil is added, Piper refrigerant oil PMS-L2000 or equivalent 500 viscosity refrigerant oil
must be used.
9. When installing the oil filler plug, make sure the sealing O-ring is not twisted and that no dirt
nor particles are on the O-ring or seat. Torque the plug to 6-9 foot-pounds. Do not overtighten
the plug to stop a leak; remove the plug and install a new O-ring.
10. Evacuate and charge the system (refer to paragraphs 14-13 and 14-14).
CAUTION
The oil plug should not be removed with pressure in the system.
14-22. REPLACEMENT OF YORK COMPRESSOR AND/OR ALTERNATOR DRIVE BELTS. (Refer to
Figure 14-9a.) (PA-28R-201)
a. Remove the old belts by removing the spinner, propeller, nose cowl, right front baffle, starter ring
gear assembly and drive belts.
b. Place the new belt or belts in their appropriate positions on the starter ring gear sheaves.
c. Reinstall the starter ring gear assembly, propeller and spinner.
d. Route the belts to the proper pulley sheaves as shown in Figure 14-9a.
CAUTION
Do not force the belts into the pulley sheaves. Remove the idles assemblies if
necessary and the alternator lower mounting bolts in order to install the
belts.
Figure 14-8b. Rotation of Clutch Front Plate (Sankyo Compressor Oil Check)
e. Check the belt and pulley alignment of the compressor and/or alternator by the following method:
1. A daturm line must be established for checking belt and pulley alignment. A nominal
dimension must be established between the forward edge of the compressor belt and the
forward machined surface of the ring gear. This dimension should be taken at the ring gear
assembly where the belt is in its sheave. The amount of misalignment can then be determined
at the other pulley sheaves by using a stiff straightedge of sufficient length to extend from the
front of the ring gear to the component sheaves.
NOTE
Ensure adequate ring gear surface contact to provide a solid base for the
straightedge.
2. Obtain a basic measurement from the top of the ring gear by measuring the width of the starter
ring gear plus the dimension from the forward machined surface of the ring gear to the
forward edge of the compressor drive belt. (Refer to Figure 14-9a.)
3. The check and adjustments of the compressor and/or alternator drive belts require different
procedures; refer to following appropriate instructions:
f. Compressor Belt Alignment: (Refer to Figure 14-9a.)
1. Place the straightedge against the right forward side of the ring gear and measure belt
alignment at compressor sheave (Point - B).
2. Measure belt alignment at the compressor idler pulley (Point - A). The belt misalignment at
Point - A should be half the misalignment of Point - B and the dimension at the top of the ring
gear and in the same direction fore and aft.
3. If at Point - A nominal misalignment is not within ±.030 of an inch as obtained in step 2, add
or remove shims as required. Belt alignment should be made as close to nominal as shims will
allow.
4. Shut down engine and recheck the belt tensions. If the compressor belt tension falls as low as
60 lbs., reset to 80 lbs. If the alternator belt tension falls as low as 50 lbs., retention to 70 lbs.
The plastic type belt should be between 35-40 lbs.
5. This tension check should be made at every 100 hours or annual inspection, whichever occurs
first.
6. Check all idler and bracket bolts for safety and replace engine cowling.
b. Adjust the Sankyo compressor on the PA-28R-201T as follows:
1. Rotate the compressor to obtain tension of 45 to 50 lbs. for new or old belts.
2. Run the engine for a 15 minute period at 1900 rpm with the compressor engaged.
WARNING
If the air conditioner is to be operated during ground servicing, the test area
should be clean and free of any loose objects lying on the ramp. Only the
service valve located on the evaporator assembly should be used for testing.
3. Shut down engine and recheck the belt tensions. New belt tension should fall back to desired
tension of 45 to 50 lbs. Old belts reinstalled should retain the 45 to 50 lbs. span tension.
4. This tension check should be made at every 100 hours or annual inspection, whichever occurs
first.
d. Slide the pulley assembly (2) over the field assembly and onto the crankshaft, now torque the field
assembly 85 to 120 inch pounds. Then secure pulley assembly with washer and new self-locking
capscrew (1). Torque the capscrew to 180 to 240 inch-pounds.
NOTE
If the clutch is not engaged while tightening the capscrew, insert a spanner
into the holes provided in the armature face.
e. Spin the pulley by hand to check for any interference between the field (4) and rotor pulley
assemblies (2). A rubbing noise can be heard as the pulley rotates if there is interference. The rotor
pulley assembly must be removed and the mounting of the field assembly adjusted until the
interference is eliminated.
14-27. REFRIGERANT LINES AND ROUTING. The refrigerant lines in this aircraft are flexible high
pressure hoses and should be handled accordingly. The hoses in the power plant area are routed so as to
provide maximum protection from heat and abrasion. They couple at the firewall to hose routed through the
two inboard, external hat section on the bottom of the fuselage, up thru the floor to the condenser and
evaporator in the tail cone. The discharge is in the right hat section and the suction in the left.
NOTE
Before any of the hose couplings are uncoupled, the system must be
completely discharged. (See paragraph 14-12.)
14-28. RECEIVER-DEHYDRATOR.
14-29. RECEIVER-DEHYDRATOR REMOVAL. This unit is mounted on the inboard side of the evaporator
assembly housing.
a. Discharge the system of all refrigerant. (See paragraph 14-12.)
b. Uncouple the refrigerant lines at the receiver-dehydrator. (See paragraph 14-5, B-7.)
c. Remove the clamp attaching the unit to the evaporator housing.
NOTE
This part is not serviceable, it must be replaced. The receiver dehydrator
should be replaced when the system has been operated without a charge or
is left open.
14-31. CONDENSER. The condenser is mounted in a frame assembly located in the bottom of the fuselage
between stations 156.00 and 191.00.
14-35. CONDENSER ASSEMBLY RIGGING INSTRUCTIONS. (Refer to Figure 14-11.) The condenser
assembly is actuated by an electric motor through bellcranks, push rods and limit switches.
It is necessary for the condenser door to fit flush with the fuselage skin and with increased force along the
forward edge. The following steps will help accomplish this requirement: (Refer to Figure 14-11.)
a. Adjust open limit switch (5) to open the condenser door (8) five inches when measured from the
leading edge of the door to the fuselage skin.
b. Adjust the push rods (9) so that a vertically measured gap of .16 of an inch exists along the trailing
edge of the door at the instant the forward edge of the door becomes flush with the fuselage skin.
c. With the door fully closed, adjust the CLOSED (6) limit switch so that the actuator (1) travels an
additional .12 of an inch after the door is fully closed, this is necessary to preload the mechanism.
Refer to Figure 14-11.
d. Cycle the assembly several times to be certain it operates properly without binding.
14-37. EXPANSION VALVE REMOVAL. The expansion valve is located in the evaporator assembly between
the receiver drier and the evaporator inlet. The capillary coil is attached to the evaporator outlet line.
a. Remove the necessary access panels and discharge system.
b. Remove the capillary coil from the outlet line. (Do not link the capillary tube.)
c. Uncouple all related tube fittings. (See paragraph 14-5, B-7.)
NOTE
If this part is not serviceable, it must be replaced with a new part.
14-38. EXPANSION VALVE INSTALLATION.
a. Install the expansion valve in the inlet line of the evaporator core by coupling the related fittings.
(Seal all couplings with sealant applied to tube flanges only.) Torque fittings per Table XIV-I.
b. Secure the capillary coil to the evaporator outlet line.
c. Evacuate and charge the system. (See paragraphs 14-13 and 14-14.) Check for leaks. (See
paragraph 14-9.)
d. Replace access panels.
14-39. EVAPORATOR ASSEMBLY. The evaporator assembly consists of the evaporator core, receiver
dehydrator, expansion valve, circulating fan and pressure switch together with necessary housing and
plumbing. The housing is fabricated of Cycolac type material. The condensed moisture is dumped over board
through a hose clamped to a fitting on the bottom of the evaporator housing.
14-40. EVAPORATOR ASSEMBLY REMOVAL. The evaporator assembly is located behind the cabin rear
panel, attached to the mounting panel with 12 screws and washers, and a bracket securing the back to the
mounting panel.
a. Remove air conditioning filter cover, filter and rear access panels.
NOTE
Discharge the system before disassembling. (Refer to paragraph 14-12.)
b. Uncouple the liquid line from the inlet side of the receiver-dehydrator and the suction line from the
evaporator core outlet. (See paragraph 14-5, B-7.)
c. Disconnect the related electrical wires.
d. Remove flexible air duct from housing outlet. Remove drain hose from housing.
e. Remove temperature probe from evaporator housing.
f. Remove the screws attaching the support bracket and evaporator housing to the mounting panel.
Remove the assembly through the access hole in the bulkhead.
14-42. PRESSURE RELIEF SWITCH (Ranco). The pressure relief switch automatically prevents the system
from over pressurization by breaking the electrical circuit to the magnetic clutch, stopping the compressor until
pressure is reduced. The switch is located in the line between the receiver and expansion valve, and set to cut
out at 350 ± 10 psi and cut in at 250 ± 10 psi.
NOTE
Before the relief switch is removed, the air conditioning system must be
discharged. (See paragraph 14-12.)
14-43. ELECTRICAL INSTALLATION. The electrical system, routing and component are installed and
routed in the conventional aircraft manner. The wiring harness is connected to switches in the climate control
center on the right side of the instrument panel. The harnesses cross the instrument panel to the left side where
two (2) wires are taken off for the compressor clutch. The harness then passes aft along the left side of the
fuselage where it connects to the blower motor, pressure relief switch and the condenser actuating motor.
NOTE
Newer models of the PA-28R-201T air conditioning throttle switch may
appear different in design, but is adjusted and inspected the same way that
is outlined in paragraph 14-44 of this section.
14-44. AIR CONDITIONING THROTTLE SWITCH. This switch is responsible for shutting down the air
conditioning system when the airplane is at full throttle enabling maximum performance. On the PA-28R-201
model, the switch is behind the control quadrant and is actuated by the throttle lever. With throttle against full
open stop, adjust switch so the .040 ± .010 clearance is obtained (refer to Figure 14-14). On the PA-28R-201T,
the switch is in back of the instrument panel in the manifold pressure gauge line. No adjustment is necessary.
14-45. FUSE REPLACEMENT. There are three fuses located behind the air conditioning system control
panel. A 20 amp circuit breaker mounted in the circuit breaker panel protects the complete air conditioning
electrical system.
14-48. DESCRIPTION. The blower is mounted in the aft section of the fuselage and is connected to the
overhead vent system. The blower draws air in from the dorsal fin and forces it through the ducting, whenever
desired. The four position blower switch on the instrument panel controls the three speed blower.
Low suction pressure. Low air supply through Repair blower or blower
(Accompanied by icing evaporator. motor. Clean stoppage
evaporator.) in air ducts.
Door will not close when Faulty relay “K-2.” Replace relay.
air conditioner switch is
in OFF position.
Electrical
Mechanical
Refrigeration
Mechanical
Refrigeration
Refrigeration
Mechanical
NOTE
1. Pin number 1 is at the pointed side of the plug and receptacle.
2. YY15062 ESB-Universal Elect. Co. Motor Wire Colors Same as E362Q
Singer Controls.
14-54. DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION. A fixed and/or portable oxygen system is available on this
aircraft. Scott Aviation manufacturers the major components for these systems and should be contacted along
with the Piper Customer Service for any further information not covered herein. For specific parts information
refer to the Piper Parts Catalog.
The fixed oxygen system involves a 48.3 cu. ft. cylinder tied into four overhead “shallow wall” outlets and
a “push-pull” regulator control mechanism. A 3AA 1800 tank, mounted in the modified tail cone behind the
baggage compartment, is connected to an external fill valve mounted to the fuselage behind fuselage station
bulkhead 191.0. The manifold for the outlets is set up such that the main feed line for the overhead outlets is
connected to the left rear passenger outlet from which the right rear and pilot outlets are connected. The copilot
outlet is connected to the right rear passenger outlet. Push-pull control is provided by a knob on the overhead
panel, to the left of the fresh air duct control A gauge for displaying tank pressure is mounted in the overhead
duct behind the passengers and is lighted by a post light.
The portable oxygen system uses a 22 cu. ft. capacity, 3AA 1800 cylinder. The tank is incorporated in a
carrying case which utilizes a dual manifold, permitting four masks to be used with dual connectors at each
outlet. The portable unit fits in the cradle between the back passengers seats.
Refer to pilot’s operating handbook for operating instructions.
WARNING
Use only aviation breathing oxygen when recharging the bottle. MIL-0-
27210C specifies that the moisture content of aviation breathing oxygen
must not exceed 0.005 milligrams of water vapor per liter of gas at a
temperature of 70 degrees F° and a pressure of 760 millimeters of mercury.
WARNING
DO NOT use grease or any type of oil on any hardware connected to the
oxygen system. When working with an oxygen system, ensure that your
hands, clothing, tools, and immediate area is clean and free of any grease or
oil.
WARNING
Oxygen cylinders are identified by the ICC or DOT identification stamped
on the cylinder. The standard weight cylinder (ICC or DOT 3AA 1800) must
be hydrostatic tested at the end of each 5 year period. Lightweight cylinders
(ICC or DOT 3HT 1850) must be tested every 3 years and after 4380 refills
or 24 years whichever comes first, be replaced. The month and year of the
last test is stamped on the cylinder beneath the ICC, DOT identification.
14-57. INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE. Due to the nature of the process used to test compressed gas
tanks, servicing and hydrostatic tests must be conducted by a DOT or manufacturer (Scott Aviation) approved
shop. The following material gives recommended inspection and maintenance information for the various parts
of the oxygen systems.
1. Check outlets for leakage both in the use and non-use condition, and for leakage around an inserted
connector. For leak testing information, refer to the appropriate subject in this chapter.
2. Check the high pressure gauge for accuracy by comparing its indicated pressure with that of a gauge of
know accuracy, connected to the fill port.
3. Inspect tank for dents, bulges, corrosion, and major strap chafing marks. Should any of these problems
exist, the tank should be removed and hydrostatically tested.
4. An operational check of the regulator is accomplished as follows: (Refer to Figure 35-3.)
a. Interconnect a sensitive pressure gauge of a range of 0 to 100 psi, with a Scott Aviation 857000
plug-in, and connect the apparatus to the pilot’s outlet in the overhead panel. It is recommended
that a hose of 1/4 in. ID x 1/2 in. OD and 18 inches long be used.
b. Interconnect a pneumatic flow apparatus of a range of 0-5 liters per min (1 pm.) with a Scott
Aviation 8570-00 plug-in. Use the same hose dimension as explained in the last step. Connect the
flow apparatus to the copilot’s outlet.
c. Insert a Scott plug-in in each of the other outlets and pull the oxygen control knob to the on
position. The pressure and flow should be 55 to 80 psi and 3.3 to 5.31 pm. respectfully at sea level.
d. There should be no external leakage anywhere on the regulator when it is turned off and all fittings
should be leak free.
5. Check airframe logbook for last maintenance of oxygen system and perform as required per Chart
3502.
6. Test the oxygen for odor. Pure oxygen is odorless and tasteless. Any system having a significant odor
present in the gas should be purged and the bottle replaced or removed and purged.
7. Any fittings, connector, and tubes which have imperfect threads, pitted or disfigured cones, or other
damage should be replaced.
WARNING
Oxygen tubes must not be clamped to or supported by electrical wire
bundles, hydraulic, pneumatic, or any other type of lines. They should be
separately clamped to bulkhead and stringers, with minimum 1/8 inch
separation.
8. Check plumbing for kinking, cracks, gouges, dents, deep scratches, or other damage, and replace as
necessary.
9. Make sure to check the oxygen lines for proper clearance as follows:
a. Two inch minimum between oxygen tubes and all flexible moving parts of the aircraft (flexible
control cables, etc). It adequate space cannot be attained, protection from chafing must be
provided.
b. At least 1/2 inch minimum between oxygen tubes and all rigid moving parts of aircraft, such as
levers and rigid control rods.
c. Six inch minimum separation between oxygen tubes and hydraulic, fuel, and electrical system
lines and components.
CAUTION
When the six inch requirement cannot be complied with, one inch is
allowed as long as the electric cables and other lines are supported at least
every two inches; and, the oxygen tube(s) is protected by rubber neoprene
hose fastened in place with cable ties at the location the specific item crosses
or is near the oxygen tube(s). If an item is near the oxygen tube for a
certain distance, the oxygen tube for that distance must be covered.
d. A minimum of 1/8 inch between tubing and structure adjoining the supported clamp, as shown in
Figure 14-18, Sketch A.
e. Where a tube passes through a grommet, the tube must not bear on the grommet in any way that
might cause cutting of the grommet in service as shown in Figure 14-18, Sketch D.
f. While in service, items may receive vibrations causing them to come in contact with other parts of
the aircraft. With this in mind, low pressure tubing that is supported well enough to prevent
relative motion must have at least a minimum clearance of 1/8 inch from a projection (bolt, nut,
etc). Low pressure tubing that cannot be supported well enough to prevent motion must have a
minimum clearance of 1/8 inch allowed after the maximum travel of the tube. High pressure lines
are affected similarly but require 1/2 inch clearances. Refer to Figure 14-18, Sketch B.
10. Perform any other required maintenance as directed in AC 43.13-1A.
11. Clean components as necessary per the following subject-paragraph.
NOTE
Solvents can be reused provided they do not become badly contaminated
with oil. This condition can be determined by thoroughly evaporating 100
milliliters of the liquid in a glass dish of a determined weight. Evaporation
may be accomplished by heating the dish at 200 degrees F° for one-half
h o u r. If after evaporation and cool down, the residue exceeded 100
milligrams in weight, the solvent cannot be used for this purpose.
Three methods are recommended for cleaning oxygen system components as follows:
1. Method I
a. Vapor degrease affected part(s) with trichlorethylene.
b. Blow part(s) dry with a stream of compressed air or dry nitrogen.
2. Method II.
a. For tubing, flush with naphtha per specifications TT-N-95.
b. Blow clean and dry off all solvent with clean, dry, filtered air.
c. Flush with isopropyl alcohol.
d. Rinse thoroughly with fresh water.
e. Dry with air or by heating at temperature 250 to 300 degrees F° for one-half hour.
3. Method III.
a. Flush with hot inhibited alkaline cleaner until free from oil and grease.
b. Rinse thoroughly with fresh water.
c. Dry thoroughly with a stream of clean air or by heating 250 to 300 degrees F° for one-half hour
minimum.
CAUTION
Do not use adhesive tape on oxygen components for attaching or securing
protective coverings. Use waxed lacing twine or tie wraps.
4. After cleaning, all tubing must be protected by caps, plugs, and/or plastic bags.
5. Before reinstallation, make sure that the fitting, tube, and fixture threads are in good condition and that
the cones do not exhibit or disfigurement.
(1) Slide tube in fitting until it bottoms, turn nut to finger tight position and tighten one quarter
turn with wrench.
(2) Snug slightly with wrench.
14-60. APPLICATION OF TEFLON TAPE THREAD SEALANT. All male pipe (tapered) threads of the
oxygen system should be sealed with 3M No. 48 Teflon tape. Teflon tape should not be used on straight
threads. Do not use any other lubricants in place of Teflon.
1. Wrap tape on threads, starting with those farthest from the opening, in the direction of the thread
spiral. Circle the threads, making sure that each side of the tape has a slight overlap.
2. Wrap the tape such that it does not extend beyond the last thread on the fitting as the opening. The tape
should then be pulled until it separates. Do not cut the tape, it will not stick properly.
NOTES:
1
On condition replace the rubber components in the asembly or replace assembly.
2
If the screen in front of value is dirty, replace valve. Valve replacement is recommended every 5 years.
14-61. LEAK TESTS. Solutions recommended for leak testing are Leak-Tec Formula #16-OX and that
available from Scott Aviation. Refer to the List of Consumable Materials for consumer information.
1. Remove royalite covers in baggage compartment and with the oxygen system turned off, disconnect
low pressure supply line and connect it to a regulated cylinder charged with dry nitrogen.
CAUTION
Whenever a leak check is performed, all fitting connections as well as other
questionable areas, should be inspected.
2. Apply the leak detector solution to test surface and watch for indication of leakage.
3. Large leaks will produce bubbles immediately, but small leaks will form a white foam in 5 to 60
seconds.
4. With outlets vacated of masks, connect a test pressure gauge to the copilot’s outlet. See Figure 14-17.
5. Adjust regulator on dry nitrogen cylinder for 100 psi and check for leakage at the outlets.
6. Correct any leaks and wipe off excess leak detector solution.
7. Close valve on nitrogen gas tank and insert a Scott plug-in to relieve system pressure.
8. Disconnect test gauge, plug-in, and nitrogen tank.
9. If the oxygen cylinder is not to be hooked up or installed immediately, cap and cover exposed fittings
with new clean plastic bags. Temporarily support lines as needed to prevent damage. Make sure caps
and coverings are as clean as possible.
NOTE
Replacement time for the recharge valve is every 5 years. If the cylinder is
being removed for the 5 year test, it is recommended the valve be removed
and/or replaced at the same time.
The oxygen bottle, located behind the finished bulkhead in the baggage compartment, is secured to a
removable shelf mounted to each side of the fuselage. The tank is mounted such that the regulator-control
valve is on the left side of the aircraft (the same side as the recharge valve). A shroud also covers the regulator
end of the bottle to prevent leaks, should any develop, firm filling the aircraft with oxygen. With this in mind,
a vent tube interconnects the shroud with the recharge valve fixture permitting any oxygen to vent overboard.
1. Remove screws attaching finished bulkhead to fuselage bulkhead and remove finished bulkhead.
2. When working in the tail cone of the aircraft, attach a tail stand to the tail.
3. With immediate area clear of flammables (grease, hydraulic fluid, fuel) and with the oxygen system
OFF, connect the mask or tube to an outlet to exhaust any pressure in the system.
4. Remove the screws and loosen clamps securing the shroud and disconnect the tube.
5. Remove the spring clamps securing vent tube to cylinder shroud and disconnect the tube.
6. Carefully separate the shroud along the high pressure lines.
7. The high pressure fitting on the regulator-control valve incorporates a valve that opens only when a
line is connected to it. With this in mind, carefully unscrew the high pressure line until the pressure
decreases, then remove the line. Disconnect low pressure lines as well.
8. Loosen and open the clamps securing the bottle to the shelf. Carefully move the bottle in such a way
that fair access can be made to the control mechanism.
CAUTION
Be extremely careful not to kink the cable.
9. Disconnect the control cable.
10. Remove tank from the aircraft being careful not to damage the regulator-control valve.
14-64. REMOVAL OF RECHARGE VALVE. The recharge valve is located on the left rear side of the aircraft
and is covered by its own access door. The valve is interconnected with the gauge line as well as the regulator
control valve and is constantly under cylinder pressure as long as the high pressure line is attached to the
regulator.
NOTE
The recommended service life for the recharge valve is 5 years and the
oxygen cylinder must be hydrostatically tested every 5 years. It is
recommended that the recharge valve be removed and replaced when the
cylinder is removed for services.
1. Due to the location of the recharge valve, it is necessary to remove the oxygen cylinder. For ease of
removal, it is recommended that the cylinder shelf also be removed.
2. Remove screws that secure the recharge valve’s protective shroud to valve mounting dish and slide
shroud back over high pressure line.
3. Unscrew high pressure line fitting from recharge valve and with somebody turning the screw from
outside the aircraft, back-up the nut to remove valve.
For comparison of filling pressure to ambient temperatures, refer to Chart VIII-IV. The following are
parameters to be followed for filling.
1. Only aviators breathing oxygen (MIL-0-27210) and appropriate filling equipment should be used to
service the system.
2. If a cylinder has less than 5 psi pressure or has insufficient pressure to produce an audible hissing
sound when the valve is cracked, it should be removed and/or purged. If the condition has existed for a
significant length of time, the bottle must be hydrostatically tested.
CAUTION
Be cautious that there is no oil on the fittings or near the immediate vicinity.
NOTE: Filling pressure are for 1850 PSI at 70°F. Table ass umes 25°F rise due to heat of comprssion with max fill rate.
3. Make sure both the charge valve and recharge “cart” fittings are clean and free of contamination.
4. Attach service cart hose to recharge port. Fill system at a rate not exceeding 200 psig per minute
proceeding as follows:
a. To obtain the correct filling pressure for the oxygen system at various ambient temperatures, a
table is included for your convenience. The pressures given are not exact, but sufficiently accurate
for practical purposes of working pressures between 1800 and 2400 psig cylinders. The cylinder
should be allowed to cool to a stabilized temperature after filling before checking against the
valves in Chart VIII-IV.
b. When using a recharge unit consisting of one supply cylinder, slowly open valve supply unit and
allow oxygen to transfer.
c. When using a recharge unit consisting of two or more supply cylinders (cascade storage system), it
is recommended that the following procedure be used:
(1) Before opening any valves, check the pressure remaining in the airplane’s oxygen cylinder. If
it is partly charged, note the pressure indicated on the cylinder gauge. Then open and close
each valve on the cascade storage system and determine which cylinder has the lowest
pressure. When found if this cylinder has a pressure lower than the oxygen cylinder in the
aircraft, do not attempt using it for filling; use the storage cylinder that has a pressure higher
than the aircraft’s cylinder but lower than the others.
(2) Open the valve on only the one storage cylinder with the lowest pressure. When the pressure
indicated on the aircraft’s oxygen gauge and charging gauge has become equal, close the valve
of the storage cylinder, then go to the storage cylinder with the next higher pressure and repeat
the procedure.
(3) If after using the last storage cylinder the aircraft’s oxygen system is still not fully charged, a
full storage cylinder should be put in place of a cylinder with the lowest pressure and used in
the same manner.
(4) A good deal of oxygen will remain in the large cylinders used in the cascade system after
filling only one of the cylinders. Remaining oxygen will be a pressure something less than the
1850 psi which is not sufficient pressure to completely refill another aircraft cylinder, although
it will refill several smaller cylinders.
(5) It is not economical even on a three or four cylinder cascade system to begin recharging with
oxygen at less than 300 psi pressure in the 300 cubic foot bank of cylinders. So use 300 cubic
foot cylinders down to approximately 300 psi; then return for refilling. In two cylinder
systems use to approximately 100 psi; then return for filling.
d. When the pressure gauge on the recharge unit or in the aircraft reaches 1800 to 1850 psi, close the
pressure regulator valve on the recharge unit Disconnect the filler hose from the filler valve;
replace the protective cap on the filler valve and close the access cover. Check the cylinder
pressure according to Chart VIII-IV after the cylinder temperature stabilizes.
5. After detaching the service cart, cap hose and fittings to prevent contamination.
6. Perform a leak check of the high pressure lines and clean off solution afterwards. If solution is not
properly cleaned off, unusual corrosion may result.
14-73. DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION. The portable oxygen system is available as one of two options
that provides oxygen for the PA-28R-201T and renders it capable of cruising at higher altitudes.
The portable oxygen unit consists of a 22 cu. ft. capacity cylinder contained in a carrying case that is
installed in a cradle located between the rear seats. (See figure 14-20, Portable Oxygen Installation.) The
system utilizes a dual manifold, which permits 4 masks to be used, two from each single outlet using a dual
connector.
CAUTION
Use only aviation breathing oxygen when having the oxygen bottle charged.
MIL-0-2710C specified that the moisture content of aviation breathing
oxygen must not exceed 0.005 milligrams of water vapor per liter of gas at a
temperature of 70°F and a pressure of 760 millimeters of mercury.
WARNING
Do not use grease or any grease type fittings on any hardware that connects
to the oxygen bottle or system hardware. When working with the system
make sure hands, clothing, and tools are free of oil, grease, and dirt when
working with the oxygen system.
The oxygen unit can be released from its cradle by pulling down on the ring under the cradle, and sliding
the unit forward, and lifting it out of the cradle.
14-76. INSPECTION AND OVERHAUL TIMES. Due to the nature of the process used to test compressed
gas tanks, it is recommended that overhaul, service or hydrostatic tests be conducted by a DOT, FAA, or
manufacturer (Scott Aviation) approved shop. The following checks and charts give recommended inspection
and maintenance information for the various parts of the oxygen system.
WARNING
Oxygen cylinders are identified by the ICC or DOT identification stamped
on the cylinder. The standard weight cylinder (ICC or DOT 3AA 1800) must
be hydrostatic tested at the end of each 5 year period. Lightweight cylinders
(ICC or DOT 3HT 1850) must be tested every 3 years and after 4380 refills
or 24 years whichever comes first, be replaced. The month and year of the
last test is stamped on the cylinder beneath the ICC, DOT identification.
1. Inspect outlets, and using directions described in the next paragraph, check leaks both in the non-use
and use condition.
2. Check the pressure gauge for accuracy by removing the back section of the unit and connecting a
gauge of known accuracy to the fill port.
3. Inspect tank for dents, bulges, major strap chaffing marks, or corrosion. Should any of these conditions
exist, the tank should be hydrostatically tested.
14-77. TESTING FOR LEAKS. Apply detector fluid Leak Tec Formula #16-OX (American Gas and Chemical
Co.) solution or its equivalent. The solution should be shaken to obtain suds or foam. The suds or foam should
be applied sparingly to the joints of the system. Look for traces of bubbles. Visible leakages are not permitted.
Repair or replace any defective parts and retest system. With the system pressurized to service pressure, further
tests can be made. All traces of the detector fluid should be wiped off at the conclusion of the examination.
14-78. MAINTENANCE.
a. Check the cylinder to be sure it is securely mounted.
b. Check the cylinder for the ICC identification number and for the date of the last FAA inspection
and test.
c. If cylinder is completely empty, it must be completely disassembled and inspected in an FAA or
manufacturer approved facility before recharging.
d. Refer to FAA Manual AC 43.13-1A for more details.
14-81. PURGING OXYGEN SYSTEM. The system should be purged whenever the cylinder pressure falls
below 50 psi or if any lines are left open for any length of time. Also, if the bottle is left at below 200 psi, it
may develop odors from bacterial growth. This will make it necessary to purge the system. Use the following
procedures:
CAUTION
When performing this operation, make sure the area is a NO SMOKING
AREA and is as clean as possible of oil and dirt.
a. Keep all doors and windows open.
b. Connect the oxygen recharging unit to the filler valve.
c. Plug the oxygen masks into the outlet valves and turn on the system.
d. Set the recharging unit pressure regulator to deliver 50 psi and let the system purge for one hour. If
any odor is still present, repeat the procedure for one or more hours. If the odor persists after the
second purging, send unit to its manufacturer or an approved shop.
14-82. CLEANING OF FACE MASKS. The disposable masks are designed for one-time use and require no
maintenance. The pilot’s and copilot’s mask can be cleaned as follows:
a. Remove the microphone from the mask.
b. Remove the sponge rubber disc from the mask turrets. Do not use soap to clean sponge rubber
discs as this would deteriorate the rubber and give off unpleasant odors. Clean in clear water and
squeeze dry.
c. Wash the rest of the mask with a very mild solution of soap and water.
d. Rinse the mask thoroughly to removal all traces of soap.
e. Make sure the side of the breathing bag do not stick together while drying as this may decrease the
life of the rubber in the bag. The mask can be sterilized with a solution of 70 percent ethyl alcohol.